1Produced by Suzanne Lybarger, steve harris, Josephine 2Paolucci and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team at 3http://www.pgdp.net. 4 5 6 7 8 9 10OPTICKS: 11 12OR, A 13 14TREATISE 15 16OF THE 17 18_Reflections_, _Refractions_, 19_Inflections_ and _Colours_ 20 21OF 22 23LIGHT. 24 25_The_ FOURTH EDITION, _corrected_. 26 27By Sir _ISAAC NEWTON_, Knt. 28 29LONDON: 30 31Printed for WILLIAM INNYS at the West-End of St. _Paul's_. MDCCXXX. 32 33TITLE PAGE OF THE 1730 EDITION 34 35 36 37 38SIR ISAAC NEWTON'S ADVERTISEMENTS 39 40 41 42 43Advertisement I 44 45 46_Part of the ensuing Discourse about Light was written at the Desire of 47some Gentlemen of the_ Royal-Society, _in the Year 1675, and then sent 48to their Secretary, and read at their Meetings, and the rest was added 49about twelve Years after to complete the Theory; except the third Book, 50and the last Proposition of the Second, which were since put together 51out of scatter'd Papers. To avoid being engaged in Disputes about these 52Matters, I have hitherto delayed the printing, and should still have 53delayed it, had not the Importunity of Friends prevailed upon me. If any 54other Papers writ on this Subject are got out of my Hands they are 55imperfect, and were perhaps written before I had tried all the 56Experiments here set down, and fully satisfied my self about the Laws of 57Refractions and Composition of Colours. I have here publish'd what I 58think proper to come abroad, wishing that it may not be translated into 59another Language without my Consent._ 60 61_The Crowns of Colours, which sometimes appear about the Sun and Moon, I 62have endeavoured to give an Account of; but for want of sufficient 63Observations leave that Matter to be farther examined. The Subject of 64the Third Book I have also left imperfect, not having tried all the 65Experiments which I intended when I was about these Matters, nor 66repeated some of those which I did try, until I had satisfied my self 67about all their Circumstances. To communicate what I have tried, and 68leave the rest to others for farther Enquiry, is all my Design in 69publishing these Papers._ 70 71_In a Letter written to Mr._ Leibnitz _in the year 1679, and published 72by Dr._ Wallis, _I mention'd a Method by which I had found some general 73Theorems about squaring Curvilinear Figures, or comparing them with the 74Conic Sections, or other the simplest Figures with which they may be 75compared. And some Years ago I lent out a Manuscript containing such 76Theorems, and having since met with some Things copied out of it, I have 77on this Occasion made it publick, prefixing to it an_ Introduction, _and 78subjoining a_ Scholium _concerning that Method. And I have joined with 79it another small Tract concerning the Curvilinear Figures of the Second 80Kind, which was also written many Years ago, and made known to some 81Friends, who have solicited the making it publick._ 82 83 _I. N._ 84 85April 1, 1704. 86 87 88Advertisement II 89 90_In this Second Edition of these Opticks I have omitted the Mathematical 91Tracts publish'd at the End of the former Edition, as not belonging to 92the Subject. And at the End of the Third Book I have added some 93Questions. And to shew that I do not take Gravity for an essential 94Property of Bodies, I have added one Question concerning its Cause, 95chusing to propose it by way of a Question, because I am not yet 96satisfied about it for want of Experiments._ 97 98 _I. N._ 99 100July 16, 1717. 101 102 103Advertisement to this Fourth Edition 104 105_This new Edition of Sir_ Isaac Newton's Opticks _is carefully printed 106from the Third Edition, as it was corrected by the Author's own Hand, 107and left before his Death with the Bookseller. Since Sir_ Isaac's 108Lectiones Opticæ, _which he publickly read in the University of_ 109Cambridge _in the Years 1669, 1670, and 1671, are lately printed, it has 110been thought proper to make at the bottom of the Pages several Citations 111from thence, where may be found the Demonstrations, which the Author 112omitted in these_ Opticks. 113 114 * * * * * 115 116Transcriber's Note: There are several greek letters used in the 117descriptions of the illustrations. They are signified by [Greek: 118letter]. Square roots are noted by the letters sqrt before the equation. 119 120 * * * * * 121 122THE FIRST BOOK OF OPTICKS 123 124 125 126 127_PART I._ 128 129 130My Design in this Book is not to explain the Properties of Light by 131Hypotheses, but to propose and prove them by Reason and Experiments: In 132order to which I shall premise the following Definitions and Axioms. 133 134 135 136 137_DEFINITIONS_ 138 139 140DEFIN. I. 141 142_By the Rays of Light I understand its least Parts, and those as well 143Successive in the same Lines, as Contemporary in several Lines._ For it 144is manifest that Light consists of Parts, both Successive and 145Contemporary; because in the same place you may stop that which comes 146one moment, and let pass that which comes presently after; and in the 147same time you may stop it in any one place, and let it pass in any 148other. For that part of Light which is stopp'd cannot be the same with 149that which is let pass. The least Light or part of Light, which may be 150stopp'd alone without the rest of the Light, or propagated alone, or do 151or suffer any thing alone, which the rest of the Light doth not or 152suffers not, I call a Ray of Light. 153 154 155DEFIN. II. 156 157_Refrangibility of the Rays of Light, is their Disposition to be 158refracted or turned out of their Way in passing out of one transparent 159Body or Medium into another. And a greater or less Refrangibility of 160Rays, is their Disposition to be turned more or less out of their Way in 161like Incidences on the same Medium._ Mathematicians usually consider the 162Rays of Light to be Lines reaching from the luminous Body to the Body 163illuminated, and the refraction of those Rays to be the bending or 164breaking of those lines in their passing out of one Medium into another. 165And thus may Rays and Refractions be considered, if Light be propagated 166in an instant. But by an Argument taken from the Æquations of the times 167of the Eclipses of _Jupiter's Satellites_, it seems that Light is 168propagated in time, spending in its passage from the Sun to us about 169seven Minutes of time: And therefore I have chosen to define Rays and 170Refractions in such general terms as may agree to Light in both cases. 171 172 173DEFIN. III. 174 175_Reflexibility of Rays, is their Disposition to be reflected or turned 176back into the same Medium from any other Medium upon whose Surface they 177fall. And Rays are more or less reflexible, which are turned back more 178or less easily._ As if Light pass out of a Glass into Air, and by being 179inclined more and more to the common Surface of the Glass and Air, 180begins at length to be totally reflected by that Surface; those sorts of 181Rays which at like Incidences are reflected most copiously, or by 182inclining the Rays begin soonest to be totally reflected, are most 183reflexible. 184 185 186DEFIN. IV. 187 188_The Angle of Incidence is that Angle, which the Line described by the 189incident Ray contains with the Perpendicular to the reflecting or 190refracting Surface at the Point of Incidence._ 191 192 193DEFIN. V. 194 195_The Angle of Reflexion or Refraction, is the Angle which the line 196described by the reflected or refracted Ray containeth with the 197Perpendicular to the reflecting or refracting Surface at the Point of 198Incidence._ 199 200 201DEFIN. VI. 202 203_The Sines of Incidence, Reflexion, and Refraction, are the Sines of the 204Angles of Incidence, Reflexion, and Refraction._ 205 206 207DEFIN. VII 208 209_The Light whose Rays are all alike Refrangible, I call Simple, 210Homogeneal and Similar; and that whose Rays are some more Refrangible 211than others, I call Compound, Heterogeneal and Dissimilar._ The former 212Light I call Homogeneal, not because I would affirm it so in all 213respects, but because the Rays which agree in Refrangibility, agree at 214least in all those their other Properties which I consider in the 215following Discourse. 216 217 218DEFIN. VIII. 219 220_The Colours of Homogeneal Lights, I call Primary, Homogeneal and 221Simple; and those of Heterogeneal Lights, Heterogeneal and Compound._ 222For these are always compounded of the colours of Homogeneal Lights; as 223will appear in the following Discourse. 224 225 226 227 228_AXIOMS._ 229 230 231AX. I. 232 233_The Angles of Reflexion and Refraction, lie in one and the same Plane 234with the Angle of Incidence._ 235 236 237AX. II. 238 239_The Angle of Reflexion is equal to the Angle of Incidence._ 240 241 242AX. III. 243 244_If the refracted Ray be returned directly back to the Point of 245Incidence, it shall be refracted into the Line before described by the 246incident Ray._ 247 248 249AX. IV. 250 251_Refraction out of the rarer Medium into the denser, is made towards the 252Perpendicular; that is, so that the Angle of Refraction be less than the 253Angle of Incidence._ 254 255 256AX. V. 257 258_The Sine of Incidence is either accurately or very nearly in a given 259Ratio to the Sine of Refraction._ 260 261Whence if that Proportion be known in any one Inclination of the 262incident Ray, 'tis known in all the Inclinations, and thereby the 263Refraction in all cases of Incidence on the same refracting Body may be 264determined. Thus if the Refraction be made out of Air into Water, the 265Sine of Incidence of the red Light is to the Sine of its Refraction as 4 266to 3. If out of Air into Glass, the Sines are as 17 to 11. In Light of 267other Colours the Sines have other Proportions: but the difference is so 268little that it need seldom be considered. 269 270[Illustration: FIG. 1] 271 272Suppose therefore, that RS [in _Fig._ 1.] represents the Surface of 273stagnating Water, and that C is the point of Incidence in which any Ray 274coming in the Air from A in the Line AC is reflected or refracted, and I 275would know whither this Ray shall go after Reflexion or Refraction: I 276erect upon the Surface of the Water from the point of Incidence the 277Perpendicular CP and produce it downwards to Q, and conclude by the 278first Axiom, that the Ray after Reflexion and Refraction, shall be 279found somewhere in the Plane of the Angle of Incidence ACP produced. I 280let fall therefore upon the Perpendicular CP the Sine of Incidence AD; 281and if the reflected Ray be desired, I produce AD to B so that DB be 282equal to AD, and draw CB. For this Line CB shall be the reflected Ray; 283the Angle of Reflexion BCP and its Sine BD being equal to the Angle and 284Sine of Incidence, as they ought to be by the second Axiom, But if the 285refracted Ray be desired, I produce AD to H, so that DH may be to AD as 286the Sine of Refraction to the Sine of Incidence, that is, (if the Light 287be red) as 3 to 4; and about the Center C and in the Plane ACP with the 288Radius CA describing a Circle ABE, I draw a parallel to the 289Perpendicular CPQ, the Line HE cutting the Circumference in E, and 290joining CE, this Line CE shall be the Line of the refracted Ray. For if 291EF be let fall perpendicularly on the Line PQ, this Line EF shall be the 292Sine of Refraction of the Ray CE, the Angle of Refraction being ECQ; and 293this Sine EF is equal to DH, and consequently in Proportion to the Sine 294of Incidence AD as 3 to 4. 295 296In like manner, if there be a Prism of Glass (that is, a Glass bounded 297with two Equal and Parallel Triangular ends, and three plain and well 298polished Sides, which meet in three Parallel Lines running from the 299three Angles of one end to the three Angles of the other end) and if the 300Refraction of the Light in passing cross this Prism be desired: Let ACB 301[in _Fig._ 2.] represent a Plane cutting this Prism transversly to its 302three Parallel lines or edges there where the Light passeth through it, 303and let DE be the Ray incident upon the first side of the Prism AC where 304the Light goes into the Glass; and by putting the Proportion of the Sine 305of Incidence to the Sine of Refraction as 17 to 11 find EF the first 306refracted Ray. Then taking this Ray for the Incident Ray upon the second 307side of the Glass BC where the Light goes out, find the next refracted 308Ray FG by putting the Proportion of the Sine of Incidence to the Sine of 309Refraction as 11 to 17. For if the Sine of Incidence out of Air into 310Glass be to the Sine of Refraction as 17 to 11, the Sine of Incidence 311out of Glass into Air must on the contrary be to the Sine of Refraction 312as 11 to 17, by the third Axiom. 313 314[Illustration: FIG. 2.] 315 316Much after the same manner, if ACBD [in _Fig._ 3.] represent a Glass 317spherically convex on both sides (usually called a _Lens_, such as is a 318Burning-glass, or Spectacle-glass, or an Object-glass of a Telescope) 319and it be required to know how Light falling upon it from any lucid 320point Q shall be refracted, let QM represent a Ray falling upon any 321point M of its first spherical Surface ACB, and by erecting a 322Perpendicular to the Glass at the point M, find the first refracted Ray 323MN by the Proportion of the Sines 17 to 11. Let that Ray in going out of 324the Glass be incident upon N, and then find the second refracted Ray 325N_q_ by the Proportion of the Sines 11 to 17. And after the same manner 326may the Refraction be found when the Lens is convex on one side and 327plane or concave on the other, or concave on both sides. 328 329[Illustration: FIG. 3.] 330 331 332AX. VI. 333 334_Homogeneal Rays which flow from several Points of any Object, and fall 335perpendicularly or almost perpendicularly on any reflecting or 336refracting Plane or spherical Surface, shall afterwards diverge from so 337many other Points, or be parallel to so many other Lines, or converge to 338so many other Points, either accurately or without any sensible Error. 339And the same thing will happen, if the Rays be reflected or refracted 340successively by two or three or more Plane or Spherical Surfaces._ 341 342The Point from which Rays diverge or to which they converge may be 343called their _Focus_. And the Focus of the incident Rays being given, 344that of the reflected or refracted ones may be found by finding the 345Refraction of any two Rays, as above; or more readily thus. 346 347_Cas._ 1. Let ACB [in _Fig._ 4.] be a reflecting or refracting Plane, 348and Q the Focus of the incident Rays, and Q_q_C a Perpendicular to that 349Plane. And if this Perpendicular be produced to _q_, so that _q_C be 350equal to QC, the Point _q_ shall be the Focus of the reflected Rays: Or 351if _q_C be taken on the same side of the Plane with QC, and in 352proportion to QC as the Sine of Incidence to the Sine of Refraction, the 353Point _q_ shall be the Focus of the refracted Rays. 354 355[Illustration: FIG. 4.] 356 357_Cas._ 2. Let ACB [in _Fig._ 5.] be the reflecting Surface of any Sphere 358whose Centre is E. Bisect any Radius thereof, (suppose EC) in T, and if 359in that Radius on the same side the Point T you take the Points Q and 360_q_, so that TQ, TE, and T_q_, be continual Proportionals, and the Point 361Q be the Focus of the incident Rays, the Point _q_ shall be the Focus of 362the reflected ones. 363 364[Illustration: FIG. 5.] 365 366_Cas._ 3. Let ACB [in _Fig._ 6.] be the refracting Surface of any Sphere 367whose Centre is E. In any Radius thereof EC produced both ways take ET 368and C_t_ equal to one another and severally in such Proportion to that 369Radius as the lesser of the Sines of Incidence and Refraction hath to 370the difference of those Sines. And then if in the same Line you find any 371two Points Q and _q_, so that TQ be to ET as E_t_ to _tq_, taking _tq_ 372the contrary way from _t_ which TQ lieth from T, and if the Point Q be 373the Focus of any incident Rays, the Point _q_ shall be the Focus of the 374refracted ones. 375 376[Illustration: FIG. 6.] 377 378And by the same means the Focus of the Rays after two or more Reflexions 379or Refractions may be found. 380 381[Illustration: FIG. 7.] 382 383_Cas._ 4. Let ACBD [in _Fig._ 7.] be any refracting Lens, spherically 384Convex or Concave or Plane on either side, and let CD be its Axis (that 385is, the Line which cuts both its Surfaces perpendicularly, and passes 386through the Centres of the Spheres,) and in this Axis produced let F and 387_f_ be the Foci of the refracted Rays found as above, when the incident 388Rays on both sides the Lens are parallel to the same Axis; and upon the 389Diameter F_f_ bisected in E, describe a Circle. Suppose now that any 390Point Q be the Focus of any incident Rays. Draw QE cutting the said 391Circle in T and _t_, and therein take _tq_ in such proportion to _t_E as 392_t_E or TE hath to TQ. Let _tq_ lie the contrary way from _t_ which TQ 393doth from T, and _q_ shall be the Focus of the refracted Rays without 394any sensible Error, provided the Point Q be not so remote from the Axis, 395nor the Lens so broad as to make any of the Rays fall too obliquely on 396the refracting Surfaces.[A] 397 398And by the like Operations may the reflecting or refracting Surfaces be 399found when the two Foci are given, and thereby a Lens be formed, which 400shall make the Rays flow towards or from what Place you please.[B] 401 402So then the Meaning of this Axiom is, that if Rays fall upon any Plane 403or Spherical Surface or Lens, and before their Incidence flow from or 404towards any Point Q, they shall after Reflexion or Refraction flow from 405or towards the Point _q_ found by the foregoing Rules. And if the 406incident Rays flow from or towards several points Q, the reflected or 407refracted Rays shall flow from or towards so many other Points _q_ 408found by the same Rules. Whether the reflected and refracted Rays flow 409from or towards the Point _q_ is easily known by the situation of that 410Point. For if that Point be on the same side of the reflecting or 411refracting Surface or Lens with the Point Q, and the incident Rays flow 412from the Point Q, the reflected flow towards the Point _q_ and the 413refracted from it; and if the incident Rays flow towards Q, the 414reflected flow from _q_, and the refracted towards it. And the contrary 415happens when _q_ is on the other side of the Surface. 416 417 418AX. VII. 419 420_Wherever the Rays which come from all the Points of any Object meet 421again in so many Points after they have been made to converge by 422Reflection or Refraction, there they will make a Picture of the Object 423upon any white Body on which they fall._ 424 425So if PR [in _Fig._ 3.] represent any Object without Doors, and AB be a 426Lens placed at a hole in the Window-shut of a dark Chamber, whereby the 427Rays that come from any Point Q of that Object are made to converge and 428meet again in the Point _q_; and if a Sheet of white Paper be held at 429_q_ for the Light there to fall upon it, the Picture of that Object PR 430will appear upon the Paper in its proper shape and Colours. For as the 431Light which comes from the Point Q goes to the Point _q_, so the Light 432which comes from other Points P and R of the Object, will go to so many 433other correspondent Points _p_ and _r_ (as is manifest by the sixth 434Axiom;) so that every Point of the Object shall illuminate a 435correspondent Point of the Picture, and thereby make a Picture like the 436Object in Shape and Colour, this only excepted, that the Picture shall 437be inverted. And this is the Reason of that vulgar Experiment of casting 438the Species of Objects from abroad upon a Wall or Sheet of white Paper 439in a dark Room. 440 441In like manner, when a Man views any Object PQR, [in _Fig._ 8.] the 442Light which comes from the several Points of the Object is so refracted 443by the transparent skins and humours of the Eye, (that is, by the 444outward coat EFG, called the _Tunica Cornea_, and by the crystalline 445humour AB which is beyond the Pupil _mk_) as to converge and meet again 446in so many Points in the bottom of the Eye, and there to paint the 447Picture of the Object upon that skin (called the _Tunica Retina_) with 448which the bottom of the Eye is covered. For Anatomists, when they have 449taken off from the bottom of the Eye that outward and most thick Coat 450called the _Dura Mater_, can then see through the thinner Coats, the 451Pictures of Objects lively painted thereon. And these Pictures, 452propagated by Motion along the Fibres of the Optick Nerves into the 453Brain, are the cause of Vision. For accordingly as these Pictures are 454perfect or imperfect, the Object is seen perfectly or imperfectly. If 455the Eye be tinged with any colour (as in the Disease of the _Jaundice_) 456so as to tinge the Pictures in the bottom of the Eye with that Colour, 457then all Objects appear tinged with the same Colour. If the Humours of 458the Eye by old Age decay, so as by shrinking to make the _Cornea_ and 459Coat of the _Crystalline Humour_ grow flatter than before, the Light 460will not be refracted enough, and for want of a sufficient Refraction 461will not converge to the bottom of the Eye but to some place beyond it, 462and by consequence paint in the bottom of the Eye a confused Picture, 463and according to the Indistinctness of this Picture the Object will 464appear confused. This is the reason of the decay of sight in old Men, 465and shews why their Sight is mended by Spectacles. For those Convex 466glasses supply the defect of plumpness in the Eye, and by increasing the 467Refraction make the Rays converge sooner, so as to convene distinctly at 468the bottom of the Eye if the Glass have a due degree of convexity. And 469the contrary happens in short-sighted Men whose Eyes are too plump. For 470the Refraction being now too great, the Rays converge and convene in the 471Eyes before they come at the bottom; and therefore the Picture made in 472the bottom and the Vision caused thereby will not be distinct, unless 473the Object be brought so near the Eye as that the place where the 474converging Rays convene may be removed to the bottom, or that the 475plumpness of the Eye be taken off and the Refractions diminished by a 476Concave-glass of a due degree of Concavity, or lastly that by Age the 477Eye grow flatter till it come to a due Figure: For short-sighted Men see 478remote Objects best in Old Age, and therefore they are accounted to have 479the most lasting Eyes. 480 481[Illustration: FIG. 8.] 482 483 484AX. VIII. 485 486_An Object seen by Reflexion or Refraction, appears in that place from 487whence the Rays after their last Reflexion or Refraction diverge in 488falling on the Spectator's Eye._ 489 490[Illustration: FIG. 9.] 491 492If the Object A [in FIG. 9.] be seen by Reflexion of a Looking-glass 493_mn_, it shall appear, not in its proper place A, but behind the Glass 494at _a_, from whence any Rays AB, AC, AD, which flow from one and the 495same Point of the Object, do after their Reflexion made in the Points B, 496C, D, diverge in going from the Glass to E, F, G, where they are 497incident on the Spectator's Eyes. For these Rays do make the same 498Picture in the bottom of the Eyes as if they had come from the Object 499really placed at _a_ without the Interposition of the Looking-glass; and 500all Vision is made according to the place and shape of that Picture. 501 502In like manner the Object D [in FIG. 2.] seen through a Prism, appears 503not in its proper place D, but is thence translated to some other place 504_d_ situated in the last refracted Ray FG drawn backward from F to _d_. 505 506[Illustration: FIG. 10.] 507 508And so the Object Q [in FIG. 10.] seen through the Lens AB, appears at 509the place _q_ from whence the Rays diverge in passing from the Lens to 510the Eye. Now it is to be noted, that the Image of the Object at _q_ is 511so much bigger or lesser than the Object it self at Q, as the distance 512of the Image at _q_ from the Lens AB is bigger or less than the distance 513of the Object at Q from the same Lens. And if the Object be seen through 514two or more such Convex or Concave-glasses, every Glass shall make a new 515Image, and the Object shall appear in the place of the bigness of the 516last Image. Which consideration unfolds the Theory of Microscopes and 517Telescopes. For that Theory consists in almost nothing else than the 518describing such Glasses as shall make the last Image of any Object as 519distinct and large and luminous as it can conveniently be made. 520 521I have now given in Axioms and their Explications the sum of what hath 522hitherto been treated of in Opticks. For what hath been generally 523agreed on I content my self to assume under the notion of Principles, in 524order to what I have farther to write. And this may suffice for an 525Introduction to Readers of quick Wit and good Understanding not yet 526versed in Opticks: Although those who are already acquainted with this 527Science, and have handled Glasses, will more readily apprehend what 528followeth. 529 530FOOTNOTES: 531 532[A] In our Author's _Lectiones Opticæ_, Part I. Sect. IV. Prop 29, 30, 533there is an elegant Method of determining these _Foci_; not only in 534spherical Surfaces, but likewise in any other curved Figure whatever: 535And in Prop. 32, 33, the same thing is done for any Ray lying out of the 536Axis. 537 538[B] _Ibid._ Prop. 34. 539 540 541 542 543_PROPOSITIONS._ 544 545 546 547_PROP._ I. THEOR. I. 548 549_Lights which differ in Colour, differ also in Degrees of 550Refrangibility._ 551 552The PROOF by Experiments. 553 554_Exper._ 1. 555 556I took a black oblong stiff Paper terminated by Parallel Sides, and with 557a Perpendicular right Line drawn cross from one Side to the other, 558distinguished it into two equal Parts. One of these parts I painted with 559a red colour and the other with a blue. The Paper was very black, and 560the Colours intense and thickly laid on, that the Phænomenon might be 561more conspicuous. This Paper I view'd through a Prism of solid Glass, 562whose two Sides through which the Light passed to the Eye were plane and 563well polished, and contained an Angle of about sixty degrees; which 564Angle I call the refracting Angle of the Prism. And whilst I view'd it, 565I held it and the Prism before a Window in such manner that the Sides of 566the Paper were parallel to the Prism, and both those Sides and the Prism 567were parallel to the Horizon, and the cross Line was also parallel to 568it: and that the Light which fell from the Window upon the Paper made an 569Angle with the Paper, equal to that Angle which was made with the same 570Paper by the Light reflected from it to the Eye. Beyond the Prism was 571the Wall of the Chamber under the Window covered over with black Cloth, 572and the Cloth was involved in Darkness that no Light might be reflected 573from thence, which in passing by the Edges of the Paper to the Eye, 574might mingle itself with the Light of the Paper, and obscure the 575Phænomenon thereof. These things being thus ordered, I found that if the 576refracting Angle of the Prism be turned upwards, so that the Paper may 577seem to be lifted upwards by the Refraction, its blue half will be 578lifted higher by the Refraction than its red half. But if the refracting 579Angle of the Prism be turned downward, so that the Paper may seem to be 580carried lower by the Refraction, its blue half will be carried something 581lower thereby than its red half. Wherefore in both Cases the Light which 582comes from the blue half of the Paper through the Prism to the Eye, does 583in like Circumstances suffer a greater Refraction than the Light which 584comes from the red half, and by consequence is more refrangible. 585 586_Illustration._ In the eleventh Figure, MN represents the Window, and DE 587the Paper terminated with parallel Sides DJ and HE, and by the 588transverse Line FG distinguished into two halfs, the one DG of an 589intensely blue Colour, the other FE of an intensely red. And BAC_cab_ 590represents the Prism whose refracting Planes AB_ba_ and AC_ca_ meet in 591the Edge of the refracting Angle A_a_. This Edge A_a_ being upward, is 592parallel both to the Horizon, and to the Parallel-Edges of the Paper DJ 593and HE, and the transverse Line FG is perpendicular to the Plane of the 594Window. And _de_ represents the Image of the Paper seen by Refraction 595upwards in such manner, that the blue half DG is carried higher to _dg_ 596than the red half FE is to _fe_, and therefore suffers a greater 597Refraction. If the Edge of the refracting Angle be turned downward, the 598Image of the Paper will be refracted downward; suppose to [Greek: de], 599and the blue half will be refracted lower to [Greek: dg] than the red 600half is to [Greek: pe]. 601 602[Illustration: FIG. 11.] 603 604_Exper._ 2. About the aforesaid Paper, whose two halfs were painted over 605with red and blue, and which was stiff like thin Pasteboard, I lapped 606several times a slender Thred of very black Silk, in such manner that 607the several parts of the Thred might appear upon the Colours like so 608many black Lines drawn over them, or like long and slender dark Shadows 609cast upon them. I might have drawn black Lines with a Pen, but the 610Threds were smaller and better defined. This Paper thus coloured and 611lined I set against a Wall perpendicularly to the Horizon, so that one 612of the Colours might stand to the Right Hand, and the other to the Left. 613Close before the Paper, at the Confine of the Colours below, I placed a 614Candle to illuminate the Paper strongly: For the Experiment was tried in 615the Night. The Flame of the Candle reached up to the lower edge of the 616Paper, or a very little higher. Then at the distance of six Feet, and 617one or two Inches from the Paper upon the Floor I erected a Glass Lens 618four Inches and a quarter broad, which might collect the Rays coming 619from the several Points of the Paper, and make them converge towards so 620many other Points at the same distance of six Feet, and one or two 621Inches on the other side of the Lens, and so form the Image of the 622coloured Paper upon a white Paper placed there, after the same manner 623that a Lens at a Hole in a Window casts the Images of Objects abroad 624upon a Sheet of white Paper in a dark Room. The aforesaid white Paper, 625erected perpendicular to the Horizon, and to the Rays which fell upon it 626from the Lens, I moved sometimes towards the Lens, sometimes from it, to 627find the Places where the Images of the blue and red Parts of the 628coloured Paper appeared most distinct. Those Places I easily knew by the 629Images of the black Lines which I had made by winding the Silk about the 630Paper. For the Images of those fine and slender Lines (which by reason 631of their Blackness were like Shadows on the Colours) were confused and 632scarce visible, unless when the Colours on either side of each Line were 633terminated most distinctly, Noting therefore, as diligently as I could, 634the Places where the Images of the red and blue halfs of the coloured 635Paper appeared most distinct, I found that where the red half of the 636Paper appeared distinct, the blue half appeared confused, so that the 637black Lines drawn upon it could scarce be seen; and on the contrary, 638where the blue half appeared most distinct, the red half appeared 639confused, so that the black Lines upon it were scarce visible. And 640between the two Places where these Images appeared distinct there was 641the distance of an Inch and a half; the distance of the white Paper from 642the Lens, when the Image of the red half of the coloured Paper appeared 643most distinct, being greater by an Inch and an half than the distance of 644the same white Paper from the Lens, when the Image of the blue half 645appeared most distinct. In like Incidences therefore of the blue and red 646upon the Lens, the blue was refracted more by the Lens than the red, so 647as to converge sooner by an Inch and a half, and therefore is more 648refrangible. 649 650_Illustration._ In the twelfth Figure (p. 27), DE signifies the coloured 651Paper, DG the blue half, FE the red half, MN the Lens, HJ the white 652Paper in that Place where the red half with its black Lines appeared 653distinct, and _hi_ the same Paper in that Place where the blue half 654appeared distinct. The Place _hi_ was nearer to the Lens MN than the 655Place HJ by an Inch and an half. 656 657_Scholium._ The same Things succeed, notwithstanding that some of the 658Circumstances be varied; as in the first Experiment when the Prism and 659Paper are any ways inclined to the Horizon, and in both when coloured 660Lines are drawn upon very black Paper. But in the Description of these 661Experiments, I have set down such Circumstances, by which either the 662Phænomenon might be render'd more conspicuous, or a Novice might more 663easily try them, or by which I did try them only. The same Thing, I have 664often done in the following Experiments: Concerning all which, this one 665Admonition may suffice. Now from these Experiments it follows not, that 666all the Light of the blue is more refrangible than all the Light of the 667red: For both Lights are mixed of Rays differently refrangible, so that 668in the red there are some Rays not less refrangible than those of the 669blue, and in the blue there are some Rays not more refrangible than 670those of the red: But these Rays, in proportion to the whole Light, are 671but few, and serve to diminish the Event of the Experiment, but are not 672able to destroy it. For, if the red and blue Colours were more dilute 673and weak, the distance of the Images would be less than an Inch and a 674half; and if they were more intense and full, that distance would be 675greater, as will appear hereafter. These Experiments may suffice for the 676Colours of Natural Bodies. For in the Colours made by the Refraction of 677Prisms, this Proposition will appear by the Experiments which are now to 678follow in the next Proposition. 679 680 681_PROP._ II. THEOR. II. 682 683_The Light of the Sun consists of Rays differently Refrangible._ 684 685The PROOF by Experiments. 686 687[Illustration: FIG. 12.] 688 689[Illustration: FIG. 13.] 690 691_Exper._ 3. 692 693In a very dark Chamber, at a round Hole, about one third Part of an Inch 694broad, made in the Shut of a Window, I placed a Glass Prism, whereby the 695Beam of the Sun's Light, which came in at that Hole, might be refracted 696upwards toward the opposite Wall of the Chamber, and there form a 697colour'd Image of the Sun. The Axis of the Prism (that is, the Line 698passing through the middle of the Prism from one end of it to the other 699end parallel to the edge of the Refracting Angle) was in this and the 700following Experiments perpendicular to the incident Rays. About this 701Axis I turned the Prism slowly, and saw the refracted Light on the Wall, 702or coloured Image of the Sun, first to descend, and then to ascend. 703Between the Descent and Ascent, when the Image seemed Stationary, I 704stopp'd the Prism, and fix'd it in that Posture, that it should be moved 705no more. For in that Posture the Refractions of the Light at the two 706Sides of the refracting Angle, that is, at the Entrance of the Rays into 707the Prism, and at their going out of it, were equal to one another.[C] 708So also in other Experiments, as often as I would have the Refractions 709on both sides the Prism to be equal to one another, I noted the Place 710where the Image of the Sun formed by the refracted Light stood still 711between its two contrary Motions, in the common Period of its Progress 712and Regress; and when the Image fell upon that Place, I made fast the 713Prism. And in this Posture, as the most convenient, it is to be 714understood that all the Prisms are placed in the following Experiments, 715unless where some other Posture is described. The Prism therefore being 716placed in this Posture, I let the refracted Light fall perpendicularly 717upon a Sheet of white Paper at the opposite Wall of the Chamber, and 718observed the Figure and Dimensions of the Solar Image formed on the 719Paper by that Light. This Image was Oblong and not Oval, but terminated 720with two Rectilinear and Parallel Sides, and two Semicircular Ends. On 721its Sides it was bounded pretty distinctly, but on its Ends very 722confusedly and indistinctly, the Light there decaying and vanishing by 723degrees. The Breadth of this Image answered to the Sun's Diameter, and 724was about two Inches and the eighth Part of an Inch, including the 725Penumbra. For the Image was eighteen Feet and an half distant from the 726Prism, and at this distance that Breadth, if diminished by the Diameter 727of the Hole in the Window-shut, that is by a quarter of an Inch, 728subtended an Angle at the Prism of about half a Degree, which is the 729Sun's apparent Diameter. But the Length of the Image was about ten 730Inches and a quarter, and the Length of the Rectilinear Sides about 731eight Inches; and the refracting Angle of the Prism, whereby so great a 732Length was made, was 64 degrees. With a less Angle the Length of the 733Image was less, the Breadth remaining the same. If the Prism was turned 734about its Axis that way which made the Rays emerge more obliquely out of 735the second refracting Surface of the Prism, the Image soon became an 736Inch or two longer, or more; and if the Prism was turned about the 737contrary way, so as to make the Rays fall more obliquely on the first 738refracting Surface, the Image soon became an Inch or two shorter. And 739therefore in trying this Experiment, I was as curious as I could be in 740placing the Prism by the above-mention'd Rule exactly in such a Posture, 741that the Refractions of the Rays at their Emergence out of the Prism 742might be equal to that at their Incidence on it. This Prism had some 743Veins running along within the Glass from one end to the other, which 744scattered some of the Sun's Light irregularly, but had no sensible 745Effect in increasing the Length of the coloured Spectrum. For I tried 746the same Experiment with other Prisms with the same Success. And 747particularly with a Prism which seemed free from such Veins, and whose 748refracting Angle was 62-1/2 Degrees, I found the Length of the Image 7499-3/4 or 10 Inches at the distance of 18-1/2 Feet from the Prism, the 750Breadth of the Hole in the Window-shut being 1/4 of an Inch, as before. 751And because it is easy to commit a Mistake in placing the Prism in its 752due Posture, I repeated the Experiment four or five Times, and always 753found the Length of the Image that which is set down above. With another 754Prism of clearer Glass and better Polish, which seemed free from Veins, 755and whose refracting Angle was 63-1/2 Degrees, the Length of this Image 756at the same distance of 18-1/2 Feet was also about 10 Inches, or 10-1/8. 757Beyond these Measures for about a 1/4 or 1/3 of an Inch at either end of 758the Spectrum the Light of the Clouds seemed to be a little tinged with 759red and violet, but so very faintly, that I suspected that Tincture 760might either wholly, or in great Measure arise from some Rays of the 761Spectrum scattered irregularly by some Inequalities in the Substance and 762Polish of the Glass, and therefore I did not include it in these 763Measures. Now the different Magnitude of the hole in the Window-shut, 764and different thickness of the Prism where the Rays passed through it, 765and different inclinations of the Prism to the Horizon, made no sensible 766changes in the length of the Image. Neither did the different matter of 767the Prisms make any: for in a Vessel made of polished Plates of Glass 768cemented together in the shape of a Prism and filled with Water, there 769is the like Success of the Experiment according to the quantity of the 770Refraction. It is farther to be observed, that the Rays went on in right 771Lines from the Prism to the Image, and therefore at their very going out 772of the Prism had all that Inclination to one another from which the 773length of the Image proceeded, that is, the Inclination of more than two 774degrees and an half. And yet according to the Laws of Opticks vulgarly 775received, they could not possibly be so much inclined to one another.[D] 776For let EG [_Fig._ 13. (p. 27)] represent the Window-shut, F the hole 777made therein through which a beam of the Sun's Light was transmitted 778into the darkened Chamber, and ABC a Triangular Imaginary Plane whereby 779the Prism is feigned to be cut transversely through the middle of the 780Light. Or if you please, let ABC represent the Prism it self, looking 781directly towards the Spectator's Eye with its nearer end: And let XY be 782the Sun, MN the Paper upon which the Solar Image or Spectrum is cast, 783and PT the Image it self whose sides towards _v_ and _w_ are Rectilinear 784and Parallel, and ends towards P and T Semicircular. YKHP and XLJT are 785two Rays, the first of which comes from the lower part of the Sun to the 786higher part of the Image, and is refracted in the Prism at K and H, and 787the latter comes from the higher part of the Sun to the lower part of 788the Image, and is refracted at L and J. Since the Refractions on both 789sides the Prism are equal to one another, that is, the Refraction at K 790equal to the Refraction at J, and the Refraction at L equal to the 791Refraction at H, so that the Refractions of the incident Rays at K and L 792taken together, are equal to the Refractions of the emergent Rays at H 793and J taken together: it follows by adding equal things to equal things, 794that the Refractions at K and H taken together, are equal to the 795Refractions at J and L taken together, and therefore the two Rays being 796equally refracted, have the same Inclination to one another after 797Refraction which they had before; that is, the Inclination of half a 798Degree answering to the Sun's Diameter. For so great was the inclination 799of the Rays to one another before Refraction. So then, the length of the 800Image PT would by the Rules of Vulgar Opticks subtend an Angle of half a 801Degree at the Prism, and by Consequence be equal to the breadth _vw_; 802and therefore the Image would be round. Thus it would be were the two 803Rays XLJT and YKHP, and all the rest which form the Image P_w_T_v_, 804alike refrangible. And therefore seeing by Experience it is found that 805the Image is not round, but about five times longer than broad, the Rays 806which going to the upper end P of the Image suffer the greatest 807Refraction, must be more refrangible than those which go to the lower 808end T, unless the Inequality of Refraction be casual. 809 810This Image or Spectrum PT was coloured, being red at its least refracted 811end T, and violet at its most refracted end P, and yellow green and 812blue in the intermediate Spaces. Which agrees with the first 813Proposition, that Lights which differ in Colour, do also differ in 814Refrangibility. The length of the Image in the foregoing Experiments, I 815measured from the faintest and outmost red at one end, to the faintest 816and outmost blue at the other end, excepting only a little Penumbra, 817whose breadth scarce exceeded a quarter of an Inch, as was said above. 818 819_Exper._ 4. In the Sun's Beam which was propagated into the Room through 820the hole in the Window-shut, at the distance of some Feet from the hole, 821I held the Prism in such a Posture, that its Axis might be perpendicular 822to that Beam. Then I looked through the Prism upon the hole, and turning 823the Prism to and fro about its Axis, to make the Image of the Hole 824ascend and descend, when between its two contrary Motions it seemed 825Stationary, I stopp'd the Prism, that the Refractions of both sides of 826the refracting Angle might be equal to each other, as in the former 827Experiment. In this situation of the Prism viewing through it the said 828Hole, I observed the length of its refracted Image to be many times 829greater than its breadth, and that the most refracted part thereof 830appeared violet, the least refracted red, the middle parts blue, green 831and yellow in order. The same thing happen'd when I removed the Prism 832out of the Sun's Light, and looked through it upon the hole shining by 833the Light of the Clouds beyond it. And yet if the Refraction were done 834regularly according to one certain Proportion of the Sines of Incidence 835and Refraction as is vulgarly supposed, the refracted Image ought to 836have appeared round. 837 838So then, by these two Experiments it appears, that in Equal Incidences 839there is a considerable inequality of Refractions. But whence this 840inequality arises, whether it be that some of the incident Rays are 841refracted more, and others less, constantly, or by chance, or that one 842and the same Ray is by Refraction disturbed, shatter'd, dilated, and as 843it were split and spread into many diverging Rays, as _Grimaldo_ 844supposes, does not yet appear by these Experiments, but will appear by 845those that follow. 846 847_Exper._ 5. Considering therefore, that if in the third Experiment the 848Image of the Sun should be drawn out into an oblong Form, either by a 849Dilatation of every Ray, or by any other casual inequality of the 850Refractions, the same oblong Image would by a second Refraction made 851sideways be drawn out as much in breadth by the like Dilatation of the 852Rays, or other casual inequality of the Refractions sideways, I tried 853what would be the Effects of such a second Refraction. For this end I 854ordered all things as in the third Experiment, and then placed a second 855Prism immediately after the first in a cross Position to it, that it 856might again refract the beam of the Sun's Light which came to it through 857the first Prism. In the first Prism this beam was refracted upwards, and 858in the second sideways. And I found that by the Refraction of the second 859Prism, the breadth of the Image was not increased, but its superior 860part, which in the first Prism suffered the greater Refraction, and 861appeared violet and blue, did again in the second Prism suffer a greater 862Refraction than its inferior part, which appeared red and yellow, and 863this without any Dilatation of the Image in breadth. 864 865[Illustration: FIG. 14] 866 867_Illustration._ Let S [_Fig._ 14, 15.] represent the Sun, F the hole in 868the Window, ABC the first Prism, DH the second Prism, Y the round Image 869of the Sun made by a direct beam of Light when the Prisms are taken 870away, PT the oblong Image of the Sun made by that beam passing through 871the first Prism alone, when the second Prism is taken away, and _pt_ the 872Image made by the cross Refractions of both Prisms together. Now if the 873Rays which tend towards the several Points of the round Image Y were 874dilated and spread by the Refraction of the first Prism, so that they 875should not any longer go in single Lines to single Points, but that 876every Ray being split, shattered, and changed from a Linear Ray to a 877Superficies of Rays diverging from the Point of Refraction, and lying in 878the Plane of the Angles of Incidence and Refraction, they should go in 879those Planes to so many Lines reaching almost from one end of the Image 880PT to the other, and if that Image should thence become oblong: those 881Rays and their several parts tending towards the several Points of the 882Image PT ought to be again dilated and spread sideways by the transverse 883Refraction of the second Prism, so as to compose a four square Image, 884such as is represented at [Greek: pt]. For the better understanding of 885which, let the Image PT be distinguished into five equal parts PQK, 886KQRL, LRSM, MSVN, NVT. And by the same irregularity that the orbicular 887Light Y is by the Refraction of the first Prism dilated and drawn out 888into a long Image PT, the Light PQK which takes up a space of the same 889length and breadth with the Light Y ought to be by the Refraction of the 890second Prism dilated and drawn out into the long Image _[Greek: p]qkp_, 891and the Light KQRL into the long Image _kqrl_, and the Lights LRSM, 892MSVN, NVT, into so many other long Images _lrsm_, _msvn_, _nvt[Greek: 893t]_; and all these long Images would compose the four square Images 894_[Greek: pt]_. Thus it ought to be were every Ray dilated by Refraction, 895and spread into a triangular Superficies of Rays diverging from the 896Point of Refraction. For the second Refraction would spread the Rays one 897way as much as the first doth another, and so dilate the Image in 898breadth as much as the first doth in length. And the same thing ought to 899happen, were some rays casually refracted more than others. But the 900Event is otherwise. The Image PT was not made broader by the Refraction 901of the second Prism, but only became oblique, as 'tis represented at 902_pt_, its upper end P being by the Refraction translated to a greater 903distance than its lower end T. So then the Light which went towards the 904upper end P of the Image, was (at equal Incidences) more refracted in 905the second Prism, than the Light which tended towards the lower end T, 906that is the blue and violet, than the red and yellow; and therefore was 907more refrangible. The same Light was by the Refraction of the first 908Prism translated farther from the place Y to which it tended before 909Refraction; and therefore suffered as well in the first Prism as in the 910second a greater Refraction than the rest of the Light, and by 911consequence was more refrangible than the rest, even before its 912incidence on the first Prism. 913 914Sometimes I placed a third Prism after the second, and sometimes also a 915fourth after the third, by all which the Image might be often refracted 916sideways: but the Rays which were more refracted than the rest in the 917first Prism were also more refracted in all the rest, and that without 918any Dilatation of the Image sideways: and therefore those Rays for their 919constancy of a greater Refraction are deservedly reputed more 920refrangible. 921 922[Illustration: FIG. 15] 923 924But that the meaning of this Experiment may more clearly appear, it is 925to be considered that the Rays which are equally refrangible do fall 926upon a Circle answering to the Sun's Disque. For this was proved in the 927third Experiment. By a Circle I understand not here a perfect 928geometrical Circle, but any orbicular Figure whose length is equal to 929its breadth, and which, as to Sense, may seem circular. Let therefore AG 930[in _Fig._ 15.] represent the Circle which all the most refrangible Rays 931propagated from the whole Disque of the Sun, would illuminate and paint 932upon the opposite Wall if they were alone; EL the Circle which all the 933least refrangible Rays would in like manner illuminate and paint if they 934were alone; BH, CJ, DK, the Circles which so many intermediate sorts of 935Rays would successively paint upon the Wall, if they were singly 936propagated from the Sun in successive order, the rest being always 937intercepted; and conceive that there are other intermediate Circles 938without Number, which innumerable other intermediate sorts of Rays would 939successively paint upon the Wall if the Sun should successively emit 940every sort apart. And seeing the Sun emits all these sorts at once, they 941must all together illuminate and paint innumerable equal Circles, of all 942which, being according to their degrees of Refrangibility placed in 943order in a continual Series, that oblong Spectrum PT is composed which I 944described in the third Experiment. Now if the Sun's circular Image Y [in 945_Fig._ 15.] which is made by an unrefracted beam of Light was by any 946Dilation of the single Rays, or by any other irregularity in the 947Refraction of the first Prism, converted into the oblong Spectrum, PT: 948then ought every Circle AG, BH, CJ, &c. in that Spectrum, by the cross 949Refraction of the second Prism again dilating or otherwise scattering 950the Rays as before, to be in like manner drawn out and transformed into 951an oblong Figure, and thereby the breadth of the Image PT would be now 952as much augmented as the length of the Image Y was before by the 953Refraction of the first Prism; and thus by the Refractions of both 954Prisms together would be formed a four square Figure _p[Greek: 955p]t[Greek: t]_, as I described above. Wherefore since the breadth of the 956Spectrum PT is not increased by the Refraction sideways, it is certain 957that the Rays are not split or dilated, or otherways irregularly 958scatter'd by that Refraction, but that every Circle is by a regular and 959uniform Refraction translated entire into another Place, as the Circle 960AG by the greatest Refraction into the place _ag_, the Circle BH by a 961less Refraction into the place _bh_, the Circle CJ by a Refraction still 962less into the place _ci_, and so of the rest; by which means a new 963Spectrum _pt_ inclined to the former PT is in like manner composed of 964Circles lying in a right Line; and these Circles must be of the same 965bigness with the former, because the breadths of all the Spectrums Y, PT 966and _pt_ at equal distances from the Prisms are equal. 967 968I considered farther, that by the breadth of the hole F through which 969the Light enters into the dark Chamber, there is a Penumbra made in the 970Circuit of the Spectrum Y, and that Penumbra remains in the rectilinear 971Sides of the Spectrums PT and _pt_. I placed therefore at that hole a 972Lens or Object-glass of a Telescope which might cast the Image of the 973Sun distinctly on Y without any Penumbra at all, and found that the 974Penumbra of the rectilinear Sides of the oblong Spectrums PT and _pt_ 975was also thereby taken away, so that those Sides appeared as distinctly 976defined as did the Circumference of the first Image Y. Thus it happens 977if the Glass of the Prisms be free from Veins, and their sides be 978accurately plane and well polished without those numberless Waves or 979Curles which usually arise from Sand-holes a little smoothed in 980polishing with Putty. If the Glass be only well polished and free from 981Veins, and the Sides not accurately plane, but a little Convex or 982Concave, as it frequently happens; yet may the three Spectrums Y, PT and 983_pt_ want Penumbras, but not in equal distances from the Prisms. Now 984from this want of Penumbras, I knew more certainly that every one of the 985Circles was refracted according to some most regular, uniform and 986constant Law. For if there were any irregularity in the Refraction, the 987right Lines AE and GL, which all the Circles in the Spectrum PT do 988touch, could not by that Refraction be translated into the Lines _ae_ 989and _gl_ as distinct and straight as they were before, but there would 990arise in those translated Lines some Penumbra or Crookedness or 991Undulation, or other sensible Perturbation contrary to what is found by 992Experience. Whatsoever Penumbra or Perturbation should be made in the 993Circles by the cross Refraction of the second Prism, all that Penumbra 994or Perturbation would be conspicuous in the right Lines _ae_ and _gl_ 995which touch those Circles. And therefore since there is no such Penumbra 996or Perturbation in those right Lines, there must be none in the 997Circles. Since the distance between those Tangents or breadth of the 998Spectrum is not increased by the Refractions, the Diameters of the 999Circles are not increased thereby. Since those Tangents continue to be 1000right Lines, every Circle which in the first Prism is more or less 1001refracted, is exactly in the same proportion more or less refracted in 1002the second. And seeing all these things continue to succeed after the 1003same manner when the Rays are again in a third Prism, and again in a 1004fourth refracted sideways, it is evident that the Rays of one and the 1005same Circle, as to their degree of Refrangibility, continue always 1006uniform and homogeneal to one another, and that those of several Circles 1007do differ in degree of Refrangibility, and that in some certain and 1008constant Proportion. Which is the thing I was to prove. 1009 1010There is yet another Circumstance or two of this Experiment by which it 1011becomes still more plain and convincing. Let the second Prism DH [in 1012_Fig._ 16.] be placed not immediately after the first, but at some 1013distance from it; suppose in the mid-way between it and the Wall on 1014which the oblong Spectrum PT is cast, so that the Light from the first 1015Prism may fall upon it in the form of an oblong Spectrum [Greek: pt] 1016parallel to this second Prism, and be refracted sideways to form the 1017oblong Spectrum _pt_ upon the Wall. And you will find as before, that 1018this Spectrum _pt_ is inclined to that Spectrum PT, which the first 1019Prism forms alone without the second; the blue ends P and _p_ being 1020farther distant from one another than the red ones T and _t_, and by 1021consequence that the Rays which go to the blue end [Greek: p] of the 1022Image [Greek: pt], and which therefore suffer the greatest Refraction in 1023the first Prism, are again in the second Prism more refracted than the 1024rest. 1025 1026[Illustration: FIG. 16.] 1027 1028[Illustration: FIG. 17.] 1029 1030The same thing I try'd also by letting the Sun's Light into a dark Room 1031through two little round holes F and [Greek: ph] [in _Fig._ 17.] made in 1032the Window, and with two parallel Prisms ABC and [Greek: abg] placed at 1033those holes (one at each) refracting those two beams of Light to the 1034opposite Wall of the Chamber, in such manner that the two colour'd 1035Images PT and MN which they there painted were joined end to end and lay 1036in one straight Line, the red end T of the one touching the blue end M 1037of the other. For if these two refracted Beams were again by a third 1038Prism DH placed cross to the two first, refracted sideways, and the 1039Spectrums thereby translated to some other part of the Wall of the 1040Chamber, suppose the Spectrum PT to _pt_ and the Spectrum MN to _mn_, 1041these translated Spectrums _pt_ and _mn_ would not lie in one straight 1042Line with their ends contiguous as before, but be broken off from one 1043another and become parallel, the blue end _m_ of the Image _mn_ being by 1044a greater Refraction translated farther from its former place MT, than 1045the red end _t_ of the other Image _pt_ from the same place MT; which 1046puts the Proposition past Dispute. And this happens whether the third 1047Prism DH be placed immediately after the two first, or at a great 1048distance from them, so that the Light refracted in the two first Prisms 1049be either white and circular, or coloured and oblong when it falls on 1050the third. 1051 1052_Exper._ 6. In the middle of two thin Boards I made round holes a third 1053part of an Inch in diameter, and in the Window-shut a much broader hole 1054being made to let into my darkned Chamber a large Beam of the Sun's 1055Light; I placed a Prism behind the Shut in that beam to refract it 1056towards the opposite Wall, and close behind the Prism I fixed one of the 1057Boards, in such manner that the middle of the refracted Light might pass 1058through the hole made in it, and the rest be intercepted by the Board. 1059Then at the distance of about twelve Feet from the first Board I fixed 1060the other Board in such manner that the middle of the refracted Light 1061which came through the hole in the first Board, and fell upon the 1062opposite Wall, might pass through the hole in this other Board, and the 1063rest being intercepted by the Board might paint upon it the coloured 1064Spectrum of the Sun. And close behind this Board I fixed another Prism 1065to refract the Light which came through the hole. Then I returned 1066speedily to the first Prism, and by turning it slowly to and fro about 1067its Axis, I caused the Image which fell upon the second Board to move up 1068and down upon that Board, that all its parts might successively pass 1069through the hole in that Board and fall upon the Prism behind it. And in 1070the mean time, I noted the places on the opposite Wall to which that 1071Light after its Refraction in the second Prism did pass; and by the 1072difference of the places I found that the Light which being most 1073refracted in the first Prism did go to the blue end of the Image, was 1074again more refracted in the second Prism than the Light which went to 1075the red end of that Image, which proves as well the first Proposition as 1076the second. And this happened whether the Axis of the two Prisms were 1077parallel, or inclined to one another, and to the Horizon in any given 1078Angles. 1079 1080_Illustration._ Let F [in _Fig._ 18.] be the wide hole in the 1081Window-shut, through which the Sun shines upon the first Prism ABC, and 1082let the refracted Light fall upon the middle of the Board DE, and the 1083middle part of that Light upon the hole G made in the middle part of 1084that Board. Let this trajected part of that Light fall again upon the 1085middle of the second Board _de_, and there paint such an oblong coloured 1086Image of the Sun as was described in the third Experiment. By turning 1087the Prism ABC slowly to and fro about its Axis, this Image will be made 1088to move up and down the Board _de_, and by this means all its parts from 1089one end to the other may be made to pass successively through the hole 1090_g_ which is made in the middle of that Board. In the mean while another 1091Prism _abc_ is to be fixed next after that hole _g_, to refract the 1092trajected Light a second time. And these things being thus ordered, I 1093marked the places M and N of the opposite Wall upon which the refracted 1094Light fell, and found that whilst the two Boards and second Prism 1095remained unmoved, those places by turning the first Prism about its Axis 1096were changed perpetually. For when the lower part of the Light which 1097fell upon the second Board _de_ was cast through the hole _g_, it went 1098to a lower place M on the Wall and when the higher part of that Light 1099was cast through the same hole _g_, it went to a higher place N on the 1100Wall, and when any intermediate part of the Light was cast through that 1101hole, it went to some place on the Wall between M and N. The unchanged 1102Position of the holes in the Boards, made the Incidence of the Rays upon 1103the second Prism to be the same in all cases. And yet in that common 1104Incidence some of the Rays were more refracted, and others less. And 1105those were more refracted in this Prism, which by a greater Refraction 1106in the first Prism were more turned out of the way, and therefore for 1107their Constancy of being more refracted are deservedly called more 1108refrangible. 1109 1110[Illustration: FIG. 18.] 1111 1112[Illustration: FIG. 20.] 1113 1114_Exper._ 7. At two holes made near one another in my Window-shut I 1115placed two Prisms, one at each, which might cast upon the opposite Wall 1116(after the manner of the third Experiment) two oblong coloured Images of 1117the Sun. And at a little distance from the Wall I placed a long slender 1118Paper with straight and parallel edges, and ordered the Prisms and Paper 1119so, that the red Colour of one Image might fall directly upon one half 1120of the Paper, and the violet Colour of the other Image upon the other 1121half of the same Paper; so that the Paper appeared of two Colours, red 1122and violet, much after the manner of the painted Paper in the first and 1123second Experiments. Then with a black Cloth I covered the Wall behind 1124the Paper, that no Light might be reflected from it to disturb the 1125Experiment, and viewing the Paper through a third Prism held parallel 1126to it, I saw that half of it which was illuminated by the violet Light 1127to be divided from the other half by a greater Refraction, especially 1128when I went a good way off from the Paper. For when I viewed it too near 1129at hand, the two halfs of the Paper did not appear fully divided from 1130one another, but seemed contiguous at one of their Angles like the 1131painted Paper in the first Experiment. Which also happened when the 1132Paper was too broad. 1133 1134[Illustration: FIG. 19.] 1135 1136Sometimes instead of the Paper I used a white Thred, and this appeared 1137through the Prism divided into two parallel Threds as is represented in 1138the nineteenth Figure, where DG denotes the Thred illuminated with 1139violet Light from D to E and with red Light from F to G, and _defg_ are 1140the parts of the Thred seen by Refraction. If one half of the Thred be 1141constantly illuminated with red, and the other half be illuminated with 1142all the Colours successively, (which may be done by causing one of the 1143Prisms to be turned about its Axis whilst the other remains unmoved) 1144this other half in viewing the Thred through the Prism, will appear in 1145a continual right Line with the first half when illuminated with red, 1146and begin to be a little divided from it when illuminated with Orange, 1147and remove farther from it when illuminated with yellow, and still 1148farther when with green, and farther when with blue, and go yet farther 1149off when illuminated with Indigo, and farthest when with deep violet. 1150Which plainly shews, that the Lights of several Colours are more and 1151more refrangible one than another, in this Order of their Colours, red, 1152orange, yellow, green, blue, indigo, deep violet; and so proves as well 1153the first Proposition as the second. 1154 1155I caused also the coloured Spectrums PT [in _Fig._ 17.] and MN made in a 1156dark Chamber by the Refractions of two Prisms to lie in a Right Line end 1157to end, as was described above in the fifth Experiment, and viewing them 1158through a third Prism held parallel to their Length, they appeared no 1159longer in a Right Line, but became broken from one another, as they are 1160represented at _pt_ and _mn_, the violet end _m_ of the Spectrum _mn_ 1161being by a greater Refraction translated farther from its former Place 1162MT than the red end _t_ of the other Spectrum _pt_. 1163 1164I farther caused those two Spectrums PT [in _Fig._ 20.] and MN to become 1165co-incident in an inverted Order of their Colours, the red end of each 1166falling on the violet end of the other, as they are represented in the 1167oblong Figure PTMN; and then viewing them through a Prism DH held 1168parallel to their Length, they appeared not co-incident, as when view'd 1169with the naked Eye, but in the form of two distinct Spectrums _pt_ and 1170_mn_ crossing one another in the middle after the manner of the Letter 1171X. Which shews that the red of the one Spectrum and violet of the other, 1172which were co-incident at PN and MT, being parted from one another by a 1173greater Refraction of the violet to _p_ and _m_ than of the red to _n_ 1174and _t_, do differ in degrees of Refrangibility. 1175 1176I illuminated also a little Circular Piece of white Paper all over with 1177the Lights of both Prisms intermixed, and when it was illuminated with 1178the red of one Spectrum, and deep violet of the other, so as by the 1179Mixture of those Colours to appear all over purple, I viewed the Paper, 1180first at a less distance, and then at a greater, through a third Prism; 1181and as I went from the Paper, the refracted Image thereof became more 1182and more divided by the unequal Refraction of the two mixed Colours, and 1183at length parted into two distinct Images, a red one and a violet one, 1184whereof the violet was farthest from the Paper, and therefore suffered 1185the greatest Refraction. And when that Prism at the Window, which cast 1186the violet on the Paper was taken away, the violet Image disappeared; 1187but when the other Prism was taken away the red vanished; which shews, 1188that these two Images were nothing else than the Lights of the two 1189Prisms, which had been intermixed on the purple Paper, but were parted 1190again by their unequal Refractions made in the third Prism, through 1191which the Paper was view'd. This also was observable, that if one of the 1192Prisms at the Window, suppose that which cast the violet on the Paper, 1193was turned about its Axis to make all the Colours in this order, 1194violet, indigo, blue, green, yellow, orange, red, fall successively on 1195the Paper from that Prism, the violet Image changed Colour accordingly, 1196turning successively to indigo, blue, green, yellow and red, and in 1197changing Colour came nearer and nearer to the red Image made by the 1198other Prism, until when it was also red both Images became fully 1199co-incident. 1200 1201I placed also two Paper Circles very near one another, the one in the 1202red Light of one Prism, and the other in the violet Light of the other. 1203The Circles were each of them an Inch in diameter, and behind them the 1204Wall was dark, that the Experiment might not be disturbed by any Light 1205coming from thence. These Circles thus illuminated, I viewed through a 1206Prism, so held, that the Refraction might be made towards the red 1207Circle, and as I went from them they came nearer and nearer together, 1208and at length became co-incident; and afterwards when I went still 1209farther off, they parted again in a contrary Order, the violet by a 1210greater Refraction being carried beyond the red. 1211 1212_Exper._ 8. In Summer, when the Sun's Light uses to be strongest, I 1213placed a Prism at the Hole of the Window-shut, as in the third 1214Experiment, yet so that its Axis might be parallel to the Axis of the 1215World, and at the opposite Wall in the Sun's refracted Light, I placed 1216an open Book. Then going six Feet and two Inches from the Book, I placed 1217there the above-mentioned Lens, by which the Light reflected from the 1218Book might be made to converge and meet again at the distance of six 1219Feet and two Inches behind the Lens, and there paint the Species of the 1220Book upon a Sheet of white Paper much after the manner of the second 1221Experiment. The Book and Lens being made fast, I noted the Place where 1222the Paper was, when the Letters of the Book, illuminated by the fullest 1223red Light of the Solar Image falling upon it, did cast their Species on 1224that Paper most distinctly: And then I stay'd till by the Motion of the 1225Sun, and consequent Motion of his Image on the Book, all the Colours 1226from that red to the middle of the blue pass'd over those Letters; and 1227when those Letters were illuminated by that blue, I noted again the 1228Place of the Paper when they cast their Species most distinctly upon it: 1229And I found that this last Place of the Paper was nearer to the Lens 1230than its former Place by about two Inches and an half, or two and three 1231quarters. So much sooner therefore did the Light in the violet end of 1232the Image by a greater Refraction converge and meet, than the Light in 1233the red end. But in trying this, the Chamber was as dark as I could make 1234it. For, if these Colours be diluted and weakned by the Mixture of any 1235adventitious Light, the distance between the Places of the Paper will 1236not be so great. This distance in the second Experiment, where the 1237Colours of natural Bodies were made use of, was but an Inch and an half, 1238by reason of the Imperfection of those Colours. Here in the Colours of 1239the Prism, which are manifestly more full, intense, and lively than 1240those of natural Bodies, the distance is two Inches and three quarters. 1241And were the Colours still more full, I question not but that the 1242distance would be considerably greater. For the coloured Light of the 1243Prism, by the interfering of the Circles described in the second Figure 1244of the fifth Experiment, and also by the Light of the very bright Clouds 1245next the Sun's Body intermixing with these Colours, and by the Light 1246scattered by the Inequalities in the Polish of the Prism, was so very 1247much compounded, that the Species which those faint and dark Colours, 1248the indigo and violet, cast upon the Paper were not distinct enough to 1249be well observed. 1250 1251_Exper._ 9. A Prism, whose two Angles at its Base were equal to one 1252another, and half right ones, and the third a right one, I placed in a 1253Beam of the Sun's Light let into a dark Chamber through a Hole in the 1254Window-shut, as in the third Experiment. And turning the Prism slowly 1255about its Axis, until all the Light which went through one of its 1256Angles, and was refracted by it began to be reflected by its Base, at 1257which till then it went out of the Glass, I observed that those Rays 1258which had suffered the greatest Refraction were sooner reflected than 1259the rest. I conceived therefore, that those Rays of the reflected Light, 1260which were most refrangible, did first of all by a total Reflexion 1261become more copious in that Light than the rest, and that afterwards the 1262rest also, by a total Reflexion, became as copious as these. To try 1263this, I made the reflected Light pass through another Prism, and being 1264refracted by it to fall afterwards upon a Sheet of white Paper placed 1265at some distance behind it, and there by that Refraction to paint the 1266usual Colours of the Prism. And then causing the first Prism to be 1267turned about its Axis as above, I observed that when those Rays, which 1268in this Prism had suffered the greatest Refraction, and appeared of a 1269blue and violet Colour began to be totally reflected, the blue and 1270violet Light on the Paper, which was most refracted in the second Prism, 1271received a sensible Increase above that of the red and yellow, which was 1272least refracted; and afterwards, when the rest of the Light which was 1273green, yellow, and red, began to be totally reflected in the first 1274Prism, the Light of those Colours on the Paper received as great an 1275Increase as the violet and blue had done before. Whence 'tis manifest, 1276that the Beam of Light reflected by the Base of the Prism, being 1277augmented first by the more refrangible Rays, and afterwards by the less 1278refrangible ones, is compounded of Rays differently refrangible. And 1279that all such reflected Light is of the same Nature with the Sun's Light 1280before its Incidence on the Base of the Prism, no Man ever doubted; it 1281being generally allowed, that Light by such Reflexions suffers no 1282Alteration in its Modifications and Properties. I do not here take 1283Notice of any Refractions made in the sides of the first Prism, because 1284the Light enters it perpendicularly at the first side, and goes out 1285perpendicularly at the second side, and therefore suffers none. So then, 1286the Sun's incident Light being of the same Temper and Constitution with 1287his emergent Light, and the last being compounded of Rays differently 1288refrangible, the first must be in like manner compounded. 1289 1290[Illustration: FIG. 21.] 1291 1292_Illustration._ In the twenty-first Figure, ABC is the first Prism, BC 1293its Base, B and C its equal Angles at the Base, each of 45 Degrees, A 1294its rectangular Vertex, FM a beam of the Sun's Light let into a dark 1295Room through a hole F one third part of an Inch broad, M its Incidence 1296on the Base of the Prism, MG a less refracted Ray, MH a more refracted 1297Ray, MN the beam of Light reflected from the Base, VXY the second Prism 1298by which this beam in passing through it is refracted, N_t_ the less 1299refracted Light of this beam, and N_p_ the more refracted part thereof. 1300When the first Prism ABC is turned about its Axis according to the order 1301of the Letters ABC, the Rays MH emerge more and more obliquely out of 1302that Prism, and at length after their most oblique Emergence are 1303reflected towards N, and going on to _p_ do increase the Number of the 1304Rays N_p_. Afterwards by continuing the Motion of the first Prism, the 1305Rays MG are also reflected to N and increase the number of the Rays 1306N_t_. And therefore the Light MN admits into its Composition, first the 1307more refrangible Rays, and then the less refrangible Rays, and yet after 1308this Composition is of the same Nature with the Sun's immediate Light 1309FM, the Reflexion of the specular Base BC causing no Alteration therein. 1310 1311_Exper._ 10. Two Prisms, which were alike in Shape, I tied so together, 1312that their Axis and opposite Sides being parallel, they composed a 1313Parallelopiped. And, the Sun shining into my dark Chamber through a 1314little hole in the Window-shut, I placed that Parallelopiped in his beam 1315at some distance from the hole, in such a Posture, that the Axes of the 1316Prisms might be perpendicular to the incident Rays, and that those Rays 1317being incident upon the first Side of one Prism, might go on through the 1318two contiguous Sides of both Prisms, and emerge out of the last Side of 1319the second Prism. This Side being parallel to the first Side of the 1320first Prism, caused the emerging Light to be parallel to the incident. 1321Then, beyond these two Prisms I placed a third, which might refract that 1322emergent Light, and by that Refraction cast the usual Colours of the 1323Prism upon the opposite Wall, or upon a sheet of white Paper held at a 1324convenient Distance behind the Prism for that refracted Light to fall 1325upon it. After this I turned the Parallelopiped about its Axis, and 1326found that when the contiguous Sides of the two Prisms became so oblique 1327to the incident Rays, that those Rays began all of them to be 1328reflected, those Rays which in the third Prism had suffered the greatest 1329Refraction, and painted the Paper with violet and blue, were first of 1330all by a total Reflexion taken out of the transmitted Light, the rest 1331remaining and on the Paper painting their Colours of green, yellow, 1332orange and red, as before; and afterwards by continuing the Motion of 1333the two Prisms, the rest of the Rays also by a total Reflexion vanished 1334in order, according to their degrees of Refrangibility. The Light 1335therefore which emerged out of the two Prisms is compounded of Rays 1336differently refrangible, seeing the more refrangible Rays may be taken 1337out of it, while the less refrangible remain. But this Light being 1338trajected only through the parallel Superficies of the two Prisms, if it 1339suffer'd any change by the Refraction of one Superficies it lost that 1340Impression by the contrary Refraction of the other Superficies, and so 1341being restor'd to its pristine Constitution, became of the same Nature 1342and Condition as at first before its Incidence on those Prisms; and 1343therefore, before its Incidence, was as much compounded of Rays 1344differently refrangible, as afterwards. 1345 1346[Illustration: FIG. 22.] 1347 1348_Illustration._ In the twenty second Figure ABC and BCD are the two 1349Prisms tied together in the form of a Parallelopiped, their Sides BC and 1350CB being contiguous, and their Sides AB and CD parallel. And HJK is the 1351third Prism, by which the Sun's Light propagated through the hole F into 1352the dark Chamber, and there passing through those sides of the Prisms 1353AB, BC, CB and CD, is refracted at O to the white Paper PT, falling 1354there partly upon P by a greater Refraction, partly upon T by a less 1355Refraction, and partly upon R and other intermediate places by 1356intermediate Refractions. By turning the Parallelopiped ACBD about its 1357Axis, according to the order of the Letters A, C, D, B, at length when 1358the contiguous Planes BC and CB become sufficiently oblique to the Rays 1359FM, which are incident upon them at M, there will vanish totally out of 1360the refracted Light OPT, first of all the most refracted Rays OP, (the 1361rest OR and OT remaining as before) then the Rays OR and other 1362intermediate ones, and lastly, the least refracted Rays OT. For when 1363the Plane BC becomes sufficiently oblique to the Rays incident upon it, 1364those Rays will begin to be totally reflected by it towards N; and first 1365the most refrangible Rays will be totally reflected (as was explained in 1366the preceding Experiment) and by Consequence must first disappear at P, 1367and afterwards the rest as they are in order totally reflected to N, 1368they must disappear in the same order at R and T. So then the Rays which 1369at O suffer the greatest Refraction, may be taken out of the Light MO 1370whilst the rest of the Rays remain in it, and therefore that Light MO is 1371compounded of Rays differently refrangible. And because the Planes AB 1372and CD are parallel, and therefore by equal and contrary Refractions 1373destroy one anothers Effects, the incident Light FM must be of the same 1374Kind and Nature with the emergent Light MO, and therefore doth also 1375consist of Rays differently refrangible. These two Lights FM and MO, 1376before the most refrangible Rays are separated out of the emergent Light 1377MO, agree in Colour, and in all other Properties so far as my 1378Observation reaches, and therefore are deservedly reputed of the same 1379Nature and Constitution, and by Consequence the one is compounded as 1380well as the other. But after the most refrangible Rays begin to be 1381totally reflected, and thereby separated out of the emergent Light MO, 1382that Light changes its Colour from white to a dilute and faint yellow, a 1383pretty good orange, a very full red successively, and then totally 1384vanishes. For after the most refrangible Rays which paint the Paper at 1385P with a purple Colour, are by a total Reflexion taken out of the beam 1386of Light MO, the rest of the Colours which appear on the Paper at R and 1387T being mix'd in the Light MO compound there a faint yellow, and after 1388the blue and part of the green which appear on the Paper between P and R 1389are taken away, the rest which appear between R and T (that is the 1390yellow, orange, red and a little green) being mixed in the beam MO 1391compound there an orange; and when all the Rays are by Reflexion taken 1392out of the beam MO, except the least refrangible, which at T appear of a 1393full red, their Colour is the same in that beam MO as afterwards at T, 1394the Refraction of the Prism HJK serving only to separate the differently 1395refrangible Rays, without making any Alteration in their Colours, as 1396shall be more fully proved hereafter. All which confirms as well the 1397first Proposition as the second. 1398 1399_Scholium._ If this Experiment and the former be conjoined and made one 1400by applying a fourth Prism VXY [in _Fig._ 22.] to refract the reflected 1401beam MN towards _tp_, the Conclusion will be clearer. For then the Light 1402N_p_ which in the fourth Prism is more refracted, will become fuller and 1403stronger when the Light OP, which in the third Prism HJK is more 1404refracted, vanishes at P; and afterwards when the less refracted Light 1405OT vanishes at T, the less refracted Light N_t_ will become increased 1406whilst the more refracted Light at _p_ receives no farther increase. And 1407as the trajected beam MO in vanishing is always of such a Colour as 1408ought to result from the mixture of the Colours which fall upon the 1409Paper PT, so is the reflected beam MN always of such a Colour as ought 1410to result from the mixture of the Colours which fall upon the Paper 1411_pt_. For when the most refrangible Rays are by a total Reflexion taken 1412out of the beam MO, and leave that beam of an orange Colour, the Excess 1413of those Rays in the reflected Light, does not only make the violet, 1414indigo and blue at _p_ more full, but also makes the beam MN change from 1415the yellowish Colour of the Sun's Light, to a pale white inclining to 1416blue, and afterward recover its yellowish Colour again, so soon as all 1417the rest of the transmitted Light MOT is reflected. 1418 1419Now seeing that in all this variety of Experiments, whether the Trial be 1420made in Light reflected, and that either from natural Bodies, as in the 1421first and second Experiment, or specular, as in the ninth; or in Light 1422refracted, and that either before the unequally refracted Rays are by 1423diverging separated from one another, and losing their whiteness which 1424they have altogether, appear severally of several Colours, as in the 1425fifth Experiment; or after they are separated from one another, and 1426appear colour'd as in the sixth, seventh, and eighth Experiments; or in 1427Light trajected through parallel Superficies, destroying each others 1428Effects, as in the tenth Experiment; there are always found Rays, which 1429at equal Incidences on the same Medium suffer unequal Refractions, and 1430that without any splitting or dilating of single Rays, or contingence in 1431the inequality of the Refractions, as is proved in the fifth and sixth 1432Experiments. And seeing the Rays which differ in Refrangibility may be 1433parted and sorted from one another, and that either by Refraction as in 1434the third Experiment, or by Reflexion as in the tenth, and then the 1435several sorts apart at equal Incidences suffer unequal Refractions, and 1436those sorts are more refracted than others after Separation, which were 1437more refracted before it, as in the sixth and following Experiments, and 1438if the Sun's Light be trajected through three or more cross Prisms 1439successively, those Rays which in the first Prism are refracted more 1440than others, are in all the following Prisms refracted more than others 1441in the same Rate and Proportion, as appears by the fifth Experiment; 1442it's manifest that the Sun's Light is an heterogeneous Mixture of Rays, 1443some of which are constantly more refrangible than others, as was 1444proposed. 1445 1446 1447_PROP._ III. THEOR. III. 1448 1449_The Sun's Light consists of Rays differing in Reflexibility, and those 1450Rays are more reflexible than others which are more refrangible._ 1451 1452This is manifest by the ninth and tenth Experiments: For in the ninth 1453Experiment, by turning the Prism about its Axis, until the Rays within 1454it which in going out into the Air were refracted by its Base, became so 1455oblique to that Base, as to begin to be totally reflected thereby; those 1456Rays became first of all totally reflected, which before at equal 1457Incidences with the rest had suffered the greatest Refraction. And the 1458same thing happens in the Reflexion made by the common Base of the two 1459Prisms in the tenth Experiment. 1460 1461 1462_PROP._ IV. PROB. I. 1463 1464_To separate from one another the heterogeneous Rays of compound Light._ 1465 1466[Illustration: FIG. 23.] 1467 1468The heterogeneous Rays are in some measure separated from one another by 1469the Refraction of the Prism in the third Experiment, and in the fifth 1470Experiment, by taking away the Penumbra from the rectilinear sides of 1471the coloured Image, that Separation in those very rectilinear sides or 1472straight edges of the Image becomes perfect. But in all places between 1473those rectilinear edges, those innumerable Circles there described, 1474which are severally illuminated by homogeneal Rays, by interfering with 1475one another, and being every where commix'd, do render the Light 1476sufficiently compound. But if these Circles, whilst their Centers keep 1477their Distances and Positions, could be made less in Diameter, their 1478interfering one with another, and by Consequence the Mixture of the 1479heterogeneous Rays would be proportionally diminish'd. In the twenty 1480third Figure let AG, BH, CJ, DK, EL, FM be the Circles which so many 1481sorts of Rays flowing from the same disque of the Sun, do in the third 1482Experiment illuminate; of all which and innumerable other intermediate 1483ones lying in a continual Series between the two rectilinear and 1484parallel edges of the Sun's oblong Image PT, that Image is compos'd, as 1485was explained in the fifth Experiment. And let _ag_, _bh_, _ci_, _dk_, 1486_el_, _fm_ be so many less Circles lying in a like continual Series 1487between two parallel right Lines _af_ and _gm_ with the same distances 1488between their Centers, and illuminated by the same sorts of Rays, that 1489is the Circle _ag_ with the same sort by which the corresponding Circle 1490AG was illuminated, and the Circle _bh_ with the same sort by which the 1491corresponding Circle BH was illuminated, and the rest of the Circles 1492_ci_, _dk_, _el_, _fm_ respectively, with the same sorts of Rays by 1493which the several corresponding Circles CJ, DK, EL, FM were illuminated. 1494In the Figure PT composed of the greater Circles, three of those Circles 1495AG, BH, CJ, are so expanded into one another, that the three sorts of 1496Rays by which those Circles are illuminated, together with other 1497innumerable sorts of intermediate Rays, are mixed at QR in the middle 1498of the Circle BH. And the like Mixture happens throughout almost the 1499whole length of the Figure PT. But in the Figure _pt_ composed of the 1500less Circles, the three less Circles _ag_, _bh_, _ci_, which answer to 1501those three greater, do not extend into one another; nor are there any 1502where mingled so much as any two of the three sorts of Rays by which 1503those Circles are illuminated, and which in the Figure PT are all of 1504them intermingled at BH. 1505 1506Now he that shall thus consider it, will easily understand that the 1507Mixture is diminished in the same Proportion with the Diameters of the 1508Circles. If the Diameters of the Circles whilst their Centers remain the 1509same, be made three times less than before, the Mixture will be also 1510three times less; if ten times less, the Mixture will be ten times less, 1511and so of other Proportions. That is, the Mixture of the Rays in the 1512greater Figure PT will be to their Mixture in the less _pt_, as the 1513Latitude of the greater Figure is to the Latitude of the less. For the 1514Latitudes of these Figures are equal to the Diameters of their Circles. 1515And hence it easily follows, that the Mixture of the Rays in the 1516refracted Spectrum _pt_ is to the Mixture of the Rays in the direct and 1517immediate Light of the Sun, as the breadth of that Spectrum is to the 1518difference between the length and breadth of the same Spectrum. 1519 1520So then, if we would diminish the Mixture of the Rays, we are to 1521diminish the Diameters of the Circles. Now these would be diminished if 1522the Sun's Diameter to which they answer could be made less than it is, 1523or (which comes to the same Purpose) if without Doors, at a great 1524distance from the Prism towards the Sun, some opake Body were placed, 1525with a round hole in the middle of it, to intercept all the Sun's Light, 1526excepting so much as coming from the middle of his Body could pass 1527through that Hole to the Prism. For so the Circles AG, BH, and the rest, 1528would not any longer answer to the whole Disque of the Sun, but only to 1529that Part of it which could be seen from the Prism through that Hole, 1530that it is to the apparent Magnitude of that Hole view'd from the Prism. 1531But that these Circles may answer more distinctly to that Hole, a Lens 1532is to be placed by the Prism to cast the Image of the Hole, (that is, 1533every one of the Circles AG, BH, &c.) distinctly upon the Paper at PT, 1534after such a manner, as by a Lens placed at a Window, the Species of 1535Objects abroad are cast distinctly upon a Paper within the Room, and the 1536rectilinear Sides of the oblong Solar Image in the fifth Experiment 1537became distinct without any Penumbra. If this be done, it will not be 1538necessary to place that Hole very far off, no not beyond the Window. And 1539therefore instead of that Hole, I used the Hole in the Window-shut, as 1540follows. 1541 1542_Exper._ 11. In the Sun's Light let into my darken'd Chamber through a 1543small round Hole in my Window-shut, at about ten or twelve Feet from the 1544Window, I placed a Lens, by which the Image of the Hole might be 1545distinctly cast upon a Sheet of white Paper, placed at the distance of 1546six, eight, ten, or twelve Feet from the Lens. For, according to the 1547difference of the Lenses I used various distances, which I think not 1548worth the while to describe. Then immediately after the Lens I placed a 1549Prism, by which the trajected Light might be refracted either upwards or 1550sideways, and thereby the round Image, which the Lens alone did cast 1551upon the Paper might be drawn out into a long one with Parallel Sides, 1552as in the third Experiment. This oblong Image I let fall upon another 1553Paper at about the same distance from the Prism as before, moving the 1554Paper either towards the Prism or from it, until I found the just 1555distance where the Rectilinear Sides of the Image became most distinct. 1556For in this Case, the Circular Images of the Hole, which compose that 1557Image after the same manner that the Circles _ag_, _bh_, _ci_, &c. do 1558the Figure _pt_ [in _Fig._ 23.] were terminated most distinctly without 1559any Penumbra, and therefore extended into one another the least that 1560they could, and by consequence the Mixture of the heterogeneous Rays was 1561now the least of all. By this means I used to form an oblong Image (such 1562as is _pt_) [in _Fig._ 23, and 24.] of Circular Images of the Hole, 1563(such as are _ag_, _bh_, _ci_, &c.) and by using a greater or less Hole 1564in the Window-shut, I made the Circular Images _ag_, _bh_, _ci_, &c. of 1565which it was formed, to become greater or less at pleasure, and thereby 1566the Mixture of the Rays in the Image _pt_ to be as much, or as little as 1567I desired. 1568 1569[Illustration: FIG. 24.] 1570 1571_Illustration._ In the twenty-fourth Figure, F represents the Circular 1572Hole in the Window-shut, MN the Lens, whereby the Image or Species of 1573that Hole is cast distinctly upon a Paper at J, ABC the Prism, whereby 1574the Rays are at their emerging out of the Lens refracted from J towards 1575another Paper at _pt_, and the round Image at J is turned into an oblong 1576Image _pt_ falling on that other Paper. This Image _pt_ consists of 1577Circles placed one after another in a Rectilinear Order, as was 1578sufficiently explained in the fifth Experiment; and these Circles are 1579equal to the Circle J, and consequently answer in magnitude to the Hole 1580F; and therefore by diminishing that Hole they may be at pleasure 1581diminished, whilst their Centers remain in their Places. By this means I 1582made the Breadth of the Image _pt_ to be forty times, and sometimes 1583sixty or seventy times less than its Length. As for instance, if the 1584Breadth of the Hole F be one tenth of an Inch, and MF the distance of 1585the Lens from the Hole be 12 Feet; and if _p_B or _p_M the distance of 1586the Image _pt_ from the Prism or Lens be 10 Feet, and the refracting 1587Angle of the Prism be 62 Degrees, the Breadth of the Image _pt_ will be 1588one twelfth of an Inch, and the Length about six Inches, and therefore 1589the Length to the Breadth as 72 to 1, and by consequence the Light of 1590this Image 71 times less compound than the Sun's direct Light. And Light 1591thus far simple and homogeneal, is sufficient for trying all the 1592Experiments in this Book about simple Light. For the Composition of 1593heterogeneal Rays is in this Light so little, that it is scarce to be 1594discovered and perceiv'd by Sense, except perhaps in the indigo and 1595violet. For these being dark Colours do easily suffer a sensible Allay 1596by that little scattering Light which uses to be refracted irregularly 1597by the Inequalities of the Prism. 1598 1599Yet instead of the Circular Hole F, 'tis better to substitute an oblong 1600Hole shaped like a long Parallelogram with its Length parallel to the 1601Prism ABC. For if this Hole be an Inch or two long, and but a tenth or 1602twentieth Part of an Inch broad, or narrower; the Light of the Image 1603_pt_ will be as simple as before, or simpler, and the Image will become 1604much broader, and therefore more fit to have Experiments try'd in its 1605Light than before. 1606 1607Instead of this Parallelogram Hole may be substituted a triangular one 1608of equal Sides, whose Base, for instance, is about the tenth Part of an 1609Inch, and its Height an Inch or more. For by this means, if the Axis of 1610the Prism be parallel to the Perpendicular of the Triangle, the Image 1611_pt_ [in _Fig._ 25.] will now be form'd of equicrural Triangles _ag_, 1612_bh_, _ci_, _dk_, _el_, _fm_, &c. and innumerable other intermediate 1613ones answering to the triangular Hole in Shape and Bigness, and lying 1614one after another in a continual Series between two Parallel Lines _af_ 1615and _gm_. These Triangles are a little intermingled at their Bases, but 1616not at their Vertices; and therefore the Light on the brighter Side _af_ 1617of the Image, where the Bases of the Triangles are, is a little 1618compounded, but on the darker Side _gm_ is altogether uncompounded, and 1619in all Places between the Sides the Composition is proportional to the 1620distances of the Places from that obscurer Side _gm_. And having a 1621Spectrum _pt_ of such a Composition, we may try Experiments either in 1622its stronger and less simple Light near the Side _af_, or in its weaker 1623and simpler Light near the other Side _gm_, as it shall seem most 1624convenient. 1625 1626[Illustration: FIG. 25.] 1627 1628But in making Experiments of this kind, the Chamber ought to be made as 1629dark as can be, lest any Foreign Light mingle it self with the Light of 1630the Spectrum _pt_, and render it compound; especially if we would try 1631Experiments in the more simple Light next the Side _gm_ of the Spectrum; 1632which being fainter, will have a less proportion to the Foreign Light; 1633and so by the mixture of that Light be more troubled, and made more 1634compound. The Lens also ought to be good, such as may serve for optical 1635Uses, and the Prism ought to have a large Angle, suppose of 65 or 70 1636Degrees, and to be well wrought, being made of Glass free from Bubbles 1637and Veins, with its Sides not a little convex or concave, as usually 1638happens, but truly plane, and its Polish elaborate, as in working 1639Optick-glasses, and not such as is usually wrought with Putty, whereby 1640the edges of the Sand-holes being worn away, there are left all over the 1641Glass a numberless Company of very little convex polite Risings like 1642Waves. The edges also of the Prism and Lens, so far as they may make any 1643irregular Refraction, must be covered with a black Paper glewed on. And 1644all the Light of the Sun's Beam let into the Chamber, which is useless 1645and unprofitable to the Experiment, ought to be intercepted with black 1646Paper, or other black Obstacles. For otherwise the useless Light being 1647reflected every way in the Chamber, will mix with the oblong Spectrum, 1648and help to disturb it. In trying these Things, so much diligence is not 1649altogether necessary, but it will promote the Success of the 1650Experiments, and by a very scrupulous Examiner of Things deserves to be 1651apply'd. It's difficult to get Glass Prisms fit for this Purpose, and 1652therefore I used sometimes prismatick Vessels made with pieces of broken 1653Looking-glasses, and filled with Rain Water. And to increase the 1654Refraction, I sometimes impregnated the Water strongly with _Saccharum 1655Saturni_. 1656 1657 1658_PROP._ V. THEOR. IV. 1659 1660_Homogeneal Light is refracted regularly without any Dilatation 1661splitting or shattering of the Rays, and the confused Vision of Objects 1662seen through refracting Bodies by heterogeneal Light arises from the 1663different Refrangibility of several sorts of Rays._ 1664 1665The first Part of this Proposition has been already sufficiently proved 1666in the fifth Experiment, and will farther appear by the Experiments 1667which follow. 1668 1669_Exper._ 12. In the middle of a black Paper I made a round Hole about a 1670fifth or sixth Part of an Inch in diameter. Upon this Paper I caused the 1671Spectrum of homogeneal Light described in the former Proposition, so to 1672fall, that some part of the Light might pass through the Hole of the 1673Paper. This transmitted part of the Light I refracted with a Prism 1674placed behind the Paper, and letting this refracted Light fall 1675perpendicularly upon a white Paper two or three Feet distant from the 1676Prism, I found that the Spectrum formed on the Paper by this Light was 1677not oblong, as when 'tis made (in the third Experiment) by refracting 1678the Sun's compound Light, but was (so far as I could judge by my Eye) 1679perfectly circular, the Length being no greater than the Breadth. Which 1680shews, that this Light is refracted regularly without any Dilatation of 1681the Rays. 1682 1683_Exper._ 13. In the homogeneal Light I placed a Paper Circle of a 1684quarter of an Inch in diameter, and in the Sun's unrefracted 1685heterogeneal white Light I placed another Paper Circle of the same 1686Bigness. And going from the Papers to the distance of some Feet, I 1687viewed both Circles through a Prism. The Circle illuminated by the Sun's 1688heterogeneal Light appeared very oblong, as in the fourth Experiment, 1689the Length being many times greater than the Breadth; but the other 1690Circle, illuminated with homogeneal Light, appeared circular and 1691distinctly defined, as when 'tis view'd with the naked Eye. Which proves 1692the whole Proposition. 1693 1694_Exper._ 14. In the homogeneal Light I placed Flies, and such-like 1695minute Objects, and viewing them through a Prism, I saw their Parts as 1696distinctly defined, as if I had viewed them with the naked Eye. The same 1697Objects placed in the Sun's unrefracted heterogeneal Light, which was 1698white, I viewed also through a Prism, and saw them most confusedly 1699defined, so that I could not distinguish their smaller Parts from one 1700another. I placed also the Letters of a small print, one while in the 1701homogeneal Light, and then in the heterogeneal, and viewing them through 1702a Prism, they appeared in the latter Case so confused and indistinct, 1703that I could not read them; but in the former they appeared so distinct, 1704that I could read readily, and thought I saw them as distinct, as when I 1705view'd them with my naked Eye. In both Cases I view'd the same Objects, 1706through the same Prism at the same distance from me, and in the same 1707Situation. There was no difference, but in the Light by which the 1708Objects were illuminated, and which in one Case was simple, and in the 1709other compound; and therefore, the distinct Vision in the former Case, 1710and confused in the latter, could arise from nothing else than from that 1711difference of the Lights. Which proves the whole Proposition. 1712 1713And in these three Experiments it is farther very remarkable, that the 1714Colour of homogeneal Light was never changed by the Refraction. 1715 1716 1717_PROP._ VI. THEOR. V. 1718 1719_The Sine of Incidence of every Ray considered apart, is to its Sine of 1720Refraction in a given Ratio._ 1721 1722That every Ray consider'd apart, is constant to it self in some degree 1723of Refrangibility, is sufficiently manifest out of what has been said. 1724Those Rays, which in the first Refraction, are at equal Incidences most 1725refracted, are also in the following Refractions at equal Incidences 1726most refracted; and so of the least refrangible, and the rest which have 1727any mean Degree of Refrangibility, as is manifest by the fifth, sixth, 1728seventh, eighth, and ninth Experiments. And those which the first Time 1729at like Incidences are equally refracted, are again at like Incidences 1730equally and uniformly refracted, and that whether they be refracted 1731before they be separated from one another, as in the fifth Experiment, 1732or whether they be refracted apart, as in the twelfth, thirteenth and 1733fourteenth Experiments. The Refraction therefore of every Ray apart is 1734regular, and what Rule that Refraction observes we are now to shew.[E] 1735 1736The late Writers in Opticks teach, that the Sines of Incidence are in a 1737given Proportion to the Sines of Refraction, as was explained in the 1738fifth Axiom, and some by Instruments fitted for measuring of 1739Refractions, or otherwise experimentally examining this Proportion, do 1740acquaint us that they have found it accurate. But whilst they, not 1741understanding the different Refrangibility of several Rays, conceived 1742them all to be refracted according to one and the same Proportion, 'tis 1743to be presumed that they adapted their Measures only to the middle of 1744the refracted Light; so that from their Measures we may conclude only 1745that the Rays which have a mean Degree of Refrangibility, that is, those 1746which when separated from the rest appear green, are refracted according 1747to a given Proportion of their Sines. And therefore we are now to shew, 1748that the like given Proportions obtain in all the rest. That it should 1749be so is very reasonable, Nature being ever conformable to her self; but 1750an experimental Proof is desired. And such a Proof will be had, if we 1751can shew that the Sines of Refraction of Rays differently refrangible 1752are one to another in a given Proportion when their Sines of Incidence 1753are equal. For, if the Sines of Refraction of all the Rays are in given 1754Proportions to the Sine of Refractions of a Ray which has a mean Degree 1755of Refrangibility, and this Sine is in a given Proportion to the equal 1756Sines of Incidence, those other Sines of Refraction will also be in 1757given Proportions to the equal Sines of Incidence. Now, when the Sines 1758of Incidence are equal, it will appear by the following Experiment, that 1759the Sines of Refraction are in a given Proportion to one another. 1760 1761[Illustration: FIG. 26.] 1762 1763_Exper._ 15. The Sun shining into a dark Chamber through a little round 1764Hole in the Window-shut, let S [in _Fig._ 26.] represent his round white 1765Image painted on the opposite Wall by his direct Light, PT his oblong 1766coloured Image made by refracting that Light with a Prism placed at the 1767Window; and _pt_, or _2p 2t_, _3p 3t_, his oblong colour'd Image made by 1768refracting again the same Light sideways with a second Prism placed 1769immediately after the first in a cross Position to it, as was explained 1770in the fifth Experiment; that is to say, _pt_ when the Refraction of the 1771second Prism is small, _2p 2t_ when its Refraction is greater, and _3p 17723t_ when it is greatest. For such will be the diversity of the 1773Refractions, if the refracting Angle of the second Prism be of various 1774Magnitudes; suppose of fifteen or twenty Degrees to make the Image _pt_, 1775of thirty or forty to make the Image _2p 2t_, and of sixty to make the 1776Image _3p 3t_. But for want of solid Glass Prisms with Angles of 1777convenient Bignesses, there may be Vessels made of polished Plates of 1778Glass cemented together in the form of Prisms and filled with Water. 1779These things being thus ordered, I observed that all the solar Images or 1780coloured Spectrums PT, _pt_, _2p 2t_, _3p 3t_ did very nearly converge 1781to the place S on which the direct Light of the Sun fell and painted his 1782white round Image when the Prisms were taken away. The Axis of the 1783Spectrum PT, that is the Line drawn through the middle of it parallel to 1784its rectilinear Sides, did when produced pass exactly through the middle 1785of that white round Image S. And when the Refraction of the second Prism 1786was equal to the Refraction of the first, the refracting Angles of them 1787both being about 60 Degrees, the Axis of the Spectrum _3p 3t_ made by 1788that Refraction, did when produced pass also through the middle of the 1789same white round Image S. But when the Refraction of the second Prism 1790was less than that of the first, the produced Axes of the Spectrums _tp_ 1791or _2t 2p_ made by that Refraction did cut the produced Axis of the 1792Spectrum TP in the points _m_ and _n_, a little beyond the Center of 1793that white round Image S. Whence the proportion of the Line 3_t_T to the 1794Line 3_p_P was a little greater than the Proportion of 2_t_T or 2_p_P, 1795and this Proportion a little greater than that of _t_T to _p_P. Now when 1796the Light of the Spectrum PT falls perpendicularly upon the Wall, those 1797Lines 3_t_T, 3_p_P, and 2_t_T, and 2_p_P, and _t_T, _p_P, are the 1798Tangents of the Refractions, and therefore by this Experiment the 1799Proportions of the Tangents of the Refractions are obtained, from whence 1800the Proportions of the Sines being derived, they come out equal, so far 1801as by viewing the Spectrums, and using some mathematical Reasoning I 1802could estimate. For I did not make an accurate Computation. So then the 1803Proposition holds true in every Ray apart, so far as appears by 1804Experiment. And that it is accurately true, may be demonstrated upon 1805this Supposition. _That Bodies refract Light by acting upon its Rays in 1806Lines perpendicular to their Surfaces._ But in order to this 1807Demonstration, I must distinguish the Motion of every Ray into two 1808Motions, the one perpendicular to the refracting Surface, the other 1809parallel to it, and concerning the perpendicular Motion lay down the 1810following Proposition. 1811 1812If any Motion or moving thing whatsoever be incident with any Velocity 1813on any broad and thin space terminated on both sides by two parallel 1814Planes, and in its Passage through that space be urged perpendicularly 1815towards the farther Plane by any force which at given distances from the 1816Plane is of given Quantities; the perpendicular velocity of that Motion 1817or Thing, at its emerging out of that space, shall be always equal to 1818the square Root of the sum of the square of the perpendicular velocity 1819of that Motion or Thing at its Incidence on that space; and of the 1820square of the perpendicular velocity which that Motion or Thing would 1821have at its Emergence, if at its Incidence its perpendicular velocity 1822was infinitely little. 1823 1824And the same Proposition holds true of any Motion or Thing 1825perpendicularly retarded in its passage through that space, if instead 1826of the sum of the two Squares you take their difference. The 1827Demonstration Mathematicians will easily find out, and therefore I shall 1828not trouble the Reader with it. 1829 1830Suppose now that a Ray coming most obliquely in the Line MC [in _Fig._ 18311.] be refracted at C by the Plane RS into the Line CN, and if it be 1832required to find the Line CE, into which any other Ray AC shall be 1833refracted; let MC, AD, be the Sines of Incidence of the two Rays, and 1834NG, EF, their Sines of Refraction, and let the equal Motions of the 1835incident Rays be represented by the equal Lines MC and AC, and the 1836Motion MC being considered as parallel to the refracting Plane, let the 1837other Motion AC be distinguished into two Motions AD and DC, one of 1838which AD is parallel, and the other DC perpendicular to the refracting 1839Surface. In like manner, let the Motions of the emerging Rays be 1840distinguish'd into two, whereof the perpendicular ones are MC/NG × CG 1841and AD/EF × CF. And if the force of the refracting Plane begins to act 1842upon the Rays either in that Plane or at a certain distance from it on 1843the one side, and ends at a certain distance from it on the other side, 1844and in all places between those two limits acts upon the Rays in Lines 1845perpendicular to that refracting Plane, and the Actions upon the Rays at 1846equal distances from the refracting Plane be equal, and at unequal ones 1847either equal or unequal according to any rate whatever; that Motion of 1848the Ray which is parallel to the refracting Plane, will suffer no 1849Alteration by that Force; and that Motion which is perpendicular to it 1850will be altered according to the rule of the foregoing Proposition. If 1851therefore for the perpendicular velocity of the emerging Ray CN you 1852write MC/NG × CG as above, then the perpendicular velocity of any other 1853emerging Ray CE which was AD/EF × CF, will be equal to the square Root 1854of CD_q_ + (_MCq/NGq_ × CG_q_). And by squaring these Equals, and adding 1855to them the Equals AD_q_ and MC_q_ - CD_q_, and dividing the Sums by the 1856Equals CF_q_ + EF_q_ and CG_q_ + NG_q_, you will have _MCq/NGq_ equal to 1857_ADq/EFq_. Whence AD, the Sine of Incidence, is to EF the Sine of 1858Refraction, as MC to NG, that is, in a given _ratio_. And this 1859Demonstration being general, without determining what Light is, or by 1860what kind of Force it is refracted, or assuming any thing farther than 1861that the refracting Body acts upon the Rays in Lines perpendicular to 1862its Surface; I take it to be a very convincing Argument of the full 1863truth of this Proposition. 1864 1865So then, if the _ratio_ of the Sines of Incidence and Refraction of any 1866sort of Rays be found in any one case, 'tis given in all cases; and this 1867may be readily found by the Method in the following Proposition. 1868 1869 1870_PROP._ VII. THEOR. VI. 1871 1872_The Perfection of Telescopes is impeded by the different Refrangibility 1873of the Rays of Light._ 1874 1875The Imperfection of Telescopes is vulgarly attributed to the spherical 1876Figures of the Glasses, and therefore Mathematicians have propounded to 1877figure them by the conical Sections. To shew that they are mistaken, I 1878have inserted this Proposition; the truth of which will appear by the 1879measure of the Refractions of the several sorts of Rays; and these 1880measures I thus determine. 1881 1882In the third Experiment of this first Part, where the refracting Angle 1883of the Prism was 62-1/2 Degrees, the half of that Angle 31 deg. 15 min. 1884is the Angle of Incidence of the Rays at their going out of the Glass 1885into the Air[F]; and the Sine of this Angle is 5188, the Radius being 188610000. When the Axis of this Prism was parallel to the Horizon, and the 1887Refraction of the Rays at their Incidence on this Prism equal to that at 1888their Emergence out of it, I observed with a Quadrant the Angle which 1889the mean refrangible Rays, (that is those which went to the middle of 1890the Sun's coloured Image) made with the Horizon, and by this Angle and 1891the Sun's altitude observed at the same time, I found the Angle which 1892the emergent Rays contained with the incident to be 44 deg. and 40 min. 1893and the half of this Angle added to the Angle of Incidence 31 deg. 15 1894min. makes the Angle of Refraction, which is therefore 53 deg. 35 min. 1895and its Sine 8047. These are the Sines of Incidence and Refraction of 1896the mean refrangible Rays, and their Proportion in round Numbers is 20 1897to 31. This Glass was of a Colour inclining to green. The last of the 1898Prisms mentioned in the third Experiment was of clear white Glass. Its 1899refracting Angle 63-1/2 Degrees. The Angle which the emergent Rays 1900contained, with the incident 45 deg. 50 min. The Sine of half the first 1901Angle 5262. The Sine of half the Sum of the Angles 8157. And their 1902Proportion in round Numbers 20 to 31, as before. 1903 1904From the Length of the Image, which was about 9-3/4 or 10 Inches, 1905subduct its Breadth, which was 2-1/8 Inches, and the Remainder 7-3/4 1906Inches would be the Length of the Image were the Sun but a Point, and 1907therefore subtends the Angle which the most and least refrangible Rays, 1908when incident on the Prism in the same Lines, do contain with one 1909another after their Emergence. Whence this Angle is 2 deg. 0´. 7´´. For 1910the distance between the Image and the Prism where this Angle is made, 1911was 18-1/2 Feet, and at that distance the Chord 7-3/4 Inches subtends an 1912Angle of 2 deg. 0´. 7´´. Now half this Angle is the Angle which these 1913emergent Rays contain with the emergent mean refrangible Rays, and a 1914quarter thereof, that is 30´. 2´´. may be accounted the Angle which they 1915would contain with the same emergent mean refrangible Rays, were they 1916co-incident to them within the Glass, and suffered no other Refraction 1917than that at their Emergence. For, if two equal Refractions, the one at 1918the Incidence of the Rays on the Prism, the other at their Emergence, 1919make half the Angle 2 deg. 0´. 7´´. then one of those Refractions will 1920make about a quarter of that Angle, and this quarter added to, and 1921subducted from the Angle of Refraction of the mean refrangible Rays, 1922which was 53 deg. 35´, gives the Angles of Refraction of the most and 1923least refrangible Rays 54 deg. 5´ 2´´, and 53 deg. 4´ 58´´, whose Sines 1924are 8099 and 7995, the common Angle of Incidence being 31 deg. 15´, and 1925its Sine 5188; and these Sines in the least round Numbers are in 1926proportion to one another, as 78 and 77 to 50. 1927 1928Now, if you subduct the common Sine of Incidence 50 from the Sines of 1929Refraction 77 and 78, the Remainders 27 and 28 shew, that in small 1930Refractions the Refraction of the least refrangible Rays is to the 1931Refraction of the most refrangible ones, as 27 to 28 very nearly, and 1932that the difference of the Refractions of the least refrangible and most 1933refrangible Rays is about the 27-1/2th Part of the whole Refraction of 1934the mean refrangible Rays. 1935 1936Whence they that are skilled in Opticks will easily understand,[G] that 1937the Breadth of the least circular Space, into which Object-glasses of 1938Telescopes can collect all sorts of Parallel Rays, is about the 27-1/2th 1939Part of half the Aperture of the Glass, or 55th Part of the whole 1940Aperture; and that the Focus of the most refrangible Rays is nearer to 1941the Object-glass than the Focus of the least refrangible ones, by about 1942the 27-1/2th Part of the distance between the Object-glass and the Focus 1943of the mean refrangible ones. 1944 1945And if Rays of all sorts, flowing from any one lucid Point in the Axis 1946of any convex Lens, be made by the Refraction of the Lens to converge to 1947Points not too remote from the Lens, the Focus of the most refrangible 1948Rays shall be nearer to the Lens than the Focus of the least refrangible 1949ones, by a distance which is to the 27-1/2th Part of the distance of the 1950Focus of the mean refrangible Rays from the Lens, as the distance 1951between that Focus and the lucid Point, from whence the Rays flow, is to 1952the distance between that lucid Point and the Lens very nearly. 1953 1954Now to examine whether the Difference between the Refractions, which the 1955most refrangible and the least refrangible Rays flowing from the same 1956Point suffer in the Object-glasses of Telescopes and such-like Glasses, 1957be so great as is here described, I contrived the following Experiment. 1958 1959_Exper._ 16. The Lens which I used in the second and eighth Experiments, 1960being placed six Feet and an Inch distant from any Object, collected the 1961Species of that Object by the mean refrangible Rays at the distance of 1962six Feet and an Inch from the Lens on the other side. And therefore by 1963the foregoing Rule, it ought to collect the Species of that Object by 1964the least refrangible Rays at the distance of six Feet and 3-2/3 Inches 1965from the Lens, and by the most refrangible ones at the distance of five 1966Feet and 10-1/3 Inches from it: So that between the two Places, where 1967these least and most refrangible Rays collect the Species, there may be 1968the distance of about 5-1/3 Inches. For by that Rule, as six Feet and an 1969Inch (the distance of the Lens from the lucid Object) is to twelve Feet 1970and two Inches (the distance of the lucid Object from the Focus of the 1971mean refrangible Rays) that is, as One is to Two; so is the 27-1/2th 1972Part of six Feet and an Inch (the distance between the Lens and the same 1973Focus) to the distance between the Focus of the most refrangible Rays 1974and the Focus of the least refrangible ones, which is therefore 5-17/55 1975Inches, that is very nearly 5-1/3 Inches. Now to know whether this 1976Measure was true, I repeated the second and eighth Experiment with 1977coloured Light, which was less compounded than that I there made use of: 1978For I now separated the heterogeneous Rays from one another by the 1979Method I described in the eleventh Experiment, so as to make a coloured 1980Spectrum about twelve or fifteen Times longer than broad. This Spectrum 1981I cast on a printed Book, and placing the above-mentioned Lens at the 1982distance of six Feet and an Inch from this Spectrum to collect the 1983Species of the illuminated Letters at the same distance on the other 1984side, I found that the Species of the Letters illuminated with blue were 1985nearer to the Lens than those illuminated with deep red by about three 1986Inches, or three and a quarter; but the Species of the Letters 1987illuminated with indigo and violet appeared so confused and indistinct, 1988that I could not read them: Whereupon viewing the Prism, I found it was 1989full of Veins running from one end of the Glass to the other; so that 1990the Refraction could not be regular. I took another Prism therefore 1991which was free from Veins, and instead of the Letters I used two or 1992three Parallel black Lines a little broader than the Strokes of the 1993Letters, and casting the Colours upon these Lines in such manner, that 1994the Lines ran along the Colours from one end of the Spectrum to the 1995other, I found that the Focus where the indigo, or confine of this 1996Colour and violet cast the Species of the black Lines most distinctly, 1997to be about four Inches, or 4-1/4 nearer to the Lens than the Focus, 1998where the deepest red cast the Species of the same black Lines most 1999distinctly. The violet was so faint and dark, that I could not discern 2000the Species of the Lines distinctly by that Colour; and therefore 2001considering that the Prism was made of a dark coloured Glass inclining 2002to green, I took another Prism of clear white Glass; but the Spectrum of 2003Colours which this Prism made had long white Streams of faint Light 2004shooting out from both ends of the Colours, which made me conclude that 2005something was amiss; and viewing the Prism, I found two or three little 2006Bubbles in the Glass, which refracted the Light irregularly. Wherefore I 2007covered that Part of the Glass with black Paper, and letting the Light 2008pass through another Part of it which was free from such Bubbles, the 2009Spectrum of Colours became free from those irregular Streams of Light, 2010and was now such as I desired. But still I found the violet so dark and 2011faint, that I could scarce see the Species of the Lines by the violet, 2012and not at all by the deepest Part of it, which was next the end of the 2013Spectrum. I suspected therefore, that this faint and dark Colour might 2014be allayed by that scattering Light which was refracted, and reflected 2015irregularly, partly by some very small Bubbles in the Glasses, and 2016partly by the Inequalities of their Polish; which Light, tho' it was but 2017little, yet it being of a white Colour, might suffice to affect the 2018Sense so strongly as to disturb the Phænomena of that weak and dark 2019Colour the violet, and therefore I tried, as in the 12th, 13th, and 14th 2020Experiments, whether the Light of this Colour did not consist of a 2021sensible Mixture of heterogeneous Rays, but found it did not. Nor did 2022the Refractions cause any other sensible Colour than violet to emerge 2023out of this Light, as they would have done out of white Light, and by 2024consequence out of this violet Light had it been sensibly compounded 2025with white Light. And therefore I concluded, that the reason why I could 2026not see the Species of the Lines distinctly by this Colour, was only 2027the Darkness of this Colour, and Thinness of its Light, and its distance 2028from the Axis of the Lens; I divided therefore those Parallel black 2029Lines into equal Parts, by which I might readily know the distances of 2030the Colours in the Spectrum from one another, and noted the distances of 2031the Lens from the Foci of such Colours, as cast the Species of the Lines 2032distinctly, and then considered whether the difference of those 2033distances bear such proportion to 5-1/3 Inches, the greatest Difference 2034of the distances, which the Foci of the deepest red and violet ought to 2035have from the Lens, as the distance of the observed Colours from one 2036another in the Spectrum bear to the greatest distance of the deepest red 2037and violet measured in the Rectilinear Sides of the Spectrum, that is, 2038to the Length of those Sides, or Excess of the Length of the Spectrum 2039above its Breadth. And my Observations were as follows. 2040 2041When I observed and compared the deepest sensible red, and the Colour in 2042the Confine of green and blue, which at the Rectilinear Sides of the 2043Spectrum was distant from it half the Length of those Sides, the Focus 2044where the Confine of green and blue cast the Species of the Lines 2045distinctly on the Paper, was nearer to the Lens than the Focus, where 2046the red cast those Lines distinctly on it by about 2-1/2 or 2-3/4 2047Inches. For sometimes the Measures were a little greater, sometimes a 2048little less, but seldom varied from one another above 1/3 of an Inch. 2049For it was very difficult to define the Places of the Foci, without some 2050little Errors. Now, if the Colours distant half the Length of the 2051Image, (measured at its Rectilinear Sides) give 2-1/2 or 2-3/4 2052Difference of the distances of their Foci from the Lens, then the 2053Colours distant the whole Length ought to give 5 or 5-1/2 Inches 2054difference of those distances. 2055 2056But here it's to be noted, that I could not see the red to the full end 2057of the Spectrum, but only to the Center of the Semicircle which bounded 2058that end, or a little farther; and therefore I compared this red not 2059with that Colour which was exactly in the middle of the Spectrum, or 2060Confine of green and blue, but with that which verged a little more to 2061the blue than to the green: And as I reckoned the whole Length of the 2062Colours not to be the whole Length of the Spectrum, but the Length of 2063its Rectilinear Sides, so compleating the semicircular Ends into 2064Circles, when either of the observed Colours fell within those Circles, 2065I measured the distance of that Colour from the semicircular End of the 2066Spectrum, and subducting half this distance from the measured distance 2067of the two Colours, I took the Remainder for their corrected distance; 2068and in these Observations set down this corrected distance for the 2069difference of the distances of their Foci from the Lens. For, as the 2070Length of the Rectilinear Sides of the Spectrum would be the whole 2071Length of all the Colours, were the Circles of which (as we shewed) that 2072Spectrum consists contracted and reduced to Physical Points, so in that 2073Case this corrected distance would be the real distance of the two 2074observed Colours. 2075 2076When therefore I farther observed the deepest sensible red, and that 2077blue whose corrected distance from it was 7/12 Parts of the Length of 2078the Rectilinear Sides of the Spectrum, the difference of the distances 2079of their Foci from the Lens was about 3-1/4 Inches, and as 7 to 12, so 2080is 3-1/4 to 5-4/7. 2081 2082When I observed the deepest sensible red, and that indigo whose 2083corrected distance was 8/12 or 2/3 of the Length of the Rectilinear 2084Sides of the Spectrum, the difference of the distances of their Foci 2085from the Lens, was about 3-2/3 Inches, and as 2 to 3, so is 3-2/3 to 20865-1/2. 2087 2088When I observed the deepest sensible red, and that deep indigo whose 2089corrected distance from one another was 9/12 or 3/4 of the Length of the 2090Rectilinear Sides of the Spectrum, the difference of the distances of 2091their Foci from the Lens was about 4 Inches; and as 3 to 4, so is 4 to 20925-1/3. 2093 2094When I observed the deepest sensible red, and that Part of the violet 2095next the indigo, whose corrected distance from the red was 10/12 or 5/6 2096of the Length of the Rectilinear Sides of the Spectrum, the difference 2097of the distances of their Foci from the Lens was about 4-1/2 Inches, and 2098as 5 to 6, so is 4-1/2 to 5-2/5. For sometimes, when the Lens was 2099advantageously placed, so that its Axis respected the blue, and all 2100Things else were well ordered, and the Sun shone clear, and I held my 2101Eye very near to the Paper on which the Lens cast the Species of the 2102Lines, I could see pretty distinctly the Species of those Lines by that 2103Part of the violet which was next the indigo; and sometimes I could see 2104them by above half the violet, For in making these Experiments I had 2105observed, that the Species of those Colours only appear distinct, which 2106were in or near the Axis of the Lens: So that if the blue or indigo were 2107in the Axis, I could see their Species distinctly; and then the red 2108appeared much less distinct than before. Wherefore I contrived to make 2109the Spectrum of Colours shorter than before, so that both its Ends might 2110be nearer to the Axis of the Lens. And now its Length was about 2-1/2 2111Inches, and Breadth about 1/5 or 1/6 of an Inch. Also instead of the 2112black Lines on which the Spectrum was cast, I made one black Line 2113broader than those, that I might see its Species more easily; and this 2114Line I divided by short cross Lines into equal Parts, for measuring the 2115distances of the observed Colours. And now I could sometimes see the 2116Species of this Line with its Divisions almost as far as the Center of 2117the semicircular violet End of the Spectrum, and made these farther 2118Observations. 2119 2120When I observed the deepest sensible red, and that Part of the violet, 2121whose corrected distance from it was about 8/9 Parts of the Rectilinear 2122Sides of the Spectrum, the Difference of the distances of the Foci of 2123those Colours from the Lens, was one time 4-2/3, another time 4-3/4, 2124another time 4-7/8 Inches; and as 8 to 9, so are 4-2/3, 4-3/4, 4-7/8, to 21255-1/4, 5-11/32, 5-31/64 respectively. 2126 2127When I observed the deepest sensible red, and deepest sensible violet, 2128(the corrected distance of which Colours, when all Things were ordered 2129to the best Advantage, and the Sun shone very clear, was about 11/12 or 213015/16 Parts of the Length of the Rectilinear Sides of the coloured 2131Spectrum) I found the Difference of the distances of their Foci from the 2132Lens sometimes 4-3/4 sometimes 5-1/4, and for the most part 5 Inches or 2133thereabouts; and as 11 to 12, or 15 to 16, so is five Inches to 5-2/2 or 21345-1/3 Inches. 2135 2136And by this Progression of Experiments I satisfied my self, that had the 2137Light at the very Ends of the Spectrum been strong enough to make the 2138Species of the black Lines appear plainly on the Paper, the Focus of the 2139deepest violet would have been found nearer to the Lens, than the Focus 2140of the deepest red, by about 5-1/3 Inches at least. And this is a 2141farther Evidence, that the Sines of Incidence and Refraction of the 2142several sorts of Rays, hold the same Proportion to one another in the 2143smallest Refractions which they do in the greatest. 2144 2145My Progress in making this nice and troublesome Experiment I have set 2146down more at large, that they that shall try it after me may be aware of 2147the Circumspection requisite to make it succeed well. And if they cannot 2148make it succeed so well as I did, they may notwithstanding collect by 2149the Proportion of the distance of the Colours of the Spectrum, to the 2150Difference of the distances of their Foci from the Lens, what would be 2151the Success in the more distant Colours by a better trial. And yet, if 2152they use a broader Lens than I did, and fix it to a long strait Staff, 2153by means of which it may be readily and truly directed to the Colour 2154whose Focus is desired, I question not but the Experiment will succeed 2155better with them than it did with me. For I directed the Axis as nearly 2156as I could to the middle of the Colours, and then the faint Ends of the 2157Spectrum being remote from the Axis, cast their Species less distinctly 2158on the Paper than they would have done, had the Axis been successively 2159directed to them. 2160 2161Now by what has been said, it's certain that the Rays which differ in 2162Refrangibility do not converge to the same Focus; but if they flow from 2163a lucid Point, as far from the Lens on one side as their Foci are on the 2164other, the Focus of the most refrangible Rays shall be nearer to the 2165Lens than that of the least refrangible, by above the fourteenth Part of 2166the whole distance; and if they flow from a lucid Point, so very remote 2167from the Lens, that before their Incidence they may be accounted 2168parallel, the Focus of the most refrangible Rays shall be nearer to the 2169Lens than the Focus of the least refrangible, by about the 27th or 28th 2170Part of their whole distance from it. And the Diameter of the Circle in 2171the middle Space between those two Foci which they illuminate, when they 2172fall there on any Plane, perpendicular to the Axis (which Circle is the 2173least into which they can all be gathered) is about the 55th Part of the 2174Diameter of the Aperture of the Glass. So that 'tis a wonder, that 2175Telescopes represent Objects so distinct as they do. But were all the 2176Rays of Light equally refrangible, the Error arising only from the 2177Sphericalness of the Figures of Glasses would be many hundred times 2178less. For, if the Object-glass of a Telescope be Plano-convex, and the 2179Plane side be turned towards the Object, and the Diameter of the 2180Sphere, whereof this Glass is a Segment, be called D, and the 2181Semi-diameter of the Aperture of the Glass be called S, and the Sine of 2182Incidence out of Glass into Air, be to the Sine of Refraction as I to R; 2183the Rays which come parallel to the Axis of the Glass, shall in the 2184Place where the Image of the Object is most distinctly made, be 2185scattered all over a little Circle, whose Diameter is _(Rq/Iq) × (S 2186cub./D quad.)_ very nearly,[H] as I gather by computing the Errors of 2187the Rays by the Method of infinite Series, and rejecting the Terms, 2188whose Quantities are inconsiderable. As for instance, if the Sine of 2189Incidence I, be to the Sine of Refraction R, as 20 to 31, and if D the 2190Diameter of the Sphere, to which the Convex-side of the Glass is ground, 2191be 100 Feet or 1200 Inches, and S the Semi-diameter of the Aperture be 2192two Inches, the Diameter of the little Circle, (that is (_Rq × S 2193cub.)/(Iq × D quad._)) will be (31 × 31 × 8)/(20 × 20 × 1200 × 1200) (or 2194961/72000000) Parts of an Inch. But the Diameter of the little Circle, 2195through which these Rays are scattered by unequal Refrangibility, will 2196be about the 55th Part of the Aperture of the Object-glass, which here 2197is four Inches. And therefore, the Error arising from the Spherical 2198Figure of the Glass, is to the Error arising from the different 2199Refrangibility of the Rays, as 961/72000000 to 4/55, that is as 1 to 22005449; and therefore being in comparison so very little, deserves not to 2201be considered. 2202 2203[Illustration: FIG. 27.] 2204 2205But you will say, if the Errors caused by the different Refrangibility 2206be so very great, how comes it to pass, that Objects appear through 2207Telescopes so distinct as they do? I answer, 'tis because the erring 2208Rays are not scattered uniformly over all that Circular Space, but 2209collected infinitely more densely in the Center than in any other Part 2210of the Circle, and in the Way from the Center to the Circumference, grow 2211continually rarer and rarer, so as at the Circumference to become 2212infinitely rare; and by reason of their Rarity are not strong enough to 2213be visible, unless in the Center and very near it. Let ADE [in _Fig._ 221427.] represent one of those Circles described with the Center C, and 2215Semi-diameter AC, and let BFG be a smaller Circle concentrick to the 2216former, cutting with its Circumference the Diameter AC in B, and bisect 2217AC in N; and by my reckoning, the Density of the Light in any Place B, 2218will be to its Density in N, as AB to BC; and the whole Light within the 2219lesser Circle BFG, will be to the whole Light within the greater AED, as 2220the Excess of the Square of AC above the Square of AB, is to the Square 2221of AC. As if BC be the fifth Part of AC, the Light will be four times 2222denser in B than in N, and the whole Light within the less Circle, will 2223be to the whole Light within the greater, as nine to twenty-five. Whence 2224it's evident, that the Light within the less Circle, must strike the 2225Sense much more strongly, than that faint and dilated Light round about 2226between it and the Circumference of the greater. 2227 2228But it's farther to be noted, that the most luminous of the Prismatick 2229Colours are the yellow and orange. These affect the Senses more strongly 2230than all the rest together, and next to these in strength are the red 2231and green. The blue compared with these is a faint and dark Colour, and 2232the indigo and violet are much darker and fainter, so that these 2233compared with the stronger Colours are little to be regarded. The Images 2234of Objects are therefore to be placed, not in the Focus of the mean 2235refrangible Rays, which are in the Confine of green and blue, but in the 2236Focus of those Rays which are in the middle of the orange and yellow; 2237there where the Colour is most luminous and fulgent, that is in the 2238brightest yellow, that yellow which inclines more to orange than to 2239green. And by the Refraction of these Rays (whose Sines of Incidence and 2240Refraction in Glass are as 17 and 11) the Refraction of Glass and 2241Crystal for Optical Uses is to be measured. Let us therefore place the 2242Image of the Object in the Focus of these Rays, and all the yellow and 2243orange will fall within a Circle, whose Diameter is about the 250th 2244Part of the Diameter of the Aperture of the Glass. And if you add the 2245brighter half of the red, (that half which is next the orange) and the 2246brighter half of the green, (that half which is next the yellow) about 2247three fifth Parts of the Light of these two Colours will fall within the 2248same Circle, and two fifth Parts will fall without it round about; and 2249that which falls without will be spread through almost as much more 2250space as that which falls within, and so in the gross be almost three 2251times rarer. Of the other half of the red and green, (that is of the 2252deep dark red and willow green) about one quarter will fall within this 2253Circle, and three quarters without, and that which falls without will be 2254spread through about four or five times more space than that which falls 2255within; and so in the gross be rarer, and if compared with the whole 2256Light within it, will be about 25 times rarer than all that taken in the 2257gross; or rather more than 30 or 40 times rarer, because the deep red in 2258the end of the Spectrum of Colours made by a Prism is very thin and 2259rare, and the willow green is something rarer than the orange and 2260yellow. The Light of these Colours therefore being so very much rarer 2261than that within the Circle, will scarce affect the Sense, especially 2262since the deep red and willow green of this Light, are much darker 2263Colours than the rest. And for the same reason the blue and violet being 2264much darker Colours than these, and much more rarified, may be 2265neglected. For the dense and bright Light of the Circle, will obscure 2266the rare and weak Light of these dark Colours round about it, and 2267render them almost insensible. The sensible Image of a lucid Point is 2268therefore scarce broader than a Circle, whose Diameter is the 250th Part 2269of the Diameter of the Aperture of the Object-glass of a good Telescope, 2270or not much broader, if you except a faint and dark misty Light round 2271about it, which a Spectator will scarce regard. And therefore in a 2272Telescope, whose Aperture is four Inches, and Length an hundred Feet, it 2273exceeds not 2´´ 45´´´, or 3´´. And in a Telescope whose Aperture is two 2274Inches, and Length 20 or 30 Feet, it may be 5´´ or 6´´, and scarce 2275above. And this answers well to Experience: For some Astronomers have 2276found the Diameters of the fix'd Stars, in Telescopes of between 20 and 227760 Feet in length, to be about 5´´ or 6´´, or at most 8´´ or 10´´ in 2278diameter. But if the Eye-Glass be tincted faintly with the Smoak of a 2279Lamp or Torch, to obscure the Light of the Star, the fainter Light in 2280the Circumference of the Star ceases to be visible, and the Star (if the 2281Glass be sufficiently soiled with Smoak) appears something more like a 2282mathematical Point. And for the same Reason, the enormous Part of the 2283Light in the Circumference of every lucid Point ought to be less 2284discernible in shorter Telescopes than in longer, because the shorter 2285transmit less Light to the Eye. 2286 2287Now, that the fix'd Stars, by reason of their immense Distance, appear 2288like Points, unless so far as their Light is dilated by Refraction, may 2289appear from hence; that when the Moon passes over them and eclipses 2290them, their Light vanishes, not gradually like that of the Planets, but 2291all at once; and in the end of the Eclipse it returns into Sight all at 2292once, or certainly in less time than the second of a Minute; the 2293Refraction of the Moon's Atmosphere a little protracting the time in 2294which the Light of the Star first vanishes, and afterwards returns into 2295Sight. 2296 2297Now, if we suppose the sensible Image of a lucid Point, to be even 250 2298times narrower than the Aperture of the Glass; yet this Image would be 2299still much greater than if it were only from the spherical Figure of the 2300Glass. For were it not for the different Refrangibility of the Rays, its 2301breadth in an 100 Foot Telescope whose aperture is 4 Inches, would be 2302but 961/72000000 parts of an Inch, as is manifest by the foregoing 2303Computation. And therefore in this case the greatest Errors arising from 2304the spherical Figure of the Glass, would be to the greatest sensible 2305Errors arising from the different Refrangibility of the Rays as 2306961/72000000 to 4/250 at most, that is only as 1 to 1200. And this 2307sufficiently shews that it is not the spherical Figures of Glasses, but 2308the different Refrangibility of the Rays which hinders the perfection of 2309Telescopes. 2310 2311There is another Argument by which it may appear that the different 2312Refrangibility of Rays, is the true cause of the imperfection of 2313Telescopes. For the Errors of the Rays arising from the spherical 2314Figures of Object-glasses, are as the Cubes of the Apertures of the 2315Object Glasses; and thence to make Telescopes of various Lengths magnify 2316with equal distinctness, the Apertures of the Object-glasses, and the 2317Charges or magnifying Powers ought to be as the Cubes of the square 2318Roots of their lengths; which doth not answer to Experience. But the 2319Errors of the Rays arising from the different Refrangibility, are as the 2320Apertures of the Object-glasses; and thence to make Telescopes of 2321various lengths, magnify with equal distinctness, their Apertures and 2322Charges ought to be as the square Roots of their lengths; and this 2323answers to Experience, as is well known. For Instance, a Telescope of 64 2324Feet in length, with an Aperture of 2-2/3 Inches, magnifies about 120 2325times, with as much distinctness as one of a Foot in length, with 1/3 of 2326an Inch aperture, magnifies 15 times. 2327 2328[Illustration: FIG. 28.] 2329 2330Now were it not for this different Refrangibility of Rays, Telescopes 2331might be brought to a greater perfection than we have yet describ'd, by 2332composing the Object-glass of two Glasses with Water between them. Let 2333ADFC [in _Fig._ 28.] represent the Object-glass composed of two Glasses 2334ABED and BEFC, alike convex on the outsides AGD and CHF, and alike 2335concave on the insides BME, BNE, with Water in the concavity BMEN. Let 2336the Sine of Incidence out of Glass into Air be as I to R, and out of 2337Water into Air, as K to R, and by consequence out of Glass into Water, 2338as I to K: and let the Diameter of the Sphere to which the convex sides 2339AGD and CHF are ground be D, and the Diameter of the Sphere to which the 2340concave sides BME and BNE, are ground be to D, as the Cube Root of 2341KK--KI to the Cube Root of RK--RI: and the Refractions on the concave 2342sides of the Glasses, will very much correct the Errors of the 2343Refractions on the convex sides, so far as they arise from the 2344sphericalness of the Figure. And by this means might Telescopes be 2345brought to sufficient perfection, were it not for the different 2346Refrangibility of several sorts of Rays. But by reason of this different 2347Refrangibility, I do not yet see any other means of improving Telescopes 2348by Refractions alone, than that of increasing their lengths, for which 2349end the late Contrivance of _Hugenius_ seems well accommodated. For very 2350long Tubes are cumbersome, and scarce to be readily managed, and by 2351reason of their length are very apt to bend, and shake by bending, so as 2352to cause a continual trembling in the Objects, whereby it becomes 2353difficult to see them distinctly: whereas by his Contrivance the Glasses 2354are readily manageable, and the Object-glass being fix'd upon a strong 2355upright Pole becomes more steady. 2356 2357Seeing therefore the Improvement of Telescopes of given lengths by 2358Refractions is desperate; I contrived heretofore a Perspective by 2359Reflexion, using instead of an Object-glass a concave Metal. The 2360diameter of the Sphere to which the Metal was ground concave was about 236125 _English_ Inches, and by consequence the length of the Instrument 2362about six Inches and a quarter. The Eye-glass was Plano-convex, and the 2363diameter of the Sphere to which the convex side was ground was about 1/5 2364of an Inch, or a little less, and by consequence it magnified between 30 2365and 40 times. By another way of measuring I found that it magnified 2366about 35 times. The concave Metal bore an Aperture of an Inch and a 2367third part; but the Aperture was limited not by an opake Circle, 2368covering the Limb of the Metal round about, but by an opake Circle 2369placed between the Eyeglass and the Eye, and perforated in the middle 2370with a little round hole for the Rays to pass through to the Eye. For 2371this Circle by being placed here, stopp'd much of the erroneous Light, 2372which otherwise would have disturbed the Vision. By comparing it with a 2373pretty good Perspective of four Feet in length, made with a concave 2374Eye-glass, I could read at a greater distance with my own Instrument 2375than with the Glass. Yet Objects appeared much darker in it than in the 2376Glass, and that partly because more Light was lost by Reflexion in the 2377Metal, than by Refraction in the Glass, and partly because my Instrument 2378was overcharged. Had it magnified but 30 or 25 times, it would have made 2379the Object appear more brisk and pleasant. Two of these I made about 16 2380Years ago, and have one of them still by me, by which I can prove the 2381truth of what I write. Yet it is not so good as at the first. For the 2382concave has been divers times tarnished and cleared again, by rubbing 2383it with very soft Leather. When I made these an Artist in _London_ 2384undertook to imitate it; but using another way of polishing them than I 2385did, he fell much short of what I had attained to, as I afterwards 2386understood by discoursing the Under-workman he had employed. The Polish 2387I used was in this manner. I had two round Copper Plates, each six 2388Inches in Diameter, the one convex, the other concave, ground very true 2389to one another. On the convex I ground the Object-Metal or Concave which 2390was to be polish'd, 'till it had taken the Figure of the Convex and was 2391ready for a Polish. Then I pitched over the convex very thinly, by 2392dropping melted Pitch upon it, and warming it to keep the Pitch soft, 2393whilst I ground it with the concave Copper wetted to make it spread 2394eavenly all over the convex. Thus by working it well I made it as thin 2395as a Groat, and after the convex was cold I ground it again to give it 2396as true a Figure as I could. Then I took Putty which I had made very 2397fine by washing it from all its grosser Particles, and laying a little 2398of this upon the Pitch, I ground it upon the Pitch with the concave 2399Copper, till it had done making a Noise; and then upon the Pitch I 2400ground the Object-Metal with a brisk motion, for about two or three 2401Minutes of time, leaning hard upon it. Then I put fresh Putty upon the 2402Pitch, and ground it again till it had done making a noise, and 2403afterwards ground the Object-Metal upon it as before. And this Work I 2404repeated till the Metal was polished, grinding it the last time with all 2405my strength for a good while together, and frequently breathing upon 2406the Pitch, to keep it moist without laying on any more fresh Putty. The 2407Object-Metal was two Inches broad, and about one third part of an Inch 2408thick, to keep it from bending. I had two of these Metals, and when I 2409had polished them both, I tried which was best, and ground the other 2410again, to see if I could make it better than that which I kept. And thus 2411by many Trials I learn'd the way of polishing, till I made those two 2412reflecting Perspectives I spake of above. For this Art of polishing will 2413be better learn'd by repeated Practice than by my Description. Before I 2414ground the Object-Metal on the Pitch, I always ground the Putty on it 2415with the concave Copper, till it had done making a noise, because if the 2416Particles of the Putty were not by this means made to stick fast in the 2417Pitch, they would by rolling up and down grate and fret the Object-Metal 2418and fill it full of little holes. 2419 2420But because Metal is more difficult to polish than Glass, and is 2421afterwards very apt to be spoiled by tarnishing, and reflects not so 2422much Light as Glass quick-silver'd over does: I would propound to use 2423instead of the Metal, a Glass ground concave on the foreside, and as 2424much convex on the backside, and quick-silver'd over on the convex side. 2425The Glass must be every where of the same thickness exactly. Otherwise 2426it will make Objects look colour'd and indistinct. By such a Glass I 2427tried about five or six Years ago to make a reflecting Telescope of four 2428Feet in length to magnify about 150 times, and I satisfied my self that 2429there wants nothing but a good Artist to bring the Design to 2430perfection. For the Glass being wrought by one of our _London_ Artists 2431after such a manner as they grind Glasses for Telescopes, though it 2432seemed as well wrought as the Object-glasses use to be, yet when it was 2433quick-silver'd, the Reflexion discovered innumerable Inequalities all 2434over the Glass. And by reason of these Inequalities, Objects appeared 2435indistinct in this Instrument. For the Errors of reflected Rays caused 2436by any Inequality of the Glass, are about six times greater than the 2437Errors of refracted Rays caused by the like Inequalities. Yet by this 2438Experiment I satisfied my self that the Reflexion on the concave side of 2439the Glass, which I feared would disturb the Vision, did no sensible 2440prejudice to it, and by consequence that nothing is wanting to perfect 2441these Telescopes, but good Workmen who can grind and polish Glasses 2442truly spherical. An Object-glass of a fourteen Foot Telescope, made by 2443an Artificer at _London_, I once mended considerably, by grinding it on 2444Pitch with Putty, and leaning very easily on it in the grinding, lest 2445the Putty should scratch it. Whether this way may not do well enough for 2446polishing these reflecting Glasses, I have not yet tried. But he that 2447shall try either this or any other way of polishing which he may think 2448better, may do well to make his Glasses ready for polishing, by grinding 2449them without that Violence, wherewith our _London_ Workmen press their 2450Glasses in grinding. For by such violent pressure, Glasses are apt to 2451bend a little in the grinding, and such bending will certainly spoil 2452their Figure. To recommend therefore the consideration of these 2453reflecting Glasses to such Artists as are curious in figuring Glasses, I 2454shall describe this optical Instrument in the following Proposition. 2455 2456 2457_PROP._ VIII. PROB. II. 2458 2459_To shorten Telescopes._ 2460 2461Let ABCD [in _Fig._ 29.] represent a Glass spherically concave on the 2462foreside AB, and as much convex on the backside CD, so that it be every 2463where of an equal thickness. Let it not be thicker on one side than on 2464the other, lest it make Objects appear colour'd and indistinct, and let 2465it be very truly wrought and quick-silver'd over on the backside; and 2466set in the Tube VXYZ which must be very black within. Let EFG represent 2467a Prism of Glass or Crystal placed near the other end of the Tube, in 2468the middle of it, by means of a handle of Brass or Iron FGK, to the end 2469of which made flat it is cemented. Let this Prism be rectangular at E, 2470and let the other two Angles at F and G be accurately equal to each 2471other, and by consequence equal to half right ones, and let the plane 2472sides FE and GE be square, and by consequence the third side FG a 2473rectangular Parallelogram, whose length is to its breadth in a 2474subduplicate proportion of two to one. Let it be so placed in the Tube, 2475that the Axis of the Speculum may pass through the middle of the square 2476side EF perpendicularly and by consequence through the middle of the 2477side FG at an Angle of 45 Degrees, and let the side EF be turned towards 2478the Speculum, and the distance of this Prism from the Speculum be such 2479that the Rays of the Light PQ, RS, &c. which are incident upon the 2480Speculum in Lines parallel to the Axis thereof, may enter the Prism at 2481the side EF, and be reflected by the side FG, and thence go out of it 2482through the side GE, to the Point T, which must be the common Focus of 2483the Speculum ABDC, and of a Plano-convex Eye-glass H, through which 2484those Rays must pass to the Eye. And let the Rays at their coming out of 2485the Glass pass through a small round hole, or aperture made in a little 2486plate of Lead, Brass, or Silver, wherewith the Glass is to be covered, 2487which hole must be no bigger than is necessary for Light enough to pass 2488through. For so it will render the Object distinct, the Plate in which 2489'tis made intercepting all the erroneous part of the Light which comes 2490from the verges of the Speculum AB. Such an Instrument well made, if it 2491be six Foot long, (reckoning the length from the Speculum to the Prism, 2492and thence to the Focus T) will bear an aperture of six Inches at the 2493Speculum, and magnify between two and three hundred times. But the hole 2494H here limits the aperture with more advantage, than if the aperture was 2495placed at the Speculum. If the Instrument be made longer or shorter, the 2496aperture must be in proportion as the Cube of the square-square Root of 2497the length, and the magnifying as the aperture. But it's convenient that 2498the Speculum be an Inch or two broader than the aperture at the least, 2499and that the Glass of the Speculum be thick, that it bend not in the 2500working. The Prism EFG must be no bigger than is necessary, and its back 2501side FG must not be quick-silver'd over. For without quicksilver it will 2502reflect all the Light incident on it from the Speculum. 2503 2504[Illustration: FIG. 29.] 2505 2506In this Instrument the Object will be inverted, but may be erected by 2507making the square sides FF and EG of the Prism EFG not plane but 2508spherically convex, that the Rays may cross as well before they come at 2509it as afterwards between it and the Eye-glass. If it be desired that the 2510Instrument bear a larger aperture, that may be also done by composing 2511the Speculum of two Glasses with Water between them. 2512 2513If the Theory of making Telescopes could at length be fully brought into 2514Practice, yet there would be certain Bounds beyond which Telescopes 2515could not perform. For the Air through which we look upon the Stars, is 2516in a perpetual Tremor; as may be seen by the tremulous Motion of Shadows 2517cast from high Towers, and by the twinkling of the fix'd Stars. But 2518these Stars do not twinkle when viewed through Telescopes which have 2519large apertures. For the Rays of Light which pass through divers parts 2520of the aperture, tremble each of them apart, and by means of their 2521various and sometimes contrary Tremors, fall at one and the same time 2522upon different points in the bottom of the Eye, and their trembling 2523Motions are too quick and confused to be perceived severally. And all 2524these illuminated Points constitute one broad lucid Point, composed of 2525those many trembling Points confusedly and insensibly mixed with one 2526another by very short and swift Tremors, and thereby cause the Star to 2527appear broader than it is, and without any trembling of the whole. Long 2528Telescopes may cause Objects to appear brighter and larger than short 2529ones can do, but they cannot be so formed as to take away that confusion 2530of the Rays which arises from the Tremors of the Atmosphere. The only 2531Remedy is a most serene and quiet Air, such as may perhaps be found on 2532the tops of the highest Mountains above the grosser Clouds. 2533 2534FOOTNOTES: 2535 2536[C] _See our_ Author's Lectiones Opticæ § 10. _Sect. II. § 29. and Sect. 2537III. Prop. 25._ 2538 2539[D] See our Author's _Lectiones Opticæ_, Part. I. Sect. 1. §5. 2540 2541[E] _This is very fully treated of in our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ 2542I. _Sect._ II. 2543 2544[F] _See our_ Author's Lect. Optic. Part I. Sect. II. § 29. 2545 2546[G] _This is demonstrated in our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ I. 2547_Sect._ IV. _Prop._ 37. 2548 2549[H] _How to do this, is shewn in our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ I. 2550_Sect._ IV. _Prop._ 31. 2551 2552 2553 2554 2555THE FIRST BOOK OF OPTICKS 2556 2557 2558 2559 2560_PART II._ 2561 2562 2563_PROP._ I. THEOR. I. 2564 2565_The Phænomena of Colours in refracted or reflected Light are not caused 2566by new Modifications of the Light variously impress'd, according to the 2567various Terminations of the Light and Shadow_. 2568 2569The PROOF by Experiments. 2570 2571_Exper._ 1. For if the Sun shine into a very dark Chamber through an 2572oblong hole F, [in _Fig._ 1.] whose breadth is the sixth or eighth part 2573of an Inch, or something less; and his beam FH do afterwards pass first 2574through a very large Prism ABC, distant about 20 Feet from the hole, and 2575parallel to it, and then (with its white part) through an oblong hole H, 2576whose breadth is about the fortieth or sixtieth part of an Inch, and 2577which is made in a black opake Body GI, and placed at the distance of 2578two or three Feet from the Prism, in a parallel Situation both to the 2579Prism and to the former hole, and if this white Light thus transmitted 2580through the hole H, fall afterwards upon a white Paper _pt_, placed 2581after that hole H, at the distance of three or four Feet from it, and 2582there paint the usual Colours of the Prism, suppose red at _t_, yellow 2583at _s_, green at _r_, blue at _q_, and violet at _p_; you may with an 2584Iron Wire, or any such like slender opake Body, whose breadth is about 2585the tenth part of an Inch, by intercepting the Rays at _k_, _l_, _m_, 2586_n_ or _o_, take away any one of the Colours at _t_, _s_, _r_, _q_ or 2587_p_, whilst the other Colours remain upon the Paper as before; or with 2588an Obstacle something bigger you may take away any two, or three, or 2589four Colours together, the rest remaining: So that any one of the 2590Colours as well as violet may become outmost in the Confine of the 2591Shadow towards _p_, and any one of them as well as red may become 2592outmost in the Confine of the Shadow towards _t_, and any one of them 2593may also border upon the Shadow made within the Colours by the Obstacle 2594R intercepting some intermediate part of the Light; and, lastly, any one 2595of them by being left alone, may border upon the Shadow on either hand. 2596All the Colours have themselves indifferently to any Confines of Shadow, 2597and therefore the differences of these Colours from one another, do not 2598arise from the different Confines of Shadow, whereby Light is variously 2599modified, as has hitherto been the Opinion of Philosophers. In trying 2600these things 'tis to be observed, that by how much the holes F and H are 2601narrower, and the Intervals between them and the Prism greater, and the 2602Chamber darker, by so much the better doth the Experiment succeed; 2603provided the Light be not so far diminished, but that the Colours at 2604_pt_ be sufficiently visible. To procure a Prism of solid Glass large 2605enough for this Experiment will be difficult, and therefore a prismatick 2606Vessel must be made of polish'd Glass Plates cemented together, and 2607filled with salt Water or clear Oil. 2608 2609[Illustration: FIG. 1.] 2610 2611_Exper._ 2. The Sun's Light let into a dark Chamber through the round 2612hole F, [in _Fig._ 2.] half an Inch wide, passed first through the Prism 2613ABC placed at the hole, and then through a Lens PT something more than 2614four Inches broad, and about eight Feet distant from the Prism, and 2615thence converged to O the Focus of the Lens distant from it about three 2616Feet, and there fell upon a white Paper DE. If that Paper was 2617perpendicular to that Light incident upon it, as 'tis represented in the 2618posture DE, all the Colours upon it at O appeared white. But if the 2619Paper being turned about an Axis parallel to the Prism, became very much 2620inclined to the Light, as 'tis represented in the Positions _de_ and 2621_[Greek: de]_; the same Light in the one case appeared yellow and red, 2622in the other blue. Here one and the same part of the Light in one and 2623the same place, according to the various Inclinations of the Paper, 2624appeared in one case white, in another yellow or red, in a third blue, 2625whilst the Confine of Light and shadow, and the Refractions of the Prism 2626in all these cases remained the same. 2627 2628[Illustration: FIG. 2.] 2629 2630[Illustration: FIG. 3.] 2631 2632_Exper._ 3. Such another Experiment may be more easily tried as follows. 2633Let a broad beam of the Sun's Light coming into a dark Chamber through a 2634hole in the Window-shut be refracted by a large Prism ABC, [in _Fig._ 26353.] whose refracting Angle C is more than 60 Degrees, and so soon as it 2636comes out of the Prism, let it fall upon the white Paper DE glewed upon 2637a stiff Plane; and this Light, when the Paper is perpendicular to it, as 2638'tis represented in DE, will appear perfectly white upon the Paper; but 2639when the Paper is very much inclin'd to it in such a manner as to keep 2640always parallel to the Axis of the Prism, the whiteness of the whole 2641Light upon the Paper will according to the inclination of the Paper this 2642way or that way, change either into yellow and red, as in the posture 2643_de_, or into blue and violet, as in the posture [Greek: de]. And if the 2644Light before it fall upon the Paper be twice refracted the same way by 2645two parallel Prisms, these Colours will become the more conspicuous. 2646Here all the middle parts of the broad beam of white Light which fell 2647upon the Paper, did without any Confine of Shadow to modify it, become 2648colour'd all over with one uniform Colour, the Colour being always the 2649same in the middle of the Paper as at the edges, and this Colour changed 2650according to the various Obliquity of the reflecting Paper, without any 2651change in the Refractions or Shadow, or in the Light which fell upon the 2652Paper. And therefore these Colours are to be derived from some other 2653Cause than the new Modifications of Light by Refractions and Shadows. 2654 2655If it be asked, what then is their Cause? I answer, That the Paper in 2656the posture _de_, being more oblique to the more refrangible Rays than 2657to the less refrangible ones, is more strongly illuminated by the latter 2658than by the former, and therefore the less refrangible Rays are 2659predominant in the reflected Light. And where-ever they are predominant 2660in any Light, they tinge it with red or yellow, as may in some measure 2661appear by the first Proposition of the first Part of this Book, and will 2662more fully appear hereafter. And the contrary happens in the posture of 2663the Paper [Greek: de], the more refrangible Rays being then predominant 2664which always tinge Light with blues and violets. 2665 2666_Exper._ 4. The Colours of Bubbles with which Children play are various, 2667and change their Situation variously, without any respect to any Confine 2668or Shadow. If such a Bubble be cover'd with a concave Glass, to keep it 2669from being agitated by any Wind or Motion of the Air, the Colours will 2670slowly and regularly change their situation, even whilst the Eye and the 2671Bubble, and all Bodies which emit any Light, or cast any Shadow, remain 2672unmoved. And therefore their Colours arise from some regular Cause which 2673depends not on any Confine of Shadow. What this Cause is will be shewed 2674in the next Book. 2675 2676To these Experiments may be added the tenth Experiment of the first Part 2677of this first Book, where the Sun's Light in a dark Room being 2678trajected through the parallel Superficies of two Prisms tied together 2679in the form of a Parallelopipede, became totally of one uniform yellow 2680or red Colour, at its emerging out of the Prisms. Here, in the 2681production of these Colours, the Confine of Shadow can have nothing to 2682do. For the Light changes from white to yellow, orange and red 2683successively, without any alteration of the Confine of Shadow: And at 2684both edges of the emerging Light where the contrary Confines of Shadow 2685ought to produce different Effects, the Colour is one and the same, 2686whether it be white, yellow, orange or red: And in the middle of the 2687emerging Light, where there is no Confine of Shadow at all, the Colour 2688is the very same as at the edges, the whole Light at its very first 2689Emergence being of one uniform Colour, whether white, yellow, orange or 2690red, and going on thence perpetually without any change of Colour, such 2691as the Confine of Shadow is vulgarly supposed to work in refracted Light 2692after its Emergence. Neither can these Colours arise from any new 2693Modifications of the Light by Refractions, because they change 2694successively from white to yellow, orange and red, while the Refractions 2695remain the same, and also because the Refractions are made contrary ways 2696by parallel Superficies which destroy one another's Effects. They arise 2697not therefore from any Modifications of Light made by Refractions and 2698Shadows, but have some other Cause. What that Cause is we shewed above 2699in this tenth Experiment, and need not here repeat it. 2700 2701There is yet another material Circumstance of this Experiment. For this 2702emerging Light being by a third Prism HIK [in _Fig._ 22. _Part_ I.][I] 2703refracted towards the Paper PT, and there painting the usual Colours of 2704the Prism, red, yellow, green, blue, violet: If these Colours arose from 2705the Refractions of that Prism modifying the Light, they would not be in 2706the Light before its Incidence on that Prism. And yet in that Experiment 2707we found, that when by turning the two first Prisms about their common 2708Axis all the Colours were made to vanish but the red; the Light which 2709makes that red being left alone, appeared of the very same red Colour 2710before its Incidence on the third Prism. And in general we find by other 2711Experiments, that when the Rays which differ in Refrangibility are 2712separated from one another, and any one Sort of them is considered 2713apart, the Colour of the Light which they compose cannot be changed by 2714any Refraction or Reflexion whatever, as it ought to be were Colours 2715nothing else than Modifications of Light caused by Refractions, and 2716Reflexions, and Shadows. This Unchangeableness of Colour I am now to 2717describe in the following Proposition. 2718 2719 2720_PROP._ II. THEOR. II. 2721 2722_All homogeneal Light has its proper Colour answering to its Degree of 2723Refrangibility, and that Colour cannot be changed by Reflexions and 2724Refractions._ 2725 2726In the Experiments of the fourth Proposition of the first Part of this 2727first Book, when I had separated the heterogeneous Rays from one 2728another, the Spectrum _pt_ formed by the separated Rays, did in the 2729Progress from its End _p_, on which the most refrangible Rays fell, unto 2730its other End _t_, on which the least refrangible Rays fell, appear 2731tinged with this Series of Colours, violet, indigo, blue, green, yellow, 2732orange, red, together with all their intermediate Degrees in a continual 2733Succession perpetually varying. So that there appeared as many Degrees 2734of Colours, as there were sorts of Rays differing in Refrangibility. 2735 2736_Exper._ 5. Now, that these Colours could not be changed by Refraction, 2737I knew by refracting with a Prism sometimes one very little Part of this 2738Light, sometimes another very little Part, as is described in the 2739twelfth Experiment of the first Part of this Book. For by this 2740Refraction the Colour of the Light was never changed in the least. If 2741any Part of the red Light was refracted, it remained totally of the same 2742red Colour as before. No orange, no yellow, no green or blue, no other 2743new Colour was produced by that Refraction. Neither did the Colour any 2744ways change by repeated Refractions, but continued always the same red 2745entirely as at first. The like Constancy and Immutability I found also 2746in the blue, green, and other Colours. So also, if I looked through a 2747Prism upon any Body illuminated with any part of this homogeneal Light, 2748as in the fourteenth Experiment of the first Part of this Book is 2749described; I could not perceive any new Colour generated this way. All 2750Bodies illuminated with compound Light appear through Prisms confused, 2751(as was said above) and tinged with various new Colours, but those 2752illuminated with homogeneal Light appeared through Prisms neither less 2753distinct, nor otherwise colour'd, than when viewed with the naked Eyes. 2754Their Colours were not in the least changed by the Refraction of the 2755interposed Prism. I speak here of a sensible Change of Colour: For the 2756Light which I here call homogeneal, being not absolutely homogeneal, 2757there ought to arise some little Change of Colour from its 2758Heterogeneity. But, if that Heterogeneity was so little as it might be 2759made by the said Experiments of the fourth Proposition, that Change was 2760not sensible, and therefore in Experiments, where Sense is Judge, ought 2761to be accounted none at all. 2762 2763_Exper._ 6. And as these Colours were not changeable by Refractions, so 2764neither were they by Reflexions. For all white, grey, red, yellow, 2765green, blue, violet Bodies, as Paper, Ashes, red Lead, Orpiment, Indico 2766Bise, Gold, Silver, Copper, Grass, blue Flowers, Violets, Bubbles of 2767Water tinged with various Colours, Peacock's Feathers, the Tincture of 2768_Lignum Nephriticum_, and such-like, in red homogeneal Light appeared 2769totally red, in blue Light totally blue, in green Light totally green, 2770and so of other Colours. In the homogeneal Light of any Colour they all 2771appeared totally of that same Colour, with this only Difference, that 2772some of them reflected that Light more strongly, others more faintly. I 2773never yet found any Body, which by reflecting homogeneal Light could 2774sensibly change its Colour. 2775 2776From all which it is manifest, that if the Sun's Light consisted of but 2777one sort of Rays, there would be but one Colour in the whole World, nor 2778would it be possible to produce any new Colour by Reflexions and 2779Refractions, and by consequence that the variety of Colours depends upon 2780the Composition of Light. 2781 2782 2783_DEFINITION._ 2784 2785The homogeneal Light and Rays which appear red, or rather make Objects 2786appear so, I call Rubrifick or Red-making; those which make Objects 2787appear yellow, green, blue, and violet, I call Yellow-making, 2788Green-making, Blue-making, Violet-making, and so of the rest. And if at 2789any time I speak of Light and Rays as coloured or endued with Colours, I 2790would be understood to speak not philosophically and properly, but 2791grossly, and accordingly to such Conceptions as vulgar People in seeing 2792all these Experiments would be apt to frame. For the Rays to speak 2793properly are not coloured. In them there is nothing else than a certain 2794Power and Disposition to stir up a Sensation of this or that Colour. 2795For as Sound in a Bell or musical String, or other sounding Body, is 2796nothing but a trembling Motion, and in the Air nothing but that Motion 2797propagated from the Object, and in the Sensorium 'tis a Sense of that 2798Motion under the Form of Sound; so Colours in the Object are nothing but 2799a Disposition to reflect this or that sort of Rays more copiously than 2800the rest; in the Rays they are nothing but their Dispositions to 2801propagate this or that Motion into the Sensorium, and in the Sensorium 2802they are Sensations of those Motions under the Forms of Colours. 2803 2804 2805_PROP._ III. PROB. I. 2806 2807_To define the Refrangibility of the several sorts of homogeneal Light 2808answering to the several Colours._ 2809 2810For determining this Problem I made the following Experiment.[J] 2811 2812_Exper._ 7. When I had caused the Rectilinear Sides AF, GM, [in _Fig._ 28134.] of the Spectrum of Colours made by the Prism to be distinctly 2814defined, as in the fifth Experiment of the first Part of this Book is 2815described, there were found in it all the homogeneal Colours in the same 2816Order and Situation one among another as in the Spectrum of simple 2817Light, described in the fourth Proposition of that Part. For the Circles 2818of which the Spectrum of compound Light PT is composed, and which in 2819the middle Parts of the Spectrum interfere, and are intermix'd with one 2820another, are not intermix'd in their outmost Parts where they touch 2821those Rectilinear Sides AF and GM. And therefore, in those Rectilinear 2822Sides when distinctly defined, there is no new Colour generated by 2823Refraction. I observed also, that if any where between the two outmost 2824Circles TMF and PGA a Right Line, as [Greek: gd], was cross to the 2825Spectrum, so as both Ends to fall perpendicularly upon its Rectilinear 2826Sides, there appeared one and the same Colour, and degree of Colour from 2827one End of this Line to the other. I delineated therefore in a Paper the 2828Perimeter of the Spectrum FAP GMT, and in trying the third Experiment of 2829the first Part of this Book, I held the Paper so that the Spectrum might 2830fall upon this delineated Figure, and agree with it exactly, whilst an 2831Assistant, whose Eyes for distinguishing Colours were more critical than 2832mine, did by Right Lines [Greek: ab, gd, ez,] &c. drawn cross the 2833Spectrum, note the Confines of the Colours, that is of the red M[Greek: 2834ab]F, of the orange [Greek: agdb], of the yellow [Greek: gezd], of the 2835green [Greek: eêthz], of the blue [Greek: êikth], of the indico [Greek: 2836ilmk], and of the violet [Greek: l]GA[Greek: m]. And this Operation 2837being divers times repeated both in the same, and in several Papers, I 2838found that the Observations agreed well enough with one another, and 2839that the Rectilinear Sides MG and FA were by the said cross Lines 2840divided after the manner of a Musical Chord. Let GM be produced to X, 2841that MX may be equal to GM, and conceive GX, [Greek: l]X, [Greek: i]X, 2842[Greek: ê]X, [Greek: e]X, [Greek: g]X, [Greek: a]X, MX, to be in 2843proportion to one another, as the Numbers, 1, 8/9, 5/6, 3/4, 2/3, 3/5, 28449/16, 1/2, and so to represent the Chords of the Key, and of a Tone, a 2845third Minor, a fourth, a fifth, a sixth Major, a seventh and an eighth 2846above that Key: And the Intervals M[Greek: a], [Greek: ag], [Greek: ge], 2847[Greek: eê], [Greek: êi], [Greek: il], and [Greek: l]G, will be the 2848Spaces which the several Colours (red, orange, yellow, green, blue, 2849indigo, violet) take up. 2850 2851[Illustration: FIG. 4.] 2852 2853[Illustration: FIG. 5.] 2854 2855Now these Intervals or Spaces subtending the Differences of the 2856Refractions of the Rays going to the Limits of those Colours, that is, 2857to the Points M, [Greek: a], [Greek: g], [Greek: e], [Greek: ê], [Greek: 2858i], [Greek: l], G, may without any sensible Error be accounted 2859proportional to the Differences of the Sines of Refraction of those Rays 2860having one common Sine of Incidence, and therefore since the common Sine 2861of Incidence of the most and least refrangible Rays out of Glass into 2862Air was (by a Method described above) found in proportion to their Sines 2863of Refraction, as 50 to 77 and 78, divide the Difference between the 2864Sines of Refraction 77 and 78, as the Line GM is divided by those 2865Intervals, and you will have 77, 77-1/8, 77-1/5, 77-1/3, 77-1/2, 77-2/3, 286677-7/9, 78, the Sines of Refraction of those Rays out of Glass into Air, 2867their common Sine of Incidence being 50. So then the Sines of the 2868Incidences of all the red-making Rays out of Glass into Air, were to the 2869Sines of their Refractions, not greater than 50 to 77, nor less than 50 2870to 77-1/8, but they varied from one another according to all 2871intermediate Proportions. And the Sines of the Incidences of the 2872green-making Rays were to the Sines of their Refractions in all 2873Proportions from that of 50 to 77-1/3, unto that of 50 to 77-1/2. And 2874by the like Limits above-mentioned were the Refractions of the Rays 2875belonging to the rest of the Colours defined, the Sines of the 2876red-making Rays extending from 77 to 77-1/8, those of the orange-making 2877from 77-1/8 to 77-1/5, those of the yellow-making from 77-1/5 to 77-1/3, 2878those of the green-making from 77-1/3 to 77-1/2, those of the 2879blue-making from 77-1/2 to 77-2/3, those of the indigo-making from 288077-2/3 to 77-7/9, and those of the violet from 77-7/9, to 78. 2881 2882These are the Laws of the Refractions made out of Glass into Air, and 2883thence by the third Axiom of the first Part of this Book, the Laws of 2884the Refractions made out of Air into Glass are easily derived. 2885 2886_Exper._ 8. I found moreover, that when Light goes out of Air through 2887several contiguous refracting Mediums as through Water and Glass, and 2888thence goes out again into Air, whether the refracting Superficies be 2889parallel or inclin'd to one another, that Light as often as by contrary 2890Refractions 'tis so corrected, that it emergeth in Lines parallel to 2891those in which it was incident, continues ever after to be white. But if 2892the emergent Rays be inclined to the incident, the Whiteness of the 2893emerging Light will by degrees in passing on from the Place of 2894Emergence, become tinged in its Edges with Colours. This I try'd by 2895refracting Light with Prisms of Glass placed within a Prismatick Vessel 2896of Water. Now those Colours argue a diverging and separation of the 2897heterogeneous Rays from one another by means of their unequal 2898Refractions, as in what follows will more fully appear. And, on the 2899contrary, the permanent whiteness argues, that in like Incidences of the 2900Rays there is no such separation of the emerging Rays, and by 2901consequence no inequality of their whole Refractions. Whence I seem to 2902gather the two following Theorems. 2903 29041. The Excesses of the Sines of Refraction of several sorts of Rays 2905above their common Sine of Incidence when the Refractions are made out 2906of divers denser Mediums immediately into one and the same rarer Medium, 2907suppose of Air, are to one another in a given Proportion. 2908 29092. The Proportion of the Sine of Incidence to the Sine of Refraction of 2910one and the same sort of Rays out of one Medium into another, is 2911composed of the Proportion of the Sine of Incidence to the Sine of 2912Refraction out of the first Medium into any third Medium, and of the 2913Proportion of the Sine of Incidence to the Sine of Refraction out of 2914that third Medium into the second Medium. 2915 2916By the first Theorem the Refractions of the Rays of every sort made out 2917of any Medium into Air are known by having the Refraction of the Rays of 2918any one sort. As for instance, if the Refractions of the Rays of every 2919sort out of Rain-water into Air be desired, let the common Sine of 2920Incidence out of Glass into Air be subducted from the Sines of 2921Refraction, and the Excesses will be 27, 27-1/8, 27-1/5, 27-1/3, 27-1/2, 292227-2/3, 27-7/9, 28. Suppose now that the Sine of Incidence of the least 2923refrangible Rays be to their Sine of Refraction out of Rain-water into 2924Air as 3 to 4, and say as 1 the difference of those Sines is to 3 the 2925Sine of Incidence, so is 27 the least of the Excesses above-mentioned to 2926a fourth Number 81; and 81 will be the common Sine of Incidence out of 2927Rain-water into Air, to which Sine if you add all the above-mentioned 2928Excesses, you will have the desired Sines of the Refractions 108, 2929108-1/8, 108-1/5, 108-1/3, 108-1/2, 108-2/3, 108-7/9, 109. 2930 2931By the latter Theorem the Refraction out of one Medium into another is 2932gathered as often as you have the Refractions out of them both into any 2933third Medium. As if the Sine of Incidence of any Ray out of Glass into 2934Air be to its Sine of Refraction, as 20 to 31, and the Sine of Incidence 2935of the same Ray out of Air into Water, be to its Sine of Refraction as 4 2936to 3; the Sine of Incidence of that Ray out of Glass into Water will be 2937to its Sine of Refraction as 20 to 31 and 4 to 3 jointly, that is, as 2938the Factum of 20 and 4 to the Factum of 31 and 3, or as 80 to 93. 2939 2940And these Theorems being admitted into Opticks, there would be scope 2941enough of handling that Science voluminously after a new manner,[K] not 2942only by teaching those things which tend to the perfection of Vision, 2943but also by determining mathematically all kinds of Phænomena of Colours 2944which could be produced by Refractions. For to do this, there is nothing 2945else requisite than to find out the Separations of heterogeneous Rays, 2946and their various Mixtures and Proportions in every Mixture. By this 2947way of arguing I invented almost all the Phænomena described in these 2948Books, beside some others less necessary to the Argument; and by the 2949successes I met with in the Trials, I dare promise, that to him who 2950shall argue truly, and then try all things with good Glasses and 2951sufficient Circumspection, the expected Event will not be wanting. But 2952he is first to know what Colours will arise from any others mix'd in any 2953assigned Proportion. 2954 2955 2956_PROP._ IV. THEOR. III. 2957 2958_Colours may be produced by Composition which shall be like to the 2959Colours of homogeneal Light as to the Appearance of Colour, but not as 2960to the Immutability of Colour and Constitution of Light. And those 2961Colours by how much they are more compounded by so much are they less 2962full and intense, and by too much Composition they maybe diluted and 2963weaken'd till they cease, and the Mixture becomes white or grey. There 2964may be also Colours produced by Composition, which are not fully like 2965any of the Colours of homogeneal Light._ 2966 2967For a Mixture of homogeneal red and yellow compounds an Orange, like in 2968appearance of Colour to that orange which in the series of unmixed 2969prismatick Colours lies between them; but the Light of one orange is 2970homogeneal as to Refrangibility, and that of the other is heterogeneal, 2971and the Colour of the one, if viewed through a Prism, remains unchanged, 2972that of the other is changed and resolved into its component Colours red 2973and yellow. And after the same manner other neighbouring homogeneal 2974Colours may compound new Colours, like the intermediate homogeneal ones, 2975as yellow and green, the Colour between them both, and afterwards, if 2976blue be added, there will be made a green the middle Colour of the three 2977which enter the Composition. For the yellow and blue on either hand, if 2978they are equal in quantity they draw the intermediate green equally 2979towards themselves in Composition, and so keep it as it were in 2980Æquilibrion, that it verge not more to the yellow on the one hand, and 2981to the blue on the other, but by their mix'd Actions remain still a 2982middle Colour. To this mix'd green there may be farther added some red 2983and violet, and yet the green will not presently cease, but only grow 2984less full and vivid, and by increasing the red and violet, it will grow 2985more and more dilute, until by the prevalence of the added Colours it be 2986overcome and turned into whiteness, or some other Colour. So if to the 2987Colour of any homogeneal Light, the Sun's white Light composed of all 2988sorts of Rays be added, that Colour will not vanish or change its 2989Species, but be diluted, and by adding more and more white it will be 2990diluted more and more perpetually. Lastly, If red and violet be mingled, 2991there will be generated according to their various Proportions various 2992Purples, such as are not like in appearance to the Colour of any 2993homogeneal Light, and of these Purples mix'd with yellow and blue may be 2994made other new Colours. 2995 2996 2997_PROP._ V. THEOR. IV. 2998 2999_Whiteness and all grey Colours between white and black, may be 3000compounded of Colours, and the whiteness of the Sun's Light is 3001compounded of all the primary Colours mix'd in a due Proportion._ 3002 3003The PROOF by Experiments. 3004 3005_Exper._ 9. The Sun shining into a dark Chamber through a little round 3006hole in the Window-shut, and his Light being there refracted by a Prism 3007to cast his coloured Image PT [in _Fig._ 5.] upon the opposite Wall: I 3008held a white Paper V to that image in such manner that it might be 3009illuminated by the colour'd Light reflected from thence, and yet not 3010intercept any part of that Light in its passage from the Prism to the 3011Spectrum. And I found that when the Paper was held nearer to any Colour 3012than to the rest, it appeared of that Colour to which it approached 3013nearest; but when it was equally or almost equally distant from all the 3014Colours, so that it might be equally illuminated by them all it appeared 3015white. And in this last situation of the Paper, if some Colours were 3016intercepted, the Paper lost its white Colour, and appeared of the Colour 3017of the rest of the Light which was not intercepted. So then the Paper 3018was illuminated with Lights of various Colours, namely, red, yellow, 3019green, blue and violet, and every part of the Light retained its proper 3020Colour, until it was incident on the Paper, and became reflected thence 3021to the Eye; so that if it had been either alone (the rest of the Light 3022being intercepted) or if it had abounded most, and been predominant in 3023the Light reflected from the Paper, it would have tinged the Paper with 3024its own Colour; and yet being mixed with the rest of the Colours in a 3025due proportion, it made the Paper look white, and therefore by a 3026Composition with the rest produced that Colour. The several parts of the 3027coloured Light reflected from the Spectrum, whilst they are propagated 3028from thence through the Air, do perpetually retain their proper Colours, 3029because wherever they fall upon the Eyes of any Spectator, they make the 3030several parts of the Spectrum to appear under their proper Colours. They 3031retain therefore their proper Colours when they fall upon the Paper V, 3032and so by the confusion and perfect mixture of those Colours compound 3033the whiteness of the Light reflected from thence. 3034 3035_Exper._ 10. Let that Spectrum or solar Image PT [in _Fig._ 6.] fall now 3036upon the Lens MN above four Inches broad, and about six Feet distant 3037from the Prism ABC and so figured that it may cause the coloured Light 3038which divergeth from the Prism to converge and meet again at its Focus 3039G, about six or eight Feet distant from the Lens, and there to fall 3040perpendicularly upon a white Paper DE. And if you move this Paper to and 3041fro, you will perceive that near the Lens, as at _de_, the whole solar 3042Image (suppose at _pt_) will appear upon it intensely coloured after the 3043manner above-explained, and that by receding from the Lens those Colours 3044will perpetually come towards one another, and by mixing more and more 3045dilute one another continually, until at length the Paper come to the 3046Focus G, where by a perfect mixture they will wholly vanish and be 3047converted into whiteness, the whole Light appearing now upon the Paper 3048like a little white Circle. And afterwards by receding farther from the 3049Lens, the Rays which before converged will now cross one another in the 3050Focus G, and diverge from thence, and thereby make the Colours to appear 3051again, but yet in a contrary order; suppose at [Greek: de], where the 3052red _t_ is now above which before was below, and the violet _p_ is below 3053which before was above. 3054 3055Let us now stop the Paper at the Focus G, where the Light appears 3056totally white and circular, and let us consider its whiteness. I say, 3057that this is composed of the converging Colours. For if any of those 3058Colours be intercepted at the Lens, the whiteness will cease and 3059degenerate into that Colour which ariseth from the composition of the 3060other Colours which are not intercepted. And then if the intercepted 3061Colours be let pass and fall upon that compound Colour, they mix with 3062it, and by their mixture restore the whiteness. So if the violet, blue 3063and green be intercepted, the remaining yellow, orange and red will 3064compound upon the Paper an orange, and then if the intercepted Colours 3065be let pass, they will fall upon this compounded orange, and together 3066with it decompound a white. So also if the red and violet be 3067intercepted, the remaining yellow, green and blue, will compound a green 3068upon the Paper, and then the red and violet being let pass will fall 3069upon this green, and together with it decompound a white. And that in 3070this Composition of white the several Rays do not suffer any Change in 3071their colorific Qualities by acting upon one another, but are only 3072mixed, and by a mixture of their Colours produce white, may farther 3073appear by these Arguments. 3074 3075[Illustration: FIG. 6.] 3076 3077If the Paper be placed beyond the Focus G, suppose at [Greek: de], and 3078then the red Colour at the Lens be alternately intercepted, and let pass 3079again, the violet Colour on the Paper will not suffer any Change 3080thereby, as it ought to do if the several sorts of Rays acted upon one 3081another in the Focus G, where they cross. Neither will the red upon the 3082Paper be changed by any alternate stopping, and letting pass the violet 3083which crosseth it. 3084 3085And if the Paper be placed at the Focus G, and the white round Image at 3086G be viewed through the Prism HIK, and by the Refraction of that Prism 3087be translated to the place _rv_, and there appear tinged with various 3088Colours, namely, the violet at _v_ and red at _r_, and others between, 3089and then the red Colours at the Lens be often stopp'd and let pass by 3090turns, the red at _r_ will accordingly disappear, and return as often, 3091but the violet at _v_ will not thereby suffer any Change. And so by 3092stopping and letting pass alternately the blue at the Lens, the blue at 3093_v_ will accordingly disappear and return, without any Change made in 3094the red at _r_. The red therefore depends on one sort of Rays, and the 3095blue on another sort, which in the Focus G where they are commix'd, do 3096not act on one another. And there is the same Reason of the other 3097Colours. 3098 3099I considered farther, that when the most refrangible Rays P_p_, and the 3100least refrangible ones T_t_, are by converging inclined to one another, 3101the Paper, if held very oblique to those Rays in the Focus G, might 3102reflect one sort of them more copiously than the other sort, and by that 3103Means the reflected Light would be tinged in that Focus with the Colour 3104of the predominant Rays, provided those Rays severally retained their 3105Colours, or colorific Qualities in the Composition of White made by them 3106in that Focus. But if they did not retain them in that White, but became 3107all of them severally endued there with a Disposition to strike the 3108Sense with the Perception of White, then they could never lose their 3109Whiteness by such Reflexions. I inclined therefore the Paper to the Rays 3110very obliquely, as in the second Experiment of this second Part of the 3111first Book, that the most refrangible Rays, might be more copiously 3112reflected than the rest, and the Whiteness at Length changed 3113successively into blue, indigo, and violet. Then I inclined it the 3114contrary Way, that the least refrangible Rays might be more copious in 3115the reflected Light than the rest, and the Whiteness turned successively 3116to yellow, orange, and red. 3117 3118Lastly, I made an Instrument XY in fashion of a Comb, whose Teeth being 3119in number sixteen, were about an Inch and a half broad, and the 3120Intervals of the Teeth about two Inches wide. Then by interposing 3121successively the Teeth of this Instrument near the Lens, I intercepted 3122Part of the Colours by the interposed Tooth, whilst the rest of them 3123went on through the Interval of the Teeth to the Paper DE, and there 3124painted a round Solar Image. But the Paper I had first placed so, that 3125the Image might appear white as often as the Comb was taken away; and 3126then the Comb being as was said interposed, that Whiteness by reason of 3127the intercepted Part of the Colours at the Lens did always change into 3128the Colour compounded of those Colours which were not intercepted, and 3129that Colour was by the Motion of the Comb perpetually varied so, that in 3130the passing of every Tooth over the Lens all these Colours, red, yellow, 3131green, blue, and purple, did always succeed one another. I caused 3132therefore all the Teeth to pass successively over the Lens, and when the 3133Motion was slow, there appeared a perpetual Succession of the Colours 3134upon the Paper: But if I so much accelerated the Motion, that the 3135Colours by reason of their quick Succession could not be distinguished 3136from one another, the Appearance of the single Colours ceased. There was 3137no red, no yellow, no green, no blue, nor purple to be seen any longer, 3138but from a Confusion of them all there arose one uniform white Colour. 3139Of the Light which now by the Mixture of all the Colours appeared white, 3140there was no Part really white. One Part was red, another yellow, a 3141third green, a fourth blue, a fifth purple, and every Part retains its 3142proper Colour till it strike the Sensorium. If the Impressions follow 3143one another slowly, so that they may be severally perceived, there is 3144made a distinct Sensation of all the Colours one after another in a 3145continual Succession. But if the Impressions follow one another so 3146quickly, that they cannot be severally perceived, there ariseth out of 3147them all one common Sensation, which is neither of this Colour alone nor 3148of that alone, but hath it self indifferently to 'em all, and this is a 3149Sensation of Whiteness. By the Quickness of the Successions, the 3150Impressions of the several Colours are confounded in the Sensorium, and 3151out of that Confusion ariseth a mix'd Sensation. If a burning Coal be 3152nimbly moved round in a Circle with Gyrations continually repeated, the 3153whole Circle will appear like Fire; the reason of which is, that the 3154Sensation of the Coal in the several Places of that Circle remains 3155impress'd on the Sensorium, until the Coal return again to the same 3156Place. And so in a quick Consecution of the Colours the Impression of 3157every Colour remains in the Sensorium, until a Revolution of all the 3158Colours be compleated, and that first Colour return again. The 3159Impressions therefore of all the successive Colours are at once in the 3160Sensorium, and jointly stir up a Sensation of them all; and so it is 3161manifest by this Experiment, that the commix'd Impressions of all the 3162Colours do stir up and beget a Sensation of white, that is, that 3163Whiteness is compounded of all the Colours. 3164 3165And if the Comb be now taken away, that all the Colours may at once pass 3166from the Lens to the Paper, and be there intermixed, and together 3167reflected thence to the Spectator's Eyes; their Impressions on the 3168Sensorium being now more subtilly and perfectly commixed there, ought 3169much more to stir up a Sensation of Whiteness. 3170 3171You may instead of the Lens use two Prisms HIK and LMN, which by 3172refracting the coloured Light the contrary Way to that of the first 3173Refraction, may make the diverging Rays converge and meet again in G, as 3174you see represented in the seventh Figure. For where they meet and mix, 3175they will compose a white Light, as when a Lens is used. 3176 3177_Exper._ 11. Let the Sun's coloured Image PT [in _Fig._ 8.] fall upon 3178the Wall of a dark Chamber, as in the third Experiment of the first 3179Book, and let the same be viewed through a Prism _abc_, held parallel to 3180the Prism ABC, by whose Refraction that Image was made, and let it now 3181appear lower than before, suppose in the Place S over-against the red 3182Colour T. And if you go near to the Image PT, the Spectrum S will appear 3183oblong and coloured like the Image PT; but if you recede from it, the 3184Colours of the spectrum S will be contracted more and more, and at 3185length vanish, that Spectrum S becoming perfectly round and white; and 3186if you recede yet farther, the Colours will emerge again, but in a 3187contrary Order. Now that Spectrum S appears white in that Case, when the 3188Rays of several sorts which converge from the several Parts of the Image 3189PT, to the Prism _abc_, are so refracted unequally by it, that in their 3190Passage from the Prism to the Eye they may diverge from one and the same 3191Point of the Spectrum S, and so fall afterwards upon one and the same 3192Point in the bottom of the Eye, and there be mingled. 3193 3194[Illustration: FIG. 7.] 3195 3196[Illustration: FIG. 8.] 3197 3198And farther, if the Comb be here made use of, by whose Teeth the Colours 3199at the Image PT may be successively intercepted; the Spectrum S, when 3200the Comb is moved slowly, will be perpetually tinged with successive 3201Colours: But when by accelerating the Motion of the Comb, the Succession 3202of the Colours is so quick that they cannot be severally seen, that 3203Spectrum S, by a confused and mix'd Sensation of them all, will appear 3204white. 3205 3206_Exper._ 12. The Sun shining through a large Prism ABC [in _Fig._ 9.] 3207upon a Comb XY, placed immediately behind the Prism, his Light which 3208passed through the Interstices of the Teeth fell upon a white Paper DE. 3209The Breadths of the Teeth were equal to their Interstices, and seven 3210Teeth together with their Interstices took up an Inch in Breadth. Now, 3211when the Paper was about two or three Inches distant from the Comb, the 3212Light which passed through its several Interstices painted so many 3213Ranges of Colours, _kl_, _mn_, _op_, _qr_, &c. which were parallel to 3214one another, and contiguous, and without any Mixture of white. And these 3215Ranges of Colours, if the Comb was moved continually up and down with a 3216reciprocal Motion, ascended and descended in the Paper, and when the 3217Motion of the Comb was so quick, that the Colours could not be 3218distinguished from one another, the whole Paper by their Confusion and 3219Mixture in the Sensorium appeared white. 3220 3221[Illustration: FIG. 9.] 3222 3223Let the Comb now rest, and let the Paper be removed farther from the 3224Prism, and the several Ranges of Colours will be dilated and expanded 3225into one another more and more, and by mixing their Colours will dilute 3226one another, and at length, when the distance of the Paper from the Comb 3227is about a Foot, or a little more (suppose in the Place 2D 2E) they will 3228so far dilute one another, as to become white. 3229 3230With any Obstacle, let all the Light be now stopp'd which passes through 3231any one Interval of the Teeth, so that the Range of Colours which comes 3232from thence may be taken away, and you will see the Light of the rest of 3233the Ranges to be expanded into the Place of the Range taken away, and 3234there to be coloured. Let the intercepted Range pass on as before, and 3235its Colours falling upon the Colours of the other Ranges, and mixing 3236with them, will restore the Whiteness. 3237 3238Let the Paper 2D 2E be now very much inclined to the Rays, so that the 3239most refrangible Rays may be more copiously reflected than the rest, and 3240the white Colour of the Paper through the Excess of those Rays will be 3241changed into blue and violet. Let the Paper be as much inclined the 3242contrary way, that the least refrangible Rays may be now more copiously 3243reflected than the rest, and by their Excess the Whiteness will be 3244changed into yellow and red. The several Rays therefore in that white 3245Light do retain their colorific Qualities, by which those of any sort, 3246whenever they become more copious than the rest, do by their Excess and 3247Predominance cause their proper Colour to appear. 3248 3249And by the same way of arguing, applied to the third Experiment of this 3250second Part of the first Book, it may be concluded, that the white 3251Colour of all refracted Light at its very first Emergence, where it 3252appears as white as before its Incidence, is compounded of various 3253Colours. 3254 3255[Illustration: FIG. 10.] 3256 3257_Exper._ 13. In the foregoing Experiment the several Intervals of the 3258Teeth of the Comb do the Office of so many Prisms, every Interval 3259producing the Phænomenon of one Prism. Whence instead of those Intervals 3260using several Prisms, I try'd to compound Whiteness by mixing their 3261Colours, and did it by using only three Prisms, as also by using only 3262two as follows. Let two Prisms ABC and _abc_, [in _Fig._ 10.] whose 3263refracting Angles B and _b_ are equal, be so placed parallel to one 3264another, that the refracting Angle B of the one may touch the Angle _c_ 3265at the Base of the other, and their Planes CB and _cb_, at which the 3266Rays emerge, may lie in Directum. Then let the Light trajected through 3267them fall upon the Paper MN, distant about 8 or 12 Inches from the 3268Prisms. And the Colours generated by the interior Limits B and _c_ of 3269the two Prisms, will be mingled at PT, and there compound white. For if 3270either Prism be taken away, the Colours made by the other will appear in 3271that Place PT, and when the Prism is restored to its Place again, so 3272that its Colours may there fall upon the Colours of the other, the 3273Mixture of them both will restore the Whiteness. 3274 3275This Experiment succeeds also, as I have tried, when the Angle _b_ of 3276the lower Prism, is a little greater than the Angle B of the upper, and 3277between the interior Angles B and _c_, there intercedes some Space B_c_, 3278as is represented in the Figure, and the refracting Planes BC and _bc_, 3279are neither in Directum, nor parallel to one another. For there is 3280nothing more requisite to the Success of this Experiment, than that the 3281Rays of all sorts may be uniformly mixed upon the Paper in the Place PT. 3282If the most refrangible Rays coming from the superior Prism take up all 3283the Space from M to P, the Rays of the same sort which come from the 3284inferior Prism ought to begin at P, and take up all the rest of the 3285Space from thence towards N. If the least refrangible Rays coming from 3286the superior Prism take up the Space MT, the Rays of the same kind which 3287come from the other Prism ought to begin at T, and take up the 3288remaining Space TN. If one sort of the Rays which have intermediate 3289Degrees of Refrangibility, and come from the superior Prism be extended 3290through the Space MQ, and another sort of those Rays through the Space 3291MR, and a third sort of them through the Space MS, the same sorts of 3292Rays coming from the lower Prism, ought to illuminate the remaining 3293Spaces QN, RN, SN, respectively. And the same is to be understood of all 3294the other sorts of Rays. For thus the Rays of every sort will be 3295scattered uniformly and evenly through the whole Space MN, and so being 3296every where mix'd in the same Proportion, they must every where produce 3297the same Colour. And therefore, since by this Mixture they produce white 3298in the Exterior Spaces MP and TN, they must also produce white in the 3299Interior Space PT. This is the reason of the Composition by which 3300Whiteness was produced in this Experiment, and by what other way soever 3301I made the like Composition, the Result was Whiteness. 3302 3303Lastly, If with the Teeth of a Comb of a due Size, the coloured Lights 3304of the two Prisms which fall upon the Space PT be alternately 3305intercepted, that Space PT, when the Motion of the Comb is slow, will 3306always appear coloured, but by accelerating the Motion of the Comb so 3307much that the successive Colours cannot be distinguished from one 3308another, it will appear white. 3309 3310_Exper._ 14. Hitherto I have produced Whiteness by mixing the Colours of 3311Prisms. If now the Colours of natural Bodies are to be mingled, let 3312Water a little thicken'd with Soap be agitated to raise a Froth, and 3313after that Froth has stood a little, there will appear to one that shall 3314view it intently various Colours every where in the Surfaces of the 3315several Bubbles; but to one that shall go so far off, that he cannot 3316distinguish the Colours from one another, the whole Froth will grow 3317white with a perfect Whiteness. 3318 3319_Exper._ 15. Lastly, In attempting to compound a white, by mixing the 3320coloured Powders which Painters use, I consider'd that all colour'd 3321Powders do suppress and stop in them a very considerable Part of the 3322Light by which they are illuminated. For they become colour'd by 3323reflecting the Light of their own Colours more copiously, and that of 3324all other Colours more sparingly, and yet they do not reflect the Light 3325of their own Colours so copiously as white Bodies do. If red Lead, for 3326instance, and a white Paper, be placed in the red Light of the colour'd 3327Spectrum made in a dark Chamber by the Refraction of a Prism, as is 3328described in the third Experiment of the first Part of this Book; the 3329Paper will appear more lucid than the red Lead, and therefore reflects 3330the red-making Rays more copiously than red Lead doth. And if they be 3331held in the Light of any other Colour, the Light reflected by the Paper 3332will exceed the Light reflected by the red Lead in a much greater 3333Proportion. And the like happens in Powders of other Colours. And 3334therefore by mixing such Powders, we are not to expect a strong and 3335full White, such as is that of Paper, but some dusky obscure one, such 3336as might arise from a Mixture of Light and Darkness, or from white and 3337black, that is, a grey, or dun, or russet brown, such as are the Colours 3338of a Man's Nail, of a Mouse, of Ashes, of ordinary Stones, of Mortar, of 3339Dust and Dirt in High-ways, and the like. And such a dark white I have 3340often produced by mixing colour'd Powders. For thus one Part of red 3341Lead, and five Parts of _Viride Æris_, composed a dun Colour like that 3342of a Mouse. For these two Colours were severally so compounded of 3343others, that in both together were a Mixture of all Colours; and there 3344was less red Lead used than _Viride Æris_, because of the Fulness of its 3345Colour. Again, one Part of red Lead, and four Parts of blue Bise, 3346composed a dun Colour verging a little to purple, and by adding to this 3347a certain Mixture of Orpiment and _Viride Æris_ in a due Proportion, the 3348Mixture lost its purple Tincture, and became perfectly dun. But the 3349Experiment succeeded best without Minium thus. To Orpiment I added by 3350little and little a certain full bright purple, which Painters use, 3351until the Orpiment ceased to be yellow, and became of a pale red. Then I 3352diluted that red by adding a little _Viride Æris_, and a little more 3353blue Bise than _Viride Æris_, until it became of such a grey or pale 3354white, as verged to no one of the Colours more than to another. For thus 3355it became of a Colour equal in Whiteness to that of Ashes, or of Wood 3356newly cut, or of a Man's Skin. The Orpiment reflected more Light than 3357did any other of the Powders, and therefore conduced more to the 3358Whiteness of the compounded Colour than they. To assign the Proportions 3359accurately may be difficult, by reason of the different Goodness of 3360Powders of the same kind. Accordingly, as the Colour of any Powder is 3361more or less full and luminous, it ought to be used in a less or greater 3362Proportion. 3363 3364Now, considering that these grey and dun Colours may be also produced by 3365mixing Whites and Blacks, and by consequence differ from perfect Whites, 3366not in Species of Colours, but only in degree of Luminousness, it is 3367manifest that there is nothing more requisite to make them perfectly 3368white than to increase their Light sufficiently; and, on the contrary, 3369if by increasing their Light they can be brought to perfect Whiteness, 3370it will thence also follow, that they are of the same Species of Colour 3371with the best Whites, and differ from them only in the Quantity of 3372Light. And this I tried as follows. I took the third of the 3373above-mention'd grey Mixtures, (that which was compounded of Orpiment, 3374Purple, Bise, and _Viride Æris_) and rubbed it thickly upon the Floor of 3375my Chamber, where the Sun shone upon it through the opened Casement; and 3376by it, in the shadow, I laid a Piece of white Paper of the same Bigness. 3377Then going from them to the distance of 12 or 18 Feet, so that I could 3378not discern the Unevenness of the Surface of the Powder, nor the little 3379Shadows let fall from the gritty Particles thereof; the Powder appeared 3380intensely white, so as to transcend even the Paper it self in Whiteness, 3381especially if the Paper were a little shaded from the Light of the 3382Clouds, and then the Paper compared with the Powder appeared of such a 3383grey Colour as the Powder had done before. But by laying the Paper where 3384the Sun shines through the Glass of the Window, or by shutting the 3385Window that the Sun might shine through the Glass upon the Powder, and 3386by such other fit Means of increasing or decreasing the Lights wherewith 3387the Powder and Paper were illuminated, the Light wherewith the Powder is 3388illuminated may be made stronger in such a due Proportion than the Light 3389wherewith the Paper is illuminated, that they shall both appear exactly 3390alike in Whiteness. For when I was trying this, a Friend coming to visit 3391me, I stopp'd him at the Door, and before I told him what the Colours 3392were, or what I was doing; I asked him, Which of the two Whites were the 3393best, and wherein they differed? And after he had at that distance 3394viewed them well, he answer'd, that they were both good Whites, and that 3395he could not say which was best, nor wherein their Colours differed. 3396Now, if you consider, that this White of the Powder in the Sun-shine was 3397compounded of the Colours which the component Powders (Orpiment, Purple, 3398Bise, and _Viride Æris_) have in the same Sun-shine, you must 3399acknowledge by this Experiment, as well as by the former, that perfect 3400Whiteness may be compounded of Colours. 3401 3402From what has been said it is also evident, that the Whiteness of the 3403Sun's Light is compounded of all the Colours wherewith the several sorts 3404of Rays whereof that Light consists, when by their several 3405Refrangibilities they are separated from one another, do tinge Paper or 3406any other white Body whereon they fall. For those Colours (by _Prop._ 3407II. _Part_ 2.) are unchangeable, and whenever all those Rays with those 3408their Colours are mix'd again, they reproduce the same white Light as 3409before. 3410 3411 3412_PROP._ VI. PROB. II. 3413 3414_In a mixture of Primary Colours, the Quantity and Quality of each being 3415given, to know the Colour of the Compound._ 3416 3417[Illustration: FIG. 11.] 3418 3419With the Center O [in _Fig._ 11.] and Radius OD describe a Circle ADF, 3420and distinguish its Circumference into seven Parts DE, EF, FG, GA, AB, 3421BC, CD, proportional to the seven Musical Tones or Intervals of the 3422eight Sounds, _Sol_, _la_, _fa_, _sol_, _la_, _mi_, _fa_, _sol_, 3423contained in an eight, that is, proportional to the Number 1/9, 1/16, 34241/10, 1/9, 1/16, 1/16, 1/9. Let the first Part DE represent a red 3425Colour, the second EF orange, the third FG yellow, the fourth CA green, 3426the fifth AB blue, the sixth BC indigo, and the seventh CD violet. And 3427conceive that these are all the Colours of uncompounded Light gradually 3428passing into one another, as they do when made by Prisms; the 3429Circumference DEFGABCD, representing the whole Series of Colours from 3430one end of the Sun's colour'd Image to the other, so that from D to E be 3431all degrees of red, at E the mean Colour between red and orange, from E 3432to F all degrees of orange, at F the mean between orange and yellow, 3433from F to G all degrees of yellow, and so on. Let _p_ be the Center of 3434Gravity of the Arch DE, and _q_, _r_, _s_, _t_, _u_, _x_, the Centers of 3435Gravity of the Arches EF, FG, GA, AB, BC, and CD respectively, and about 3436those Centers of Gravity let Circles proportional to the Number of Rays 3437of each Colour in the given Mixture be describ'd: that is, the Circle 3438_p_ proportional to the Number of the red-making Rays in the Mixture, 3439the Circle _q_ proportional to the Number of the orange-making Rays in 3440the Mixture, and so of the rest. Find the common Center of Gravity of 3441all those Circles, _p_, _q_, _r_, _s_, _t_, _u_, _x_. Let that Center be 3442Z; and from the Center of the Circle ADF, through Z to the 3443Circumference, drawing the Right Line OY, the Place of the Point Y in 3444the Circumference shall shew the Colour arising from the Composition of 3445all the Colours in the given Mixture, and the Line OZ shall be 3446proportional to the Fulness or Intenseness of the Colour, that is, to 3447its distance from Whiteness. As if Y fall in the middle between F and G, 3448the compounded Colour shall be the best yellow; if Y verge from the 3449middle towards F or G, the compound Colour shall accordingly be a 3450yellow, verging towards orange or green. If Z fall upon the 3451Circumference, the Colour shall be intense and florid in the highest 3452Degree; if it fall in the mid-way between the Circumference and Center, 3453it shall be but half so intense, that is, it shall be such a Colour as 3454would be made by diluting the intensest yellow with an equal quantity of 3455whiteness; and if it fall upon the center O, the Colour shall have lost 3456all its intenseness, and become a white. But it is to be noted, That if 3457the point Z fall in or near the line OD, the main ingredients being the 3458red and violet, the Colour compounded shall not be any of the prismatick 3459Colours, but a purple, inclining to red or violet, accordingly as the 3460point Z lieth on the side of the line DO towards E or towards C, and in 3461general the compounded violet is more bright and more fiery than the 3462uncompounded. Also if only two of the primary Colours which in the 3463circle are opposite to one another be mixed in an equal proportion, the 3464point Z shall fall upon the center O, and yet the Colour compounded of 3465those two shall not be perfectly white, but some faint anonymous Colour. 3466For I could never yet by mixing only two primary Colours produce a 3467perfect white. Whether it may be compounded of a mixture of three taken 3468at equal distances in the circumference I do not know, but of four or 3469five I do not much question but it may. But these are Curiosities of 3470little or no moment to the understanding the Phænomena of Nature. For in 3471all whites produced by Nature, there uses to be a mixture of all sorts 3472of Rays, and by consequence a composition of all Colours. 3473 3474To give an instance of this Rule; suppose a Colour is compounded of 3475these homogeneal Colours, of violet one part, of indigo one part, of 3476blue two parts, of green three parts, of yellow five parts, of orange 3477six parts, and of red ten parts. Proportional to these parts describe 3478the Circles _x_, _v_, _t_, _s_, _r_, _q_, _p_, respectively, that is, so 3479that if the Circle _x_ be one, the Circle _v_ may be one, the Circle _t_ 3480two, the Circle _s_ three, and the Circles _r_, _q_ and _p_, five, six 3481and ten. Then I find Z the common center of gravity of these Circles, 3482and through Z drawing the Line OY, the Point Y falls upon the 3483circumference between E and F, something nearer to E than to F, and 3484thence I conclude, that the Colour compounded of these Ingredients will 3485be an orange, verging a little more to red than to yellow. Also I find 3486that OZ is a little less than one half of OY, and thence I conclude, 3487that this orange hath a little less than half the fulness or intenseness 3488of an uncompounded orange; that is to say, that it is such an orange as 3489may be made by mixing an homogeneal orange with a good white in the 3490proportion of the Line OZ to the Line ZY, this Proportion being not of 3491the quantities of mixed orange and white Powders, but of the quantities 3492of the Lights reflected from them. 3493 3494This Rule I conceive accurate enough for practice, though not 3495mathematically accurate; and the truth of it may be sufficiently proved 3496to Sense, by stopping any of the Colours at the Lens in the tenth 3497Experiment of this Book. For the rest of the Colours which are not 3498stopp'd, but pass on to the Focus of the Lens, will there compound 3499either accurately or very nearly such a Colour, as by this Rule ought to 3500result from their Mixture. 3501 3502 3503_PROP._ VII. THEOR. V. 3504 3505_All the Colours in the Universe which are made by Light, and depend not 3506on the Power of Imagination, are either the Colours of homogeneal 3507Lights, or compounded of these, and that either accurately or very 3508nearly, according to the Rule of the foregoing Problem._ 3509 3510For it has been proved (in _Prop. 1. Part 2._) that the changes of 3511Colours made by Refractions do not arise from any new Modifications of 3512the Rays impress'd by those Refractions, and by the various Terminations 3513of Light and Shadow, as has been the constant and general Opinion of 3514Philosophers. It has also been proved that the several Colours of the 3515homogeneal Rays do constantly answer to their degrees of Refrangibility, 3516(_Prop._ 1. _Part_ 1. and _Prop._ 2. _Part_ 2.) and that their degrees 3517of Refrangibility cannot be changed by Refractions and Reflexions 3518(_Prop._ 2. _Part_ 1.) and by consequence that those their Colours are 3519likewise immutable. It has also been proved directly by refracting and 3520reflecting homogeneal Lights apart, that their Colours cannot be 3521changed, (_Prop._ 2. _Part_ 2.) It has been proved also, that when the 3522several sorts of Rays are mixed, and in crossing pass through the same 3523space, they do not act on one another so as to change each others 3524colorific qualities. (_Exper._ 10. _Part_ 2.) but by mixing their 3525Actions in the Sensorium beget a Sensation differing from what either 3526would do apart, that is a Sensation of a mean Colour between their 3527proper Colours; and particularly when by the concourse and mixtures of 3528all sorts of Rays, a white Colour is produced, the white is a mixture of 3529all the Colours which the Rays would have apart, (_Prop._ 5. _Part_ 2.) 3530The Rays in that mixture do not lose or alter their several colorific 3531qualities, but by all their various kinds of Actions mix'd in the 3532Sensorium, beget a Sensation of a middling Colour between all their 3533Colours, which is whiteness. For whiteness is a mean between all 3534Colours, having it self indifferently to them all, so as with equal 3535facility to be tinged with any of them. A red Powder mixed with a little 3536blue, or a blue with a little red, doth not presently lose its Colour, 3537but a white Powder mix'd with any Colour is presently tinged with that 3538Colour, and is equally capable of being tinged with any Colour whatever. 3539It has been shewed also, that as the Sun's Light is mix'd of all sorts 3540of Rays, so its whiteness is a mixture of the Colours of all sorts of 3541Rays; those Rays having from the beginning their several colorific 3542qualities as well as their several Refrangibilities, and retaining them 3543perpetually unchanged notwithstanding any Refractions or Reflexions they 3544may at any time suffer, and that whenever any sort of the Sun's Rays is 3545by any means (as by Reflexion in _Exper._ 9, and 10. _Part_ 1. or by 3546Refraction as happens in all Refractions) separated from the rest, they 3547then manifest their proper Colours. These things have been prov'd, and 3548the sum of all this amounts to the Proposition here to be proved. For if 3549the Sun's Light is mix'd of several sorts of Rays, each of which have 3550originally their several Refrangibilities and colorific Qualities, and 3551notwithstanding their Refractions and Reflexions, and their various 3552Separations or Mixtures, keep those their original Properties 3553perpetually the same without alteration; then all the Colours in the 3554World must be such as constantly ought to arise from the original 3555colorific qualities of the Rays whereof the Lights consist by which 3556those Colours are seen. And therefore if the reason of any Colour 3557whatever be required, we have nothing else to do than to consider how 3558the Rays in the Sun's Light have by Reflexions or Refractions, or other 3559causes, been parted from one another, or mixed together; or otherwise to 3560find out what sorts of Rays are in the Light by which that Colour is 3561made, and in what Proportion; and then by the last Problem to learn the 3562Colour which ought to arise by mixing those Rays (or their Colours) in 3563that proportion. I speak here of Colours so far as they arise from 3564Light. For they appear sometimes by other Causes, as when by the power 3565of Phantasy we see Colours in a Dream, or a Mad-man sees things before 3566him which are not there; or when we see Fire by striking the Eye, or see 3567Colours like the Eye of a Peacock's Feather, by pressing our Eyes in 3568either corner whilst we look the other way. Where these and such like 3569Causes interpose not, the Colour always answers to the sort or sorts of 3570the Rays whereof the Light consists, as I have constantly found in 3571whatever Phænomena of Colours I have hitherto been able to examine. I 3572shall in the following Propositions give instances of this in the 3573Phænomena of chiefest note. 3574 3575 3576_PROP._ VIII. PROB. III. 3577 3578_By the discovered Properties of Light to explain the Colours made by 3579Prisms._ 3580 3581Let ABC [in _Fig._ 12.] represent a Prism refracting the Light of the 3582Sun, which comes into a dark Chamber through a hole F[Greek: ph] almost 3583as broad as the Prism, and let MN represent a white Paper on which the 3584refracted Light is cast, and suppose the most refrangible or deepest 3585violet-making Rays fall upon the Space P[Greek: p], the least 3586refrangible or deepest red-making Rays upon the Space T[Greek: t], the 3587middle sort between the indigo-making and blue-making Rays upon the 3588Space Q[Greek: ch], the middle sort of the green-making Rays upon the 3589Space R, the middle sort between the yellow-making and orange-making 3590Rays upon the Space S[Greek: s], and other intermediate sorts upon 3591intermediate Spaces. For so the Spaces upon which the several sorts 3592adequately fall will by reason of the different Refrangibility of those 3593sorts be one lower than another. Now if the Paper MN be so near the 3594Prism that the Spaces PT and [Greek: pt] do not interfere with one 3595another, the distance between them T[Greek: p] will be illuminated by 3596all the sorts of Rays in that proportion to one another which they have 3597at their very first coming out of the Prism, and consequently be white. 3598But the Spaces PT and [Greek: pt] on either hand, will not be 3599illuminated by them all, and therefore will appear coloured. And 3600particularly at P, where the outmost violet-making Rays fall alone, the 3601Colour must be the deepest violet. At Q where the violet-making and 3602indigo-making Rays are mixed, it must be a violet inclining much to 3603indigo. At R where the violet-making, indigo-making, blue-making, and 3604one half of the green-making Rays are mixed, their Colours must (by the 3605construction of the second Problem) compound a middle Colour between 3606indigo and blue. At S where all the Rays are mixed, except the 3607red-making and orange-making, their Colours ought by the same Rule to 3608compound a faint blue, verging more to green than indigo. And in the 3609progress from S to T, this blue will grow more and more faint and 3610dilute, till at T, where all the Colours begin to be mixed, it ends in 3611whiteness. 3612 3613[Illustration: FIG. 12.] 3614 3615So again, on the other side of the white at [Greek: t], where the least 3616refrangible or utmost red-making Rays are alone, the Colour must be the 3617deepest red. At [Greek: s] the mixture of red and orange will compound a 3618red inclining to orange. At [Greek: r] the mixture of red, orange, 3619yellow, and one half of the green must compound a middle Colour between 3620orange and yellow. At [Greek: ch] the mixture of all Colours but violet 3621and indigo will compound a faint yellow, verging more to green than to 3622orange. And this yellow will grow more faint and dilute continually in 3623its progress from [Greek: ch] to [Greek: p], where by a mixture of all 3624sorts of Rays it will become white. 3625 3626These Colours ought to appear were the Sun's Light perfectly white: But 3627because it inclines to yellow, the Excess of the yellow-making Rays 3628whereby 'tis tinged with that Colour, being mixed with the faint blue 3629between S and T, will draw it to a faint green. And so the Colours in 3630order from P to [Greek: t] ought to be violet, indigo, blue, very faint 3631green, white, faint yellow, orange, red. Thus it is by the computation: 3632And they that please to view the Colours made by a Prism will find it so 3633in Nature. 3634 3635These are the Colours on both sides the white when the Paper is held 3636between the Prism and the Point X where the Colours meet, and the 3637interjacent white vanishes. For if the Paper be held still farther off 3638from the Prism, the most refrangible and least refrangible Rays will be 3639wanting in the middle of the Light, and the rest of the Rays which are 3640found there, will by mixture produce a fuller green than before. Also 3641the yellow and blue will now become less compounded, and by consequence 3642more intense than before. And this also agrees with experience. 3643 3644And if one look through a Prism upon a white Object encompassed with 3645blackness or darkness, the reason of the Colours arising on the edges is 3646much the same, as will appear to one that shall a little consider it. If 3647a black Object be encompassed with a white one, the Colours which appear 3648through the Prism are to be derived from the Light of the white one, 3649spreading into the Regions of the black, and therefore they appear in a 3650contrary order to that, when a white Object is surrounded with black. 3651And the same is to be understood when an Object is viewed, whose parts 3652are some of them less luminous than others. For in the borders of the 3653more and less luminous Parts, Colours ought always by the same 3654Principles to arise from the Excess of the Light of the more luminous, 3655and to be of the same kind as if the darker parts were black, but yet to 3656be more faint and dilute. 3657 3658What is said of Colours made by Prisms may be easily applied to Colours 3659made by the Glasses of Telescopes or Microscopes, or by the Humours of 3660the Eye. For if the Object-glass of a Telescope be thicker on one side 3661than on the other, or if one half of the Glass, or one half of the Pupil 3662of the Eye be cover'd with any opake substance; the Object-glass, or 3663that part of it or of the Eye which is not cover'd, may be consider'd as 3664a Wedge with crooked Sides, and every Wedge of Glass or other pellucid 3665Substance has the effect of a Prism in refracting the Light which passes 3666through it.[L] 3667 3668How the Colours in the ninth and tenth Experiments of the first Part 3669arise from the different Reflexibility of Light, is evident by what was 3670there said. But it is observable in the ninth Experiment, that whilst 3671the Sun's direct Light is yellow, the Excess of the blue-making Rays in 3672the reflected beam of Light MN, suffices only to bring that yellow to a 3673pale white inclining to blue, and not to tinge it with a manifestly blue 3674Colour. To obtain therefore a better blue, I used instead of the yellow 3675Light of the Sun the white Light of the Clouds, by varying a little the 3676Experiment, as follows. 3677 3678[Illustration: FIG. 13.] 3679 3680_Exper._ 16 Let HFG [in _Fig._ 13.] represent a Prism in the open Air, 3681and S the Eye of the Spectator, viewing the Clouds by their Light coming 3682into the Prism at the Plane Side FIGK, and reflected in it by its Base 3683HEIG, and thence going out through its Plane Side HEFK to the Eye. And 3684when the Prism and Eye are conveniently placed, so that the Angles of 3685Incidence and Reflexion at the Base may be about 40 Degrees, the 3686Spectator will see a Bow MN of a blue Colour, running from one End of 3687the Base to the other, with the Concave Side towards him, and the Part 3688of the Base IMNG beyond this Bow will be brighter than the other Part 3689EMNH on the other Side of it. This blue Colour MN being made by nothing 3690else than by Reflexion of a specular Superficies, seems so odd a 3691Phænomenon, and so difficult to be explained by the vulgar Hypothesis of 3692Philosophers, that I could not but think it deserved to be taken Notice 3693of. Now for understanding the Reason of it, suppose the Plane ABC to cut 3694the Plane Sides and Base of the Prism perpendicularly. From the Eye to 3695the Line BC, wherein that Plane cuts the Base, draw the Lines S_p_ and 3696S_t_, in the Angles S_pc_ 50 degr. 1/9, and S_tc_ 49 degr. 1/28, and the 3697Point _p_ will be the Limit beyond which none of the most refrangible 3698Rays can pass through the Base of the Prism, and be refracted, whose 3699Incidence is such that they may be reflected to the Eye; and the Point 3700_t_ will be the like Limit for the least refrangible Rays, that is, 3701beyond which none of them can pass through the Base, whose Incidence is 3702such that by Reflexion they may come to the Eye. And the Point _r_ taken 3703in the middle Way between _p_ and _t_, will be the like Limit for the 3704meanly refrangible Rays. And therefore all the least refrangible Rays 3705which fall upon the Base beyond _t_, that is, between _t_ and B, and can 3706come from thence to the Eye, will be reflected thither: But on this side 3707_t_, that is, between _t_ and _c_, many of these Rays will be 3708transmitted through the Base. And all the most refrangible Rays which 3709fall upon the Base beyond _p_, that is, between, _p_ and B, and can by 3710Reflexion come from thence to the Eye, will be reflected thither, but 3711every where between _p_ and _c_, many of these Rays will get through the 3712Base, and be refracted; and the same is to be understood of the meanly 3713refrangible Rays on either side of the Point _r_. Whence it follows, 3714that the Base of the Prism must every where between _t_ and B, by a 3715total Reflexion of all sorts of Rays to the Eye, look white and bright. 3716And every where between _p_ and C, by reason of the Transmission of many 3717Rays of every sort, look more pale, obscure, and dark. But at _r_, and 3718in other Places between _p_ and _t_, where all the more refrangible Rays 3719are reflected to the Eye, and many of the less refrangible are 3720transmitted, the Excess of the most refrangible in the reflected Light 3721will tinge that Light with their Colour, which is violet and blue. And 3722this happens by taking the Line C _prt_ B any where between the Ends of 3723the Prism HG and EI. 3724 3725 3726_PROP._ IX. PROB. IV. 3727 3728_By the discovered Properties of Light to explain the Colours of the 3729Rain-bow._ 3730 3731[Illustration: FIG. 14.] 3732 3733This Bow never appears, but where it rains in the Sun-shine, and may be 3734made artificially by spouting up Water which may break aloft, and 3735scatter into Drops, and fall down like Rain. For the Sun shining upon 3736these Drops certainly causes the Bow to appear to a Spectator standing 3737in a due Position to the Rain and Sun. And hence it is now agreed upon, 3738that this Bow is made by Refraction of the Sun's Light in drops of 3739falling Rain. This was understood by some of the Antients, and of late 3740more fully discover'd and explain'd by the famous _Antonius de Dominis_ 3741Archbishop of _Spalato_, in his book _De Radiis Visûs & Lucis_, 3742published by his Friend _Bartolus_ at _Venice_, in the Year 1611, and 3743written above 20 Years before. For he teaches there how the interior Bow 3744is made in round Drops of Rain by two Refractions of the Sun's Light, 3745and one Reflexion between them, and the exterior by two Refractions, and 3746two sorts of Reflexions between them in each Drop of Water, and proves 3747his Explications by Experiments made with a Phial full of Water, and 3748with Globes of Glass filled with Water, and placed in the Sun to make 3749the Colours of the two Bows appear in them. The same Explication 3750_Des-Cartes_ hath pursued in his Meteors, and mended that of the 3751exterior Bow. But whilst they understood not the true Origin of Colours, 3752it's necessary to pursue it here a little farther. For understanding 3753therefore how the Bow is made, let a Drop of Rain, or any other 3754spherical transparent Body be represented by the Sphere BNFG, [in _Fig._ 375514.] described with the Center C, and Semi-diameter CN. And let AN be 3756one of the Sun's Rays incident upon it at N, and thence refracted to F, 3757where let it either go out of the Sphere by Refraction towards V, or be 3758reflected to G; and at G let it either go out by Refraction to R, or be 3759reflected to H; and at H let it go out by Refraction towards S, cutting 3760the incident Ray in Y. Produce AN and RG, till they meet in X, and upon 3761AX and NF, let fall the Perpendiculars CD and CE, and produce CD till it 3762fall upon the Circumference at L. Parallel to the incident Ray AN draw 3763the Diameter BQ, and let the Sine of Incidence out of Air into Water be 3764to the Sine of Refraction as I to R. Now, if you suppose the Point of 3765Incidence N to move from the Point B, continually till it come to L, the 3766Arch QF will first increase and then decrease, and so will the Angle AXR 3767which the Rays AN and GR contain; and the Arch QF and Angle AXR will be 3768biggest when ND is to CN as sqrt(II - RR) to sqrt(3)RR, in which 3769case NE will be to ND as 2R to I. Also the Angle AYS, which the Rays AN 3770and HS contain will first decrease, and then increase and grow least 3771when ND is to CN as sqrt(II - RR) to sqrt(8)RR, in which case NE 3772will be to ND, as 3R to I. And so the Angle which the next emergent Ray 3773(that is, the emergent Ray after three Reflexions) contains with the 3774incident Ray AN will come to its Limit when ND is to CN as sqrt(II - 3775RR) to sqrt(15)RR, in which case NE will be to ND as 4R to I. And the 3776Angle which the Ray next after that Emergent, that is, the Ray emergent 3777after four Reflexions, contains with the Incident, will come to its 3778Limit, when ND is to CN as sqrt(II - RR) to sqrt(24)RR, in which 3779case NE will be to ND as 5R to I; and so on infinitely, the Numbers 3, 37808, 15, 24, &c. being gather'd by continual Addition of the Terms of the 3781arithmetical Progression 3, 5, 7, 9, &c. The Truth of all this 3782Mathematicians will easily examine.[M] 3783 3784Now it is to be observed, that as when the Sun comes to his Tropicks, 3785Days increase and decrease but a very little for a great while together; 3786so when by increasing the distance CD, these Angles come to their 3787Limits, they vary their quantity but very little for some time together, 3788and therefore a far greater number of the Rays which fall upon all the 3789Points N in the Quadrant BL, shall emerge in the Limits of these Angles, 3790than in any other Inclinations. And farther it is to be observed, that 3791the Rays which differ in Refrangibility will have different Limits of 3792their Angles of Emergence, and by consequence according to their 3793different Degrees of Refrangibility emerge most copiously in different 3794Angles, and being separated from one another appear each in their proper 3795Colours. And what those Angles are may be easily gather'd from the 3796foregoing Theorem by Computation. 3797 3798For in the least refrangible Rays the Sines I and R (as was found above) 3799are 108 and 81, and thence by Computation the greatest Angle AXR will be 3800found 42 Degrees and 2 Minutes, and the least Angle AYS, 50 Degrees and 380157 Minutes. And in the most refrangible Rays the Sines I and R are 109 3802and 81, and thence by Computation the greatest Angle AXR will be found 380340 Degrees and 17 Minutes, and the least Angle AYS 54 Degrees and 7 3804Minutes. 3805 3806Suppose now that O [in _Fig._ 15.] is the Spectator's Eye, and OP a Line 3807drawn parallel to the Sun's Rays and let POE, POF, POG, POH, be Angles 3808of 40 Degr. 17 Min. 42 Degr. 2 Min. 50 Degr. 57 Min. and 54 Degr. 7 Min. 3809respectively, and these Angles turned about their common Side OP, shall 3810with their other Sides OE, OF; OG, OH, describe the Verges of two 3811Rain-bows AF, BE and CHDG. For if E, F, G, H, be drops placed any where 3812in the conical Superficies described by OE, OF, OG, OH, and be 3813illuminated by the Sun's Rays SE, SF, SG, SH; the Angle SEO being equal 3814to the Angle POE, or 40 Degr. 17 Min. shall be the greatest Angle in 3815which the most refrangible Rays can after one Reflexion be refracted to 3816the Eye, and therefore all the Drops in the Line OE shall send the most 3817refrangible Rays most copiously to the Eye, and thereby strike the 3818Senses with the deepest violet Colour in that Region. And in like 3819manner the Angle SFO being equal to the Angle POF, or 42 Degr. 2 Min. 3820shall be the greatest in which the least refrangible Rays after one 3821Reflexion can emerge out of the Drops, and therefore those Rays shall 3822come most copiously to the Eye from the Drops in the Line OF, and strike 3823the Senses with the deepest red Colour in that Region. And by the same 3824Argument, the Rays which have intermediate Degrees of Refrangibility 3825shall come most copiously from Drops between E and F, and strike the 3826Senses with the intermediate Colours, in the Order which their Degrees 3827of Refrangibility require, that is in the Progress from E to F, or from 3828the inside of the Bow to the outside in this order, violet, indigo, 3829blue, green, yellow, orange, red. But the violet, by the mixture of the 3830white Light of the Clouds, will appear faint and incline to purple. 3831 3832[Illustration: FIG. 15.] 3833 3834Again, the Angle SGO being equal to the Angle POG, or 50 Gr. 51 Min. 3835shall be the least Angle in which the least refrangible Rays can after 3836two Reflexions emerge out of the Drops, and therefore the least 3837refrangible Rays shall come most copiously to the Eye from the Drops in 3838the Line OG, and strike the Sense with the deepest red in that Region. 3839And the Angle SHO being equal to the Angle POH, or 54 Gr. 7 Min. shall 3840be the least Angle, in which the most refrangible Rays after two 3841Reflexions can emerge out of the Drops; and therefore those Rays shall 3842come most copiously to the Eye from the Drops in the Line OH, and strike 3843the Senses with the deepest violet in that Region. And by the same 3844Argument, the Drops in the Regions between G and H shall strike the 3845Sense with the intermediate Colours in the Order which their Degrees of 3846Refrangibility require, that is, in the Progress from G to H, or from 3847the inside of the Bow to the outside in this order, red, orange, yellow, 3848green, blue, indigo, violet. And since these four Lines OE, OF, OG, OH, 3849may be situated any where in the above-mention'd conical Superficies; 3850what is said of the Drops and Colours in these Lines is to be understood 3851of the Drops and Colours every where in those Superficies. 3852 3853Thus shall there be made two Bows of Colours, an interior and stronger, 3854by one Reflexion in the Drops, and an exterior and fainter by two; for 3855the Light becomes fainter by every Reflexion. And their Colours shall 3856lie in a contrary Order to one another, the red of both Bows bordering 3857upon the Space GF, which is between the Bows. The Breadth of the 3858interior Bow EOF measured cross the Colours shall be 1 Degr. 45 Min. and 3859the Breadth of the exterior GOH shall be 3 Degr. 10 Min. and the 3860distance between them GOF shall be 8 Gr. 15 Min. the greatest 3861Semi-diameter of the innermost, that is, the Angle POF being 42 Gr. 2 3862Min. and the least Semi-diameter of the outermost POG, being 50 Gr. 57 3863Min. These are the Measures of the Bows, as they would be were the Sun 3864but a Point; for by the Breadth of his Body, the Breadth of the Bows 3865will be increased, and their Distance decreased by half a Degree, and so 3866the breadth of the interior Iris will be 2 Degr. 15 Min. that of the 3867exterior 3 Degr. 40 Min. their distance 8 Degr. 25 Min. the greatest 3868Semi-diameter of the interior Bow 42 Degr. 17 Min. and the least of the 3869exterior 50 Degr. 42 Min. And such are the Dimensions of the Bows in the 3870Heavens found to be very nearly, when their Colours appear strong and 3871perfect. For once, by such means as I then had, I measured the greatest 3872Semi-diameter of the interior Iris about 42 Degrees, and the breadth of 3873the red, yellow and green in that Iris 63 or 64 Minutes, besides the 3874outmost faint red obscured by the brightness of the Clouds, for which we 3875may allow 3 or 4 Minutes more. The breadth of the blue was about 40 3876Minutes more besides the violet, which was so much obscured by the 3877brightness of the Clouds, that I could not measure its breadth. But 3878supposing the breadth of the blue and violet together to equal that of 3879the red, yellow and green together, the whole breadth of this Iris will 3880be about 2-1/4 Degrees, as above. The least distance between this Iris 3881and the exterior Iris was about 8 Degrees and 30 Minutes. The exterior 3882Iris was broader than the interior, but so faint, especially on the blue 3883side, that I could not measure its breadth distinctly. At another time 3884when both Bows appeared more distinct, I measured the breadth of the 3885interior Iris 2 Gr. 10´, and the breadth of the red, yellow and green in 3886the exterior Iris, was to the breadth of the same Colours in the 3887interior as 3 to 2. 3888 3889This Explication of the Rain-bow is yet farther confirmed by the known 3890Experiment (made by _Antonius de Dominis_ and _Des-Cartes_) of hanging 3891up any where in the Sun-shine a Glass Globe filled with Water, and 3892viewing it in such a posture, that the Rays which come from the Globe to 3893the Eye may contain with the Sun's Rays an Angle of either 42 or 50 3894Degrees. For if the Angle be about 42 or 43 Degrees, the Spectator 3895(suppose at O) shall see a full red Colour in that side of the Globe 3896opposed to the Sun as 'tis represented at F, and if that Angle become 3897less (suppose by depressing the Globe to E) there will appear other 3898Colours, yellow, green and blue successive in the same side of the 3899Globe. But if the Angle be made about 50 Degrees (suppose by lifting up 3900the Globe to G) there will appear a red Colour in that side of the Globe 3901towards the Sun, and if the Angle be made greater (suppose by lifting 3902up the Globe to H) the red will turn successively to the other Colours, 3903yellow, green and blue. The same thing I have tried, by letting a Globe 3904rest, and raising or depressing the Eye, or otherwise moving it to make 3905the Angle of a just magnitude. 3906 3907I have heard it represented, that if the Light of a Candle be refracted 3908by a Prism to the Eye; when the blue Colour falls upon the Eye, the 3909Spectator shall see red in the Prism, and when the red falls upon the 3910Eye he shall see blue; and if this were certain, the Colours of the 3911Globe and Rain-bow ought to appear in a contrary order to what we find. 3912But the Colours of the Candle being very faint, the mistake seems to 3913arise from the difficulty of discerning what Colours fall on the Eye. 3914For, on the contrary, I have sometimes had occasion to observe in the 3915Sun's Light refracted by a Prism, that the Spectator always sees that 3916Colour in the Prism which falls upon his Eye. And the same I have found 3917true also in Candle-light. For when the Prism is moved slowly from the 3918Line which is drawn directly from the Candle to the Eye, the red appears 3919first in the Prism and then the blue, and therefore each of them is seen 3920when it falls upon the Eye. For the red passes over the Eye first, and 3921then the blue. 3922 3923The Light which comes through drops of Rain by two Refractions without 3924any Reflexion, ought to appear strongest at the distance of about 26 3925Degrees from the Sun, and to decay gradually both ways as the distance 3926from him increases and decreases. And the same is to be understood of 3927Light transmitted through spherical Hail-stones. And if the Hail be a 3928little flatted, as it often is, the Light transmitted may grow so strong 3929at a little less distance than that of 26 Degrees, as to form a Halo 3930about the Sun or Moon; which Halo, as often as the Hail-stones are duly 3931figured may be colour'd, and then it must be red within by the least 3932refrangible Rays, and blue without by the most refrangible ones, 3933especially if the Hail-stones have opake Globules of Snow in their 3934center to intercept the Light within the Halo (as _Hugenius_ has 3935observ'd) and make the inside thereof more distinctly defined than it 3936would otherwise be. For such Hail-stones, though spherical, by 3937terminating the Light by the Snow, may make a Halo red within and 3938colourless without, and darker in the red than without, as Halos used to 3939be. For of those Rays which pass close by the Snow the Rubriform will be 3940least refracted, and so come to the Eye in the directest Lines. 3941 3942The Light which passes through a drop of Rain after two Refractions, and 3943three or more Reflexions, is scarce strong enough to cause a sensible 3944Bow; but in those Cylinders of Ice by which _Hugenius_ explains the 3945_Parhelia_, it may perhaps be sensible. 3946 3947 3948_PROP._ X. PROB. V. 3949 3950_By the discovered Properties of Light to explain the permanent Colours 3951of Natural Bodies._ 3952 3953These Colours arise from hence, that some natural Bodies reflect some 3954sorts of Rays, others other sorts more copiously than the rest. Minium 3955reflects the least refrangible or red-making Rays most copiously, and 3956thence appears red. Violets reflect the most refrangible most copiously, 3957and thence have their Colour, and so of other Bodies. Every Body 3958reflects the Rays of its own Colour more copiously than the rest, and 3959from their excess and predominance in the reflected Light has its 3960Colour. 3961 3962_Exper._ 17. For if in the homogeneal Lights obtained by the solution of 3963the Problem proposed in the fourth Proposition of the first Part of this 3964Book, you place Bodies of several Colours, you will find, as I have 3965done, that every Body looks most splendid and luminous in the Light of 3966its own Colour. Cinnaber in the homogeneal red Light is most 3967resplendent, in the green Light it is manifestly less resplendent, and 3968in the blue Light still less. Indigo in the violet blue Light is most 3969resplendent, and its splendor is gradually diminish'd, as it is removed 3970thence by degrees through the green and yellow Light to the red. By a 3971Leek the green Light, and next that the blue and yellow which compound 3972green, are more strongly reflected than the other Colours red and 3973violet, and so of the rest. But to make these Experiments the more 3974manifest, such Bodies ought to be chosen as have the fullest and most 3975vivid Colours, and two of those Bodies are to be compared together. 3976Thus, for instance, if Cinnaber and _ultra_-marine blue, or some other 3977full blue be held together in the red homogeneal Light, they will both 3978appear red, but the Cinnaber will appear of a strongly luminous and 3979resplendent red, and the _ultra_-marine blue of a faint obscure and dark 3980red; and if they be held together in the blue homogeneal Light, they 3981will both appear blue, but the _ultra_-marine will appear of a strongly 3982luminous and resplendent blue, and the Cinnaber of a faint and dark 3983blue. Which puts it out of dispute that the Cinnaber reflects the red 3984Light much more copiously than the _ultra_-marine doth, and the 3985_ultra_-marine reflects the blue Light much more copiously than the 3986Cinnaber doth. The same Experiment may be tried successfully with red 3987Lead and Indigo, or with any other two colour'd Bodies, if due allowance 3988be made for the different strength or weakness of their Colour and 3989Light. 3990 3991And as the reason of the Colours of natural Bodies is evident by these 3992Experiments, so it is farther confirmed and put past dispute by the two 3993first Experiments of the first Part, whereby 'twas proved in such Bodies 3994that the reflected Lights which differ in Colours do differ also in 3995degrees of Refrangibility. For thence it's certain, that some Bodies 3996reflect the more refrangible, others the less refrangible Rays more 3997copiously. 3998 3999And that this is not only a true reason of these Colours, but even the 4000only reason, may appear farther from this Consideration, that the Colour 4001of homogeneal Light cannot be changed by the Reflexion of natural 4002Bodies. 4003 4004For if Bodies by Reflexion cannot in the least change the Colour of any 4005one sort of Rays, they cannot appear colour'd by any other means than by 4006reflecting those which either are of their own Colour, or which by 4007mixture must produce it. 4008 4009But in trying Experiments of this kind care must be had that the Light 4010be sufficiently homogeneal. For if Bodies be illuminated by the ordinary 4011prismatick Colours, they will appear neither of their own Day-light 4012Colours, nor of the Colour of the Light cast on them, but of some middle 4013Colour between both, as I have found by Experience. Thus red Lead (for 4014instance) illuminated with the ordinary prismatick green will not appear 4015either red or green, but orange or yellow, or between yellow and green, 4016accordingly as the green Light by which 'tis illuminated is more or less 4017compounded. For because red Lead appears red when illuminated with white 4018Light, wherein all sorts of Rays are equally mix'd, and in the green 4019Light all sorts of Rays are not equally mix'd, the Excess of the 4020yellow-making, green-making and blue-making Rays in the incident green 4021Light, will cause those Rays to abound so much in the reflected Light, 4022as to draw the Colour from red towards their Colour. And because the red 4023Lead reflects the red-making Rays most copiously in proportion to their 4024number, and next after them the orange-making and yellow-making Rays; 4025these Rays in the reflected Light will be more in proportion to the 4026Light than they were in the incident green Light, and thereby will draw 4027the reflected Light from green towards their Colour. And therefore the 4028red Lead will appear neither red nor green, but of a Colour between 4029both. 4030 4031In transparently colour'd Liquors 'tis observable, that their Colour 4032uses to vary with their thickness. Thus, for instance, a red Liquor in a 4033conical Glass held between the Light and the Eye, looks of a pale and 4034dilute yellow at the bottom where 'tis thin, and a little higher where 4035'tis thicker grows orange, and where 'tis still thicker becomes red, and 4036where 'tis thickest the red is deepest and darkest. For it is to be 4037conceiv'd that such a Liquor stops the indigo-making and violet-making 4038Rays most easily, the blue-making Rays more difficultly, the 4039green-making Rays still more difficultly, and the red-making most 4040difficultly: And that if the thickness of the Liquor be only so much as 4041suffices to stop a competent number of the violet-making and 4042indigo-making Rays, without diminishing much the number of the rest, the 4043rest must (by _Prop._ 6. _Part_ 2.) compound a pale yellow. But if the 4044Liquor be so much thicker as to stop also a great number of the 4045blue-making Rays, and some of the green-making, the rest must compound 4046an orange; and where it is so thick as to stop also a great number of 4047the green-making and a considerable number of the yellow-making, the 4048rest must begin to compound a red, and this red must grow deeper and 4049darker as the yellow-making and orange-making Rays are more and more 4050stopp'd by increasing the thickness of the Liquor, so that few Rays 4051besides the red-making can get through. 4052 4053Of this kind is an Experiment lately related to me by Mr. _Halley_, who, 4054in diving deep into the Sea in a diving Vessel, found in a clear 4055Sun-shine Day, that when he was sunk many Fathoms deep into the Water 4056the upper part of his Hand on which the Sun shone directly through the 4057Water and through a small Glass Window in the Vessel appeared of a red 4058Colour, like that of a Damask Rose, and the Water below and the under 4059part of his Hand illuminated by Light reflected from the Water below 4060look'd green. For thence it may be gather'd, that the Sea-Water reflects 4061back the violet and blue-making Rays most easily, and lets the 4062red-making Rays pass most freely and copiously to great Depths. For 4063thereby the Sun's direct Light at all great Depths, by reason of the 4064predominating red-making Rays, must appear red; and the greater the 4065Depth is, the fuller and intenser must that red be. And at such Depths 4066as the violet-making Rays scarce penetrate unto, the blue-making, 4067green-making, and yellow-making Rays being reflected from below more 4068copiously than the red-making ones, must compound a green. 4069 4070Now, if there be two Liquors of full Colours, suppose a red and blue, 4071and both of them so thick as suffices to make their Colours sufficiently 4072full; though either Liquor be sufficiently transparent apart, yet will 4073you not be able to see through both together. For, if only the 4074red-making Rays pass through one Liquor, and only the blue-making 4075through the other, no Rays can pass through both. This Mr. _Hook_ tried 4076casually with Glass Wedges filled with red and blue Liquors, and was 4077surprized at the unexpected Event, the reason of it being then unknown; 4078which makes me trust the more to his Experiment, though I have not tried 4079it my self. But he that would repeat it, must take care the Liquors be 4080of very good and full Colours. 4081 4082Now, whilst Bodies become coloured by reflecting or transmitting this or 4083that sort of Rays more copiously than the rest, it is to be conceived 4084that they stop and stifle in themselves the Rays which they do not 4085reflect or transmit. For, if Gold be foliated and held between your Eye 4086and the Light, the Light looks of a greenish blue, and therefore massy 4087Gold lets into its Body the blue-making Rays to be reflected to and fro 4088within it till they be stopp'd and stifled, whilst it reflects the 4089yellow-making outwards, and thereby looks yellow. And much after the 4090same manner that Leaf Gold is yellow by reflected, and blue by 4091transmitted Light, and massy Gold is yellow in all Positions of the Eye; 4092there are some Liquors, as the Tincture of _Lignum Nephriticum_, and 4093some sorts of Glass which transmit one sort of Light most copiously, and 4094reflect another sort, and thereby look of several Colours, according to 4095the Position of the Eye to the Light. But, if these Liquors or Glasses 4096were so thick and massy that no Light could get through them, I question 4097not but they would like all other opake Bodies appear of one and the 4098same Colour in all Positions of the Eye, though this I cannot yet affirm 4099by Experience. For all colour'd Bodies, so far as my Observation 4100reaches, may be seen through if made sufficiently thin, and therefore 4101are in some measure transparent, and differ only in degrees of 4102Transparency from tinged transparent Liquors; these Liquors, as well as 4103those Bodies, by a sufficient Thickness becoming opake. A transparent 4104Body which looks of any Colour by transmitted Light, may also look of 4105the same Colour by reflected Light, the Light of that Colour being 4106reflected by the farther Surface of the Body, or by the Air beyond it. 4107And then the reflected Colour will be diminished, and perhaps cease, by 4108making the Body very thick, and pitching it on the backside to diminish 4109the Reflexion of its farther Surface, so that the Light reflected from 4110the tinging Particles may predominate. In such Cases, the Colour of the 4111reflected Light will be apt to vary from that of the Light transmitted. 4112But whence it is that tinged Bodies and Liquors reflect some sort of 4113Rays, and intromit or transmit other sorts, shall be said in the next 4114Book. In this Proposition I content my self to have put it past dispute, 4115that Bodies have such Properties, and thence appear colour'd. 4116 4117 4118_PROP._ XI. PROB. VI. 4119 4120_By mixing colour'd Lights to compound a beam of Light of the same 4121Colour and Nature with a beam of the Sun's direct Light, and therein to 4122experience the Truth of the foregoing Propositions._ 4123 4124[Illustration: FIG. 16.] 4125 4126Let ABC _abc_ [in _Fig._ 16.] represent a Prism, by which the Sun's 4127Light let into a dark Chamber through the Hole F, may be refracted 4128towards the Lens MN, and paint upon it at _p_, _q_, _r_, _s_, and _t_, 4129the usual Colours violet, blue, green, yellow, and red, and let the 4130diverging Rays by the Refraction of this Lens converge again towards X, 4131and there, by the mixture of all those their Colours, compound a white 4132according to what was shewn above. Then let another Prism DEG _deg_, 4133parallel to the former, be placed at X, to refract that white Light 4134upwards towards Y. Let the refracting Angles of the Prisms, and their 4135distances from the Lens be equal, so that the Rays which converged from 4136the Lens towards X, and without Refraction, would there have crossed and 4137diverged again, may by the Refraction of the second Prism be reduced 4138into Parallelism and diverge no more. For then those Rays will recompose 4139a beam of white Light XY. If the refracting Angle of either Prism be the 4140bigger, that Prism must be so much the nearer to the Lens. You will know 4141when the Prisms and the Lens are well set together, by observing if the 4142beam of Light XY, which comes out of the second Prism be perfectly white 4143to the very edges of the Light, and at all distances from the Prism 4144continue perfectly and totally white like a beam of the Sun's Light. For 4145till this happens, the Position of the Prisms and Lens to one another 4146must be corrected; and then if by the help of a long beam of Wood, as is 4147represented in the Figure, or by a Tube, or some other such Instrument, 4148made for that Purpose, they be made fast in that Situation, you may try 4149all the same Experiments in this compounded beam of Light XY, which have 4150been made in the Sun's direct Light. For this compounded beam of Light 4151has the same appearance, and is endow'd with all the same Properties 4152with a direct beam of the Sun's Light, so far as my Observation reaches. 4153And in trying Experiments in this beam you may by stopping any of the 4154Colours, _p_, _q_, _r_, _s_, and _t_, at the Lens, see how the Colours 4155produced in the Experiments are no other than those which the Rays had 4156at the Lens before they entered the Composition of this Beam: And by 4157consequence, that they arise not from any new Modifications of the Light 4158by Refractions and Reflexions, but from the various Separations and 4159Mixtures of the Rays originally endow'd with their colour-making 4160Qualities. 4161 4162So, for instance, having with a Lens 4-1/4 Inches broad, and two Prisms 4163on either hand 6-1/4 Feet distant from the Lens, made such a beam of 4164compounded Light; to examine the reason of the Colours made by Prisms, I 4165refracted this compounded beam of Light XY with another Prism HIK _kh_, 4166and thereby cast the usual Prismatick Colours PQRST upon the Paper LV 4167placed behind. And then by stopping any of the Colours _p_, _q_, _r_, 4168_s_, _t_, at the Lens, I found that the same Colour would vanish at the 4169Paper. So if the Purple _p_ was stopp'd at the Lens, the Purple P upon 4170the Paper would vanish, and the rest of the Colours would remain 4171unalter'd, unless perhaps the blue, so far as some purple latent in it 4172at the Lens might be separated from it by the following Refractions. And 4173so by intercepting the green upon the Lens, the green R upon the Paper 4174would vanish, and so of the rest; which plainly shews, that as the white 4175beam of Light XY was compounded of several Lights variously colour'd at 4176the Lens, so the Colours which afterwards emerge out of it by new 4177Refractions are no other than those of which its Whiteness was 4178compounded. The Refraction of the Prism HIK _kh_ generates the Colours 4179PQRST upon the Paper, not by changing the colorific Qualities of the 4180Rays, but by separating the Rays which had the very same colorific 4181Qualities before they enter'd the Composition of the refracted beam of 4182white Light XY. For otherwise the Rays which were of one Colour at the 4183Lens might be of another upon the Paper, contrary to what we find. 4184 4185So again, to examine the reason of the Colours of natural Bodies, I 4186placed such Bodies in the Beam of Light XY, and found that they all 4187appeared there of those their own Colours which they have in Day-light, 4188and that those Colours depend upon the Rays which had the same Colours 4189at the Lens before they enter'd the Composition of that beam. Thus, for 4190instance, Cinnaber illuminated by this beam appears of the same red 4191Colour as in Day-light; and if at the Lens you intercept the 4192green-making and blue-making Rays, its redness will become more full and 4193lively: But if you there intercept the red-making Rays, it will not any 4194longer appear red, but become yellow or green, or of some other Colour, 4195according to the sorts of Rays which you do not intercept. So Gold in 4196this Light XY appears of the same yellow Colour as in Day-light, but by 4197intercepting at the Lens a due Quantity of the yellow-making Rays it 4198will appear white like Silver (as I have tried) which shews that its 4199yellowness arises from the Excess of the intercepted Rays tinging that 4200Whiteness with their Colour when they are let pass. So the Infusion of 4201_Lignum Nephriticum_ (as I have also tried) when held in this beam of 4202Light XY, looks blue by the reflected Part of the Light, and red by the 4203transmitted Part of it, as when 'tis view'd in Day-light; but if you 4204intercept the blue at the Lens the Infusion will lose its reflected blue 4205Colour, whilst its transmitted red remains perfect, and by the loss of 4206some blue-making Rays, wherewith it was allay'd, becomes more intense 4207and full. And, on the contrary, if the red and orange-making Rays be 4208intercepted at the Lens, the Infusion will lose its transmitted red, 4209whilst its blue will remain and become more full and perfect. Which 4210shews, that the Infusion does not tinge the Rays with blue and red, but 4211only transmits those most copiously which were red-making before, and 4212reflects those most copiously which were blue-making before. And after 4213the same manner may the Reasons of other Phænomena be examined, by 4214trying them in this artificial beam of Light XY. 4215 4216FOOTNOTES: 4217 4218[I] See p. 59. 4219 4220[J] _See our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ II. _Sect._ II. _p._ 239. 4221 4222[K] _As is done in our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ I. _Sect._ III. 4223_and_ IV. _and Part_ II. _Sect._ II. 4224 4225[L] _See our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ II. _Sect._ II. _pag._ 269, 4226&c. 4227 4228[M] _This is demonstrated in our_ Author's Lect. Optic. _Part_ I. 4229_Sect._ IV. _Prop._ 35 _and_ 36. 4230 4231 4232 4233 4234THE 4235 4236SECOND BOOK 4237 4238OF 4239 4240OPTICKS 4241 4242 4243 4244 4245_PART I._ 4246 4247_Observations concerning the Reflexions, Refractions, and Colours of 4248thin transparent Bodies._ 4249 4250 4251It has been observed by others, that transparent Substances, as Glass, 4252Water, Air, &c. when made very thin by being blown into Bubbles, or 4253otherwise formed into Plates, do exhibit various Colours according to 4254their various thinness, altho' at a greater thickness they appear very 4255clear and colourless. In the former Book I forbore to treat of these 4256Colours, because they seemed of a more difficult Consideration, and were 4257not necessary for establishing the Properties of Light there discoursed 4258of. But because they may conduce to farther Discoveries for compleating 4259the Theory of Light, especially as to the constitution of the parts of 4260natural Bodies, on which their Colours or Transparency depend; I have 4261here set down an account of them. To render this Discourse short and 4262distinct, I have first described the principal of my Observations, and 4263then consider'd and made use of them. The Observations are these. 4264 4265_Obs._ 1. Compressing two Prisms hard together that their sides (which 4266by chance were a very little convex) might somewhere touch one another: 4267I found the place in which they touched to become absolutely 4268transparent, as if they had there been one continued piece of Glass. For 4269when the Light fell so obliquely on the Air, which in other places was 4270between them, as to be all reflected; it seemed in that place of contact 4271to be wholly transmitted, insomuch that when look'd upon, it appeared 4272like a black or dark spot, by reason that little or no sensible Light 4273was reflected from thence, as from other places; and when looked through 4274it seemed (as it were) a hole in that Air which was formed into a thin 4275Plate, by being compress'd between the Glasses. And through this hole 4276Objects that were beyond might be seen distinctly, which could not at 4277all be seen through other parts of the Glasses where the Air was 4278interjacent. Although the Glasses were a little convex, yet this 4279transparent spot was of a considerable breadth, which breadth seemed 4280principally to proceed from the yielding inwards of the parts of the 4281Glasses, by reason of their mutual pressure. For by pressing them very 4282hard together it would become much broader than otherwise. 4283 4284_Obs._ 2. When the Plate of Air, by turning the Prisms about their 4285common Axis, became so little inclined to the incident Rays, that some 4286of them began to be transmitted, there arose in it many slender Arcs of 4287Colours which at first were shaped almost like the Conchoid, as you see 4288them delineated in the first Figure. And by continuing the Motion of the 4289Prisms, these Arcs increased and bended more and more about the said 4290transparent spot, till they were compleated into Circles or Rings 4291incompassing it, and afterwards continually grew more and more 4292contracted. 4293 4294[Illustration: FIG. 1.] 4295 4296These Arcs at their first appearance were of a violet and blue Colour, 4297and between them were white Arcs of Circles, which presently by 4298continuing the Motion of the Prisms became a little tinged in their 4299inward Limbs with red and yellow, and to their outward Limbs the blue 4300was adjacent. So that the order of these Colours from the central dark 4301spot, was at that time white, blue, violet; black, red, orange, yellow, 4302white, blue, violet, &c. But the yellow and red were much fainter than 4303the blue and violet. 4304 4305The Motion of the Prisms about their Axis being continued, these Colours 4306contracted more and more, shrinking towards the whiteness on either 4307side of it, until they totally vanished into it. And then the Circles in 4308those parts appear'd black and white, without any other Colours 4309intermix'd. But by farther moving the Prisms about, the Colours again 4310emerged out of the whiteness, the violet and blue at its inward Limb, 4311and at its outward Limb the red and yellow. So that now their order from 4312the central Spot was white, yellow, red; black; violet, blue, white, 4313yellow, red, &c. contrary to what it was before. 4314 4315_Obs._ 3. When the Rings or some parts of them appeared only black and 4316white, they were very distinct and well defined, and the blackness 4317seemed as intense as that of the central Spot. Also in the Borders of 4318the Rings, where the Colours began to emerge out of the whiteness, they 4319were pretty distinct, which made them visible to a very great multitude. 4320I have sometimes number'd above thirty Successions (reckoning every 4321black and white Ring for one Succession) and seen more of them, which by 4322reason of their smalness I could not number. But in other Positions of 4323the Prisms, at which the Rings appeared of many Colours, I could not 4324distinguish above eight or nine of them, and the Exterior of those were 4325very confused and dilute. 4326 4327In these two Observations to see the Rings distinct, and without any 4328other Colour than Black and white, I found it necessary to hold my Eye 4329at a good distance from them. For by approaching nearer, although in the 4330same inclination of my Eye to the Plane of the Rings, there emerged a 4331bluish Colour out of the white, which by dilating it self more and more 4332into the black, render'd the Circles less distinct, and left the white a 4333little tinged with red and yellow. I found also by looking through a 4334slit or oblong hole, which was narrower than the pupil of my Eye, and 4335held close to it parallel to the Prisms, I could see the Circles much 4336distincter and visible to a far greater number than otherwise. 4337 4338_Obs._ 4. To observe more nicely the order of the Colours which arose 4339out of the white Circles as the Rays became less and less inclined to 4340the Plate of Air; I took two Object-glasses, the one a Plano-convex for 4341a fourteen Foot Telescope, and the other a large double Convex for one 4342of about fifty Foot; and upon this, laying the other with its plane side 4343downwards, I pressed them slowly together, to make the Colours 4344successively emerge in the middle of the Circles, and then slowly lifted 4345the upper Glass from the lower to make them successively vanish again in 4346the same place. The Colour, which by pressing the Glasses together, 4347emerged last in the middle of the other Colours, would upon its first 4348appearance look like a Circle of a Colour almost uniform from the 4349circumference to the center and by compressing the Glasses still more, 4350grow continually broader until a new Colour emerged in its center, and 4351thereby it became a Ring encompassing that new Colour. And by 4352compressing the Glasses still more, the diameter of this Ring would 4353increase, and the breadth of its Orbit or Perimeter decrease until 4354another new Colour emerged in the center of the last: And so on until a 4355third, a fourth, a fifth, and other following new Colours successively 4356emerged there, and became Rings encompassing the innermost Colour, the 4357last of which was the black Spot. And, on the contrary, by lifting up 4358the upper Glass from the lower, the diameter of the Rings would 4359decrease, and the breadth of their Orbit increase, until their Colours 4360reached successively to the center; and then they being of a 4361considerable breadth, I could more easily discern and distinguish their 4362Species than before. And by this means I observ'd their Succession and 4363Quantity to be as followeth. 4364 4365Next to the pellucid central Spot made by the contact of the Glasses 4366succeeded blue, white, yellow, and red. The blue was so little in 4367quantity, that I could not discern it in the Circles made by the Prisms, 4368nor could I well distinguish any violet in it, but the yellow and red 4369were pretty copious, and seemed about as much in extent as the white, 4370and four or five times more than the blue. The next Circuit in order of 4371Colours immediately encompassing these were violet, blue, green, yellow, 4372and red: and these were all of them copious and vivid, excepting the 4373green, which was very little in quantity, and seemed much more faint and 4374dilute than the other Colours. Of the other four, the violet was the 4375least in extent, and the blue less than the yellow or red. The third 4376Circuit or Order was purple, blue, green, yellow, and red; in which the 4377purple seemed more reddish than the violet in the former Circuit, and 4378the green was much more conspicuous, being as brisk and copious as any 4379of the other Colours, except the yellow, but the red began to be a 4380little faded, inclining very much to purple. After this succeeded the 4381fourth Circuit of green and red. The green was very copious and lively, 4382inclining on the one side to blue, and on the other side to yellow. But 4383in this fourth Circuit there was neither violet, blue, nor yellow, and 4384the red was very imperfect and dirty. Also the succeeding Colours became 4385more and more imperfect and dilute, till after three or four revolutions 4386they ended in perfect whiteness. Their form, when the Glasses were most 4387compress'd so as to make the black Spot appear in the center, is 4388delineated in the second Figure; where _a_, _b_, _c_, _d_, _e_: _f_, 4389_g_, _h_, _i_, _k_: _l_, _m_, _n_, _o_, _p_: _q_, _r_: _s_, _t_: _v_, 4390_x_: _y_, _z_, denote the Colours reckon'd in order from the center, 4391black, blue, white, yellow, red: violet, blue, green, yellow, red: 4392purple, blue, green, yellow, red: green, red: greenish blue, red: 4393greenish blue, pale red: greenish blue, reddish white. 4394 4395[Illustration: FIG. 2.] 4396 4397_Obs._ 5. To determine the interval of the Glasses, or thickness of the 4398interjacent Air, by which each Colour was produced, I measured the 4399Diameters of the first six Rings at the most lucid part of their Orbits, 4400and squaring them, I found their Squares to be in the arithmetical 4401Progression of the odd Numbers, 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, 11. And since one of 4402these Glasses was plane, and the other spherical, their Intervals at 4403those Rings must be in the same Progression. I measured also the 4404Diameters of the dark or faint Rings between the more lucid Colours, and 4405found their Squares to be in the arithmetical Progression of the even 4406Numbers, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12. And it being very nice and difficult to 4407take these measures exactly; I repeated them divers times at divers 4408parts of the Glasses, that by their Agreement I might be confirmed in 4409them. And the same method I used in determining some others of the 4410following Observations. 4411 4412_Obs._ 6. The Diameter of the sixth Ring at the most lucid part of its 4413Orbit was 58/100 parts of an Inch, and the Diameter of the Sphere on 4414which the double convex Object-glass was ground was about 102 Feet, and 4415hence I gathered the thickness of the Air or Aereal Interval of the 4416Glasses at that Ring. But some time after, suspecting that in making 4417this Observation I had not determined the Diameter of the Sphere with 4418sufficient accurateness, and being uncertain whether the Plano-convex 4419Glass was truly plane, and not something concave or convex on that side 4420which I accounted plane; and whether I had not pressed the Glasses 4421together, as I often did, to make them touch; (For by pressing such 4422Glasses together their parts easily yield inwards, and the Rings thereby 4423become sensibly broader than they would be, did the Glasses keep their 4424Figures.) I repeated the Experiment, and found the Diameter of the sixth 4425lucid Ring about 55/100 parts of an Inch. I repeated the Experiment also 4426with such an Object-glass of another Telescope as I had at hand. This 4427was a double Convex ground on both sides to one and the same Sphere, and 4428its Focus was distant from it 83-2/5 Inches. And thence, if the Sines of 4429Incidence and Refraction of the bright yellow Light be assumed in 4430proportion as 11 to 17, the Diameter of the Sphere to which the Glass 4431was figured will by computation be found 182 Inches. This Glass I laid 4432upon a flat one, so that the black Spot appeared in the middle of the 4433Rings of Colours without any other Pressure than that of the weight of 4434the Glass. And now measuring the Diameter of the fifth dark Circle as 4435accurately as I could, I found it the fifth part of an Inch precisely. 4436This Measure was taken with the points of a pair of Compasses on the 4437upper Surface on the upper Glass, and my Eye was about eight or nine 4438Inches distance from the Glass, almost perpendicularly over it, and the 4439Glass was 1/6 of an Inch thick, and thence it is easy to collect that 4440the true Diameter of the Ring between the Glasses was greater than its 4441measur'd Diameter above the Glasses in the Proportion of 80 to 79, or 4442thereabouts, and by consequence equal to 16/79 parts of an Inch, and its 4443true Semi-diameter equal to 8/79 parts. Now as the Diameter of the 4444Sphere (182 Inches) is to the Semi-diameter of this fifth dark Ring 4445(8/79 parts of an Inch) so is this Semi-diameter to the thickness of the 4446Air at this fifth dark Ring; which is therefore 32/567931 or 4447100/1774784. Parts of an Inch; and the fifth Part thereof, _viz._ the 44481/88739 Part of an Inch, is the Thickness of the Air at the first of 4449these dark Rings. 4450 4451The same Experiment I repeated with another double convex Object-glass 4452ground on both sides to one and the same Sphere. Its Focus was distant 4453from it 168-1/2 Inches, and therefore the Diameter of that Sphere was 4454184 Inches. This Glass being laid upon the same plain Glass, the 4455Diameter of the fifth of the dark Rings, when the black Spot in their 4456Center appear'd plainly without pressing the Glasses, was by the measure 4457of the Compasses upon the upper Glass 121/600 Parts of an Inch, and by 4458consequence between the Glasses it was 1222/6000: For the upper Glass 4459was 1/8 of an Inch thick, and my Eye was distant from it 8 Inches. And a 4460third proportional to half this from the Diameter of the Sphere is 44615/88850 Parts of an Inch. This is therefore the Thickness of the Air at 4462this Ring, and a fifth Part thereof, _viz._ the 1/88850th Part of an 4463Inch is the Thickness thereof at the first of the Rings, as above. 4464 4465I tried the same Thing, by laying these Object-glasses upon flat Pieces 4466of a broken Looking-glass, and found the same Measures of the Rings: 4467Which makes me rely upon them till they can be determin'd more 4468accurately by Glasses ground to larger Spheres, though in such Glasses 4469greater care must be taken of a true Plane. 4470 4471These Dimensions were taken, when my Eye was placed almost 4472perpendicularly over the Glasses, being about an Inch, or an Inch and a 4473quarter, distant from the incident Rays, and eight Inches distant from 4474the Glass; so that the Rays were inclined to the Glass in an Angle of 4475about four Degrees. Whence by the following Observation you will 4476understand, that had the Rays been perpendicular to the Glasses, the 4477Thickness of the Air at these Rings would have been less in the 4478Proportion of the Radius to the Secant of four Degrees, that is, of 447910000 to 10024. Let the Thicknesses found be therefore diminish'd in 4480this Proportion, and they will become 1/88952 and 1/89063, or (to use 4481the nearest round Number) the 1/89000th Part of an Inch. This is the 4482Thickness of the Air at the darkest Part of the first dark Ring made by 4483perpendicular Rays; and half this Thickness multiplied by the 4484Progression, 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, &c. gives the Thicknesses of the Air at 4485the most luminous Parts of all the brightest Rings, _viz._ 1/178000, 44863/178000, 5/178000, 7/178000, &c. their arithmetical Means 2/178000, 44874/178000, 6/178000, &c. being its Thicknesses at the darkest Parts of 4488all the dark ones. 4489 4490_Obs._ 7. The Rings were least, when my Eye was placed perpendicularly 4491over the Glasses in the Axis of the Rings: And when I view'd them 4492obliquely they became bigger, continually swelling as I removed my Eye 4493farther from the Axis. And partly by measuring the Diameter of the same 4494Circle at several Obliquities of my Eye, partly by other Means, as also 4495by making use of the two Prisms for very great Obliquities, I found its 4496Diameter, and consequently the Thickness of the Air at its Perimeter in 4497all those Obliquities to be very nearly in the Proportions express'd in 4498this Table. 4499 4500-------------------+--------------------+----------+---------- 4501Angle of Incidence |Angle of Refraction |Diameter |Thickness 4502 on | into | of the | of the 4503 the Air. | the Air. | Ring. | Air. 4504-------------------+--------------------+----------+---------- 4505 Deg. Min. | | | 4506 | | | 4507 00 00 | 00 00 | 10 | 10 4508 | | | 4509 06 26 | 10 00 | 10-1/13 | 10-2/13 4510 | | | 4511 12 45 | 20 00 | 10-1/3 | 10-2/3 4512 | | | 4513 18 49 | 30 00 | 10-3/4 | 11-1/2 4514 | | | 4515 24 30 | 40 00 | 11-2/5 | 13 4516 | | | 4517 29 37 | 50 00 | 12-1/2 | 15-1/2 4518 | | | 4519 33 58 | 60 00 | 14 | 20 4520 | | | 4521 35 47 | 65 00 | 15-1/4 | 23-1/4 4522 | | | 4523 37 19 | 70 00 | 16-4/5 | 28-1/4 4524 | | | 4525 38 33 | 75 00 | 19-1/4 | 37 4526 | | | 4527 39 27 | 80 00 | 22-6/7 | 52-1/4 4528 | | | 4529 40 00 | 85 00 | 29 | 84-1/12 4530 | | | 4531 40 11 | 90 00 | 35 | 122-1/2 4532-------------------+--------------------+----------+---------- 4533 4534In the two first Columns are express'd the Obliquities of the incident 4535and emergent Rays to the Plate of the Air, that is, their Angles of 4536Incidence and Refraction. In the third Column the Diameter of any 4537colour'd Ring at those Obliquities is expressed in Parts, of which ten 4538constitute that Diameter when the Rays are perpendicular. And in the 4539fourth Column the Thickness of the Air at the Circumference of that Ring 4540is expressed in Parts, of which also ten constitute its Thickness when 4541the Rays are perpendicular. 4542 4543And from these Measures I seem to gather this Rule: That the Thickness 4544of the Air is proportional to the Secant of an Angle, whose Sine is a 4545certain mean Proportional between the Sines of Incidence and Refraction. 4546And that mean Proportional, so far as by these Measures I can determine 4547it, is the first of an hundred and six arithmetical mean Proportionals 4548between those Sines counted from the bigger Sine, that is, from the Sine 4549of Refraction when the Refraction is made out of the Glass into the 4550Plate of Air, or from the Sine of Incidence when the Refraction is made 4551out of the Plate of Air into the Glass. 4552 4553_Obs._ 8. The dark Spot in the middle of the Rings increased also by the 4554Obliquation of the Eye, although almost insensibly. But, if instead of 4555the Object-glasses the Prisms were made use of, its Increase was more 4556manifest when viewed so obliquely that no Colours appear'd about it. It 4557was least when the Rays were incident most obliquely on the interjacent 4558Air, and as the obliquity decreased it increased more and more until the 4559colour'd Rings appear'd, and then decreased again, but not so much as it 4560increased before. And hence it is evident, that the Transparency was 4561not only at the absolute Contact of the Glasses, but also where they had 4562some little Interval. I have sometimes observed the Diameter of that 4563Spot to be between half and two fifth parts of the Diameter of the 4564exterior Circumference of the red in the first Circuit or Revolution of 4565Colours when view'd almost perpendicularly; whereas when view'd 4566obliquely it hath wholly vanish'd and become opake and white like the 4567other parts of the Glass; whence it may be collected that the Glasses 4568did then scarcely, or not at all, touch one another, and that their 4569Interval at the perimeter of that Spot when view'd perpendicularly was 4570about a fifth or sixth part of their Interval at the circumference of 4571the said red. 4572 4573_Obs._ 9. By looking through the two contiguous Object-glasses, I found 4574that the interjacent Air exhibited Rings of Colours, as well by 4575transmitting Light as by reflecting it. The central Spot was now white, 4576and from it the order of the Colours were yellowish red; black, violet, 4577blue, white, yellow, red; violet, blue, green, yellow, red, &c. But 4578these Colours were very faint and dilute, unless when the Light was 4579trajected very obliquely through the Glasses: For by that means they 4580became pretty vivid. Only the first yellowish red, like the blue in the 4581fourth Observation, was so little and faint as scarcely to be discern'd. 4582Comparing the colour'd Rings made by Reflexion, with these made by 4583transmission of the Light; I found that white was opposite to black, red 4584to blue, yellow to violet, and green to a Compound of red and violet. 4585That is, those parts of the Glass were black when looked through, which 4586when looked upon appeared white, and on the contrary. And so those which 4587in one case exhibited blue, did in the other case exhibit red. And the 4588like of the other Colours. The manner you have represented in the third 4589Figure, where AB, CD, are the Surfaces of the Glasses contiguous at E, 4590and the black Lines between them are their Distances in arithmetical 4591Progression, and the Colours written above are seen by reflected Light, 4592and those below by Light transmitted (p. 209). 4593 4594_Obs._ 10. Wetting the Object-glasses a little at their edges, the Water 4595crept in slowly between them, and the Circles thereby became less and 4596the Colours more faint: Insomuch that as the Water crept along, one half 4597of them at which it first arrived would appear broken off from the other 4598half, and contracted into a less Room. By measuring them I found the 4599Proportions of their Diameters to the Diameters of the like Circles made 4600by Air to be about seven to eight, and consequently the Intervals of the 4601Glasses at like Circles, caused by those two Mediums Water and Air, are 4602as about three to four. Perhaps it may be a general Rule, That if any 4603other Medium more or less dense than Water be compress'd between the 4604Glasses, their Intervals at the Rings caused thereby will be to their 4605Intervals caused by interjacent Air, as the Sines are which measure the 4606Refraction made out of that Medium into Air. 4607 4608_Obs._ 11. When the Water was between the Glasses, if I pressed the 4609upper Glass variously at its edges to make the Rings move nimbly from 4610one place to another, a little white Spot would immediately follow the 4611center of them, which upon creeping in of the ambient Water into that 4612place would presently vanish. Its appearance was such as interjacent Air 4613would have caused, and it exhibited the same Colours. But it was not 4614air, for where any Bubbles of Air were in the Water they would not 4615vanish. The Reflexion must have rather been caused by a subtiler Medium, 4616which could recede through the Glasses at the creeping in of the Water. 4617 4618_Obs._ 12. These Observations were made in the open Air. But farther to 4619examine the Effects of colour'd Light falling on the Glasses, I darken'd 4620the Room, and view'd them by Reflexion of the Colours of a Prism cast on 4621a Sheet of white Paper, my Eye being so placed that I could see the 4622colour'd Paper by Reflexion in the Glasses, as in a Looking-glass. And 4623by this means the Rings became distincter and visible to a far greater 4624number than in the open Air. I have sometimes seen more than twenty of 4625them, whereas in the open Air I could not discern above eight or nine. 4626 4627[Illustration: FIG. 3.] 4628 4629_Obs._ 13. Appointing an Assistant to move the Prism to and fro about 4630its Axis, that all the Colours might successively fall on that part of 4631the Paper which I saw by Reflexion from that part of the Glasses, where 4632the Circles appear'd, so that all the Colours might be successively 4633reflected from the Circles to my Eye, whilst I held it immovable, I 4634found the Circles which the red Light made to be manifestly bigger than 4635those which were made by the blue and violet. And it was very pleasant 4636to see them gradually swell or contract accordingly as the Colour of the 4637Light was changed. The Interval of the Glasses at any of the Rings when 4638they were made by the utmost red Light, was to their Interval at the 4639same Ring when made by the utmost violet, greater than as 3 to 2, and 4640less than as 13 to 8. By the most of my Observations it was as 14 to 9. 4641And this Proportion seem'd very nearly the same in all Obliquities of my 4642Eye; unless when two Prisms were made use of instead of the 4643Object-glasses. For then at a certain great obliquity of my Eye, the 4644Rings made by the several Colours seem'd equal, and at a greater 4645obliquity those made by the violet would be greater than the same Rings 4646made by the red: the Refraction of the Prism in this case causing the 4647most refrangible Rays to fall more obliquely on that plate of the Air 4648than the least refrangible ones. Thus the Experiment succeeded in the 4649colour'd Light, which was sufficiently strong and copious to make the 4650Rings sensible. And thence it may be gather'd, that if the most 4651refrangible and least refrangible Rays had been copious enough to make 4652the Rings sensible without the mixture of other Rays, the Proportion 4653which here was 14 to 9 would have been a little greater, suppose 14-1/4 4654or 14-1/3 to 9. 4655 4656_Obs._ 14. Whilst the Prism was turn'd about its Axis with an uniform 4657Motion, to make all the several Colours fall successively upon the 4658Object-glasses, and thereby to make the Rings contract and dilate: The 4659Contraction or Dilatation of each Ring thus made by the variation of its 4660Colour was swiftest in the red, and slowest in the violet, and in the 4661intermediate Colours it had intermediate degrees of Celerity. Comparing 4662the quantity of Contraction and Dilatation made by all the degrees of 4663each Colour, I found that it was greatest in the red; less in the 4664yellow, still less in the blue, and least in the violet. And to make as 4665just an Estimation as I could of the Proportions of their Contractions 4666or Dilatations, I observ'd that the whole Contraction or Dilatation of 4667the Diameter of any Ring made by all the degrees of red, was to that of 4668the Diameter of the same Ring made by all the degrees of violet, as 4669about four to three, or five to four, and that when the Light was of the 4670middle Colour between yellow and green, the Diameter of the Ring was 4671very nearly an arithmetical Mean between the greatest Diameter of the 4672same Ring made by the outmost red, and the least Diameter thereof made 4673by the outmost violet: Contrary to what happens in the Colours of the 4674oblong Spectrum made by the Refraction of a Prism, where the red is most 4675contracted, the violet most expanded, and in the midst of all the 4676Colours is the Confine of green and blue. And hence I seem to collect 4677that the thicknesses of the Air between the Glasses there, where the 4678Ring is successively made by the limits of the five principal Colours 4679(red, yellow, green, blue, violet) in order (that is, by the extreme 4680red, by the limit of red and yellow in the middle of the orange, by the 4681limit of yellow and green, by the limit of green and blue, by the limit 4682of blue and violet in the middle of the indigo, and by the extreme 4683violet) are to one another very nearly as the sixth lengths of a Chord 4684which found the Notes in a sixth Major, _sol_, _la_, _mi_, _fa_, _sol_, 4685_la_. But it agrees something better with the Observation to say, that 4686the thicknesses of the Air between the Glasses there, where the Rings 4687are successively made by the limits of the seven Colours, red, orange, 4688yellow, green, blue, indigo, violet in order, are to one another as the 4689Cube Roots of the Squares of the eight lengths of a Chord, which found 4690the Notes in an eighth, _sol_, _la_, _fa_, _sol_, _la_, _mi_, _fa_, 4691_sol_; that is, as the Cube Roots of the Squares of the Numbers, 1, 8/9, 46925/6, 3/4, 2/3, 3/5, 9/16, 1/2. 4693 4694_Obs._ 15. These Rings were not of various Colours like those made in 4695the open Air, but appeared all over of that prismatick Colour only with 4696which they were illuminated. And by projecting the prismatick Colours 4697immediately upon the Glasses, I found that the Light which fell on the 4698dark Spaces which were between the Colour'd Rings was transmitted 4699through the Glasses without any variation of Colour. For on a white 4700Paper placed behind, it would paint Rings of the same Colour with those 4701which were reflected, and of the bigness of their immediate Spaces. And 4702from thence the origin of these Rings is manifest; namely, that the Air 4703between the Glasses, according to its various thickness, is disposed in 4704some places to reflect, and in others to transmit the Light of any one 4705Colour (as you may see represented in the fourth Figure) and in the same 4706place to reflect that of one Colour where it transmits that of another. 4707 4708[Illustration: FIG. 4.] 4709 4710_Obs._ 16. The Squares of the Diameters of these Rings made by any 4711prismatick Colour were in arithmetical Progression, as in the fifth 4712Observation. And the Diameter of the sixth Circle, when made by the 4713citrine yellow, and viewed almost perpendicularly was about 58/100 parts 4714of an Inch, or a little less, agreeable to the sixth Observation. 4715 4716The precedent Observations were made with a rarer thin Medium, 4717terminated by a denser, such as was Air or Water compress'd between two 4718Glasses. In those that follow are set down the Appearances of a denser 4719Medium thin'd within a rarer, such as are Plates of Muscovy Glass, 4720Bubbles of Water, and some other thin Substances terminated on all sides 4721with air. 4722 4723_Obs._ 17. If a Bubble be blown with Water first made tenacious by 4724dissolving a little Soap in it, 'tis a common Observation, that after a 4725while it will appear tinged with a great variety of Colours. To defend 4726these Bubbles from being agitated by the external Air (whereby their 4727Colours are irregularly moved one among another, so that no accurate 4728Observation can be made of them,) as soon as I had blown any of them I 4729cover'd it with a clear Glass, and by that means its Colours emerged in 4730a very regular order, like so many concentrick Rings encompassing the 4731top of the Bubble. And as the Bubble grew thinner by the continual 4732subsiding of the Water, these Rings dilated slowly and overspread the 4733whole Bubble, descending in order to the bottom of it, where they 4734vanish'd successively. In the mean while, after all the Colours were 4735emerged at the top, there grew in the center of the Rings a small round 4736black Spot, like that in the first Observation, which continually 4737dilated it self till it became sometimes more than 1/2 or 3/4 of an Inch 4738in breadth before the Bubble broke. At first I thought there had been no 4739Light reflected from the Water in that place, but observing it more 4740curiously, I saw within it several smaller round Spots, which appeared 4741much blacker and darker than the rest, whereby I knew that there was 4742some Reflexion at the other places which were not so dark as those 4743Spots. And by farther Tryal I found that I could see the Images of some 4744things (as of a Candle or the Sun) very faintly reflected, not only from 4745the great black Spot, but also from the little darker Spots which were 4746within it. 4747 4748Besides the aforesaid colour'd Rings there would often appear small 4749Spots of Colours, ascending and descending up and down the sides of the 4750Bubble, by reason of some Inequalities in the subsiding of the Water. 4751And sometimes small black Spots generated at the sides would ascend up 4752to the larger black Spot at the top of the Bubble, and unite with it. 4753 4754_Obs._ 18. Because the Colours of these Bubbles were more extended and 4755lively than those of the Air thinn'd between two Glasses, and so more 4756easy to be distinguish'd, I shall here give you a farther description of 4757their order, as they were observ'd in viewing them by Reflexion of the 4758Skies when of a white Colour, whilst a black substance was placed 4759behind the Bubble. And they were these, red, blue; red, blue; red, blue; 4760red, green; red, yellow, green, blue, purple; red, yellow, green, blue, 4761violet; red, yellow, white, blue, black. 4762 4763The three first Successions of red and blue were very dilute and dirty, 4764especially the first, where the red seem'd in a manner to be white. 4765Among these there was scarce any other Colour sensible besides red and 4766blue, only the blues (and principally the second blue) inclined a little 4767to green. 4768 4769The fourth red was also dilute and dirty, but not so much as the former 4770three; after that succeeded little or no yellow, but a copious green, 4771which at first inclined a little to yellow, and then became a pretty 4772brisk and good willow green, and afterwards changed to a bluish Colour; 4773but there succeeded neither blue nor violet. 4774 4775The fifth red at first inclined very much to purple, and afterwards 4776became more bright and brisk, but yet not very pure. This was succeeded 4777with a very bright and intense yellow, which was but little in quantity, 4778and soon chang'd to green: But that green was copious and something more 4779pure, deep and lively, than the former green. After that follow'd an 4780excellent blue of a bright Sky-colour, and then a purple, which was less 4781in quantity than the blue, and much inclined to red. 4782 4783The sixth red was at first of a very fair and lively scarlet, and soon 4784after of a brighter Colour, being very pure and brisk, and the best of 4785all the reds. Then after a lively orange follow'd an intense bright and 4786copious yellow, which was also the best of all the yellows, and this 4787changed first to a greenish yellow, and then to a greenish blue; but the 4788green between the yellow and the blue, was very little and dilute, 4789seeming rather a greenish white than a green. The blue which succeeded 4790became very good, and of a very bright Sky-colour, but yet something 4791inferior to the former blue; and the violet was intense and deep with 4792little or no redness in it. And less in quantity than the blue. 4793 4794In the last red appeared a tincture of scarlet next to violet, which 4795soon changed to a brighter Colour, inclining to an orange; and the 4796yellow which follow'd was at first pretty good and lively, but 4797afterwards it grew more dilute until by degrees it ended in perfect 4798whiteness. And this whiteness, if the Water was very tenacious and 4799well-temper'd, would slowly spread and dilate it self over the greater 4800part of the Bubble; continually growing paler at the top, where at 4801length it would crack in many places, and those cracks, as they dilated, 4802would appear of a pretty good, but yet obscure and dark Sky-colour; the 4803white between the blue Spots diminishing, until it resembled the Threds 4804of an irregular Net-work, and soon after vanish'd, and left all the 4805upper part of the Bubble of the said dark blue Colour. And this Colour, 4806after the aforesaid manner, dilated it self downwards, until sometimes 4807it hath overspread the whole Bubble. In the mean while at the top, which 4808was of a darker blue than the bottom, and appear'd also full of many 4809round blue Spots, something darker than the rest, there would emerge 4810one or more very black Spots, and within those, other Spots of an 4811intenser blackness, which I mention'd in the former Observation; and 4812these continually dilated themselves until the Bubble broke. 4813 4814If the Water was not very tenacious, the black Spots would break forth 4815in the white, without any sensible intervention of the blue. And 4816sometimes they would break forth within the precedent yellow, or red, or 4817perhaps within the blue of the second order, before the intermediate 4818Colours had time to display themselves. 4819 4820By this description you may perceive how great an affinity these Colours 4821have with those of Air described in the fourth Observation, although set 4822down in a contrary order, by reason that they begin to appear when the 4823Bubble is thickest, and are most conveniently reckon'd from the lowest 4824and thickest part of the Bubble upwards. 4825 4826_Obs._ 19. Viewing in several oblique Positions of my Eye the Rings of 4827Colours emerging on the top of the Bubble, I found that they were 4828sensibly dilated by increasing the obliquity, but yet not so much by far 4829as those made by thinn'd Air in the seventh Observation. For there they 4830were dilated so much as, when view'd most obliquely, to arrive at a part 4831of the Plate more than twelve times thicker than that where they 4832appear'd when viewed perpendicularly; whereas in this case the thickness 4833of the Water, at which they arrived when viewed most obliquely, was to 4834that thickness which exhibited them by perpendicular Rays, something 4835less than as 8 to 5. By the best of my Observations it was between 15 4836and 15-1/2 to 10; an increase about 24 times less than in the other 4837case. 4838 4839Sometimes the Bubble would become of an uniform thickness all over, 4840except at the top of it near the black Spot, as I knew, because it would 4841exhibit the same appearance of Colours in all Positions of the Eye. And 4842then the Colours which were seen at its apparent circumference by the 4843obliquest Rays, would be different from those that were seen in other 4844places, by Rays less oblique to it. And divers Spectators might see the 4845same part of it of differing Colours, by viewing it at very differing 4846Obliquities. Now observing how much the Colours at the same places of 4847the Bubble, or at divers places of equal thickness, were varied by the 4848several Obliquities of the Rays; by the assistance of the 4th, 14th, 484916th and 18th Observations, as they are hereafter explain'd, I collect 4850the thickness of the Water requisite to exhibit any one and the same 4851Colour, at several Obliquities, to be very nearly in the Proportion 4852expressed in this Table. 4853 4854-----------------+------------------+---------------- 4855 Incidence on | Refraction into | Thickness of 4856 the Water. | the Water. | the Water. 4857-----------------+------------------+---------------- 4858 Deg. Min. | Deg. Min. | 4859 | | 4860 00 00 | 00 00 | 10 4861 | | 4862 15 00 | 11 11 | 10-1/4 4863 | | 4864 30 00 | 22 1 | 10-4/5 4865 | | 4866 45 00 | 32 2 | 11-4/5 4867 | | 4868 60 00 | 40 30 | 13 4869 | | 4870 75 00 | 46 25 | 14-1/2 4871 | | 4872 90 00 | 48 35 | 15-1/5 4873-----------------+------------------+---------------- 4874 4875In the two first Columns are express'd the Obliquities of the Rays to 4876the Superficies of the Water, that is, their Angles of Incidence and 4877Refraction. Where I suppose, that the Sines which measure them are in 4878round Numbers, as 3 to 4, though probably the Dissolution of Soap in the 4879Water, may a little alter its refractive Virtue. In the third Column, 4880the Thickness of the Bubble, at which any one Colour is exhibited in 4881those several Obliquities, is express'd in Parts, of which ten 4882constitute its Thickness when the Rays are perpendicular. And the Rule 4883found by the seventh Observation agrees well with these Measures, if 4884duly apply'd; namely, that the Thickness of a Plate of Water requisite 4885to exhibit one and the same Colour at several Obliquities of the Eye, is 4886proportional to the Secant of an Angle, whose Sine is the first of an 4887hundred and six arithmetical mean Proportionals between the Sines of 4888Incidence and Refraction counted from the lesser Sine, that is, from the 4889Sine of Refraction when the Refraction is made out of Air into Water, 4890otherwise from the Sine of Incidence. 4891 4892I have sometimes observ'd, that the Colours which arise on polish'd 4893Steel by heating it, or on Bell-metal, and some other metalline 4894Substances, when melted and pour'd on the Ground, where they may cool in 4895the open Air, have, like the Colours of Water-bubbles, been a little 4896changed by viewing them at divers Obliquities, and particularly that a 4897deep blue, or violet, when view'd very obliquely, hath been changed to a 4898deep red. But the Changes of these Colours are not so great and 4899sensible as of those made by Water. For the Scoria, or vitrified Part of 4900the Metal, which most Metals when heated or melted do continually 4901protrude, and send out to their Surface, and which by covering the 4902Metals in form of a thin glassy Skin, causes these Colours, is much 4903denser than Water; and I find that the Change made by the Obliquation of 4904the Eye is least in Colours of the densest thin Substances. 4905 4906_Obs._ 20. As in the ninth Observation, so here, the Bubble, by 4907transmitted Light, appear'd of a contrary Colour to that, which it 4908exhibited by Reflexion. Thus when the Bubble being look'd on by the 4909Light of the Clouds reflected from it, seemed red at its apparent 4910Circumference, if the Clouds at the same time, or immediately after, 4911were view'd through it, the Colour at its Circumference would be blue. 4912And, on the contrary, when by reflected Light it appeared blue, it would 4913appear red by transmitted Light. 4914 4915_Obs._ 21. By wetting very thin Plates of _Muscovy_ Glass, whose 4916thinness made the like Colours appear, the Colours became more faint and 4917languid, especially by wetting the Plates on that side opposite to the 4918Eye: But I could not perceive any variation of their Species. So then 4919the thickness of a Plate requisite to produce any Colour, depends only 4920on the density of the Plate, and not on that of the ambient Medium. And 4921hence, by the 10th and 16th Observations, may be known the thickness 4922which Bubbles of Water, or Plates of _Muscovy_ Glass, or other 4923Substances, have at any Colour produced by them. 4924 4925_Obs._ 22. A thin transparent Body, which is denser than its ambient 4926Medium, exhibits more brisk and vivid Colours than that which is so much 4927rarer; as I have particularly observed in the Air and Glass. For blowing 4928Glass very thin at a Lamp Furnace, those Plates encompassed with Air did 4929exhibit Colours much more vivid than those of Air made thin between two 4930Glasses. 4931 4932_Obs._ 23. Comparing the quantity of Light reflected from the several 4933Rings, I found that it was most copious from the first or inmost, and in 4934the exterior Rings became gradually less and less. Also the whiteness of 4935the first Ring was stronger than that reflected from those parts of the 4936thin Medium or Plate which were without the Rings; as I could manifestly 4937perceive by viewing at a distance the Rings made by the two 4938Object-glasses; or by comparing two Bubbles of Water blown at distant 4939Times, in the first of which the Whiteness appear'd, which succeeded all 4940the Colours, and in the other, the Whiteness which preceded them all. 4941 4942_Obs._ 24. When the two Object-glasses were lay'd upon one another, so 4943as to make the Rings of the Colours appear, though with my naked Eye I 4944could not discern above eight or nine of those Rings, yet by viewing 4945them through a Prism I have seen a far greater Multitude, insomuch that 4946I could number more than forty, besides many others, that were so very 4947small and close together, that I could not keep my Eye steady on them 4948severally so as to number them, but by their Extent I have sometimes 4949estimated them to be more than an hundred. And I believe the Experiment 4950may be improved to the Discovery of far greater Numbers. For they seem 4951to be really unlimited, though visible only so far as they can be 4952separated by the Refraction of the Prism, as I shall hereafter explain. 4953 4954[Illustration: FIG. 5.] 4955 4956But it was but one side of these Rings, namely, that towards which the 4957Refraction was made, which by that Refraction was render'd distinct, and 4958the other side became more confused than when view'd by the naked Eye, 4959insomuch that there I could not discern above one or two, and sometimes 4960none of those Rings, of which I could discern eight or nine with my 4961naked Eye. And their Segments or Arcs, which on the other side appear'd 4962so numerous, for the most part exceeded not the third Part of a Circle. 4963If the Refraction was very great, or the Prism very distant from the 4964Object-glasses, the middle Part of those Arcs became also confused, so 4965as to disappear and constitute an even Whiteness, whilst on either side 4966their Ends, as also the whole Arcs farthest from the Center, became 4967distincter than before, appearing in the Form as you see them design'd 4968in the fifth Figure. 4969 4970The Arcs, where they seem'd distinctest, were only white and black 4971successively, without any other Colours intermix'd. But in other Places 4972there appeared Colours, whose Order was inverted by the refraction in 4973such manner, that if I first held the Prism very near the 4974Object-glasses, and then gradually removed it farther off towards my 4975Eye, the Colours of the 2d, 3d, 4th, and following Rings, shrunk towards 4976the white that emerged between them, until they wholly vanish'd into it 4977at the middle of the Arcs, and afterwards emerged again in a contrary 4978Order. But at the Ends of the Arcs they retain'd their Order unchanged. 4979 4980I have sometimes so lay'd one Object-glass upon the other, that to the 4981naked Eye they have all over seem'd uniformly white, without the least 4982Appearance of any of the colour'd Rings; and yet by viewing them through 4983a Prism, great Multitudes of those Rings have discover'd themselves. And 4984in like manner Plates of _Muscovy_ Glass, and Bubbles of Glass blown at 4985a Lamp-Furnace, which were not so thin as to exhibit any Colours to the 4986naked Eye, have through the Prism exhibited a great Variety of them 4987ranged irregularly up and down in the Form of Waves. And so Bubbles of 4988Water, before they began to exhibit their Colours to the naked Eye of a 4989Bystander, have appeared through a Prism, girded about with many 4990parallel and horizontal Rings; to produce which Effect, it was necessary 4991to hold the Prism parallel, or very nearly parallel to the Horizon, and 4992to dispose it so that the Rays might be refracted upwards. 4993 4994 4995 4996 4997THE 4998 4999SECOND BOOK 5000 5001OF 5002 5003OPTICKS 5004 5005 5006_PART II._ 5007 5008_Remarks upon the foregoing Observations._ 5009 5010 5011Having given my Observations of these Colours, before I make use of them 5012to unfold the Causes of the Colours of natural Bodies, it is convenient 5013that by the simplest of them, such as are the 2d, 3d, 4th, 9th, 12th, 501418th, 20th, and 24th, I first explain the more compounded. And first to 5015shew how the Colours in the fourth and eighteenth Observations are 5016produced, let there be taken in any Right Line from the Point Y, [in 5017_Fig._ 6.] the Lengths YA, YB, YC, YD, YE, YF, YG, YH, in proportion to 5018one another, as the Cube-Roots of the Squares of the Numbers, 1/2, 9/16, 50193/5, 2/3, 3/4, 5/6, 8/9, 1, whereby the Lengths of a Musical Chord to 5020sound all the Notes in an eighth are represented; that is, in the 5021Proportion of the Numbers 6300, 6814, 7114, 7631, 8255, 8855, 9243, 502210000. And at the Points A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, let Perpendiculars 5023A[Greek: a], B[Greek: b], &c. be erected, by whose Intervals the Extent 5024of the several Colours set underneath against them, is to be 5025represented. Then divide the Line _A[Greek: a]_ in such Proportion as 5026the Numbers 1, 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, &c. set at the Points of 5027Division denote. And through those Divisions from Y draw Lines 1I, 2K, 50283L, 5M, 6N, 7O, &c. 5029 5030Now, if A2 be supposed to represent the Thickness of any thin 5031transparent Body, at which the outmost Violet is most copiously 5032reflected in the first Ring, or Series of Colours, then by the 13th 5033Observation, HK will represent its Thickness, at which the utmost Red is 5034most copiously reflected in the same Series. Also by the 5th and 16th 5035Observations, A6 and HN will denote the Thicknesses at which those 5036extreme Colours are most copiously reflected in the second Series, and 5037A10 and HQ the Thicknesses at which they are most copiously reflected in 5038the third Series, and so on. And the Thickness at which any of the 5039intermediate Colours are reflected most copiously, will, according to 5040the 14th Observation, be defined by the distance of the Line AH from the 5041intermediate parts of the Lines 2K, 6N, 10Q, &c. against which the Names 5042of those Colours are written below. 5043 5044[Illustration: FIG. 6.] 5045 5046But farther, to define the Latitude of these Colours in each Ring or 5047Series, let A1 design the least thickness, and A3 the greatest 5048thickness, at which the extreme violet in the first Series is reflected, 5049and let HI, and HL, design the like limits for the extreme red, and let 5050the intermediate Colours be limited by the intermediate parts of the 5051Lines 1I, and 3L, against which the Names of those Colours are written, 5052and so on: But yet with this caution, that the Reflexions be supposed 5053strongest at the intermediate Spaces, 2K, 6N, 10Q, &c. and from thence 5054to decrease gradually towards these limits, 1I, 3L, 5M, 7O, &c. on 5055either side; where you must not conceive them to be precisely limited, 5056but to decay indefinitely. And whereas I have assign'd the same Latitude 5057to every Series, I did it, because although the Colours in the first 5058Series seem to be a little broader than the rest, by reason of a 5059stronger Reflexion there, yet that inequality is so insensible as 5060scarcely to be determin'd by Observation. 5061 5062Now according to this Description, conceiving that the Rays originally 5063of several Colours are by turns reflected at the Spaces 1I, L3, 5M, O7, 50649PR11, &c. and transmitted at the Spaces AHI1, 3LM5, 7OP9, &c. it is 5065easy to know what Colour must in the open Air be exhibited at any 5066thickness of a transparent thin Body. For if a Ruler be applied parallel 5067to AH, at that distance from it by which the thickness of the Body is 5068represented, the alternate Spaces 1IL3, 5MO7, &c. which it crosseth will 5069denote the reflected original Colours, of which the Colour exhibited in 5070the open Air is compounded. Thus if the constitution of the green in the 5071third Series of Colours be desired, apply the Ruler as you see at 5072[Greek: prsph], and by its passing through some of the blue at [Greek: 5073p] and yellow at [Greek: s], as well as through the green at [Greek: r], 5074you may conclude that the green exhibited at that thickness of the Body 5075is principally constituted of original green, but not without a mixture 5076of some blue and yellow. 5077 5078By this means you may know how the Colours from the center of the Rings 5079outward ought to succeed in order as they were described in the 4th and 508018th Observations. For if you move the Ruler gradually from AH through 5081all distances, having pass'd over the first Space which denotes little 5082or no Reflexion to be made by thinnest Substances, it will first arrive 5083at 1 the violet, and then very quickly at the blue and green, which 5084together with that violet compound blue, and then at the yellow and red, 5085by whose farther addition that blue is converted into whiteness, which 5086whiteness continues during the transit of the edge of the Ruler from I 5087to 3, and after that by the successive deficience of its component 5088Colours, turns first to compound yellow, and then to red, and last of 5089all the red ceaseth at L. Then begin the Colours of the second Series, 5090which succeed in order during the transit of the edge of the Ruler from 50915 to O, and are more lively than before, because more expanded and 5092severed. And for the same reason instead of the former white there 5093intercedes between the blue and yellow a mixture of orange, yellow, 5094green, blue and indigo, all which together ought to exhibit a dilute and 5095imperfect green. So the Colours of the third Series all succeed in 5096order; first, the violet, which a little interferes with the red of the 5097second order, and is thereby inclined to a reddish purple; then the blue 5098and green, which are less mix'd with other Colours, and consequently 5099more lively than before, especially the green: Then follows the yellow, 5100some of which towards the green is distinct and good, but that part of 5101it towards the succeeding red, as also that red is mix'd with the violet 5102and blue of the fourth Series, whereby various degrees of red very much 5103inclining to purple are compounded. This violet and blue, which should 5104succeed this red, being mixed with, and hidden in it, there succeeds a 5105green. And this at first is much inclined to blue, but soon becomes a 5106good green, the only unmix'd and lively Colour in this fourth Series. 5107For as it verges towards the yellow, it begins to interfere with the 5108Colours of the fifth Series, by whose mixture the succeeding yellow and 5109red are very much diluted and made dirty, especially the yellow, which 5110being the weaker Colour is scarce able to shew it self. After this the 5111several Series interfere more and more, and their Colours become more 5112and more intermix'd, till after three or four more revolutions (in which 5113the red and blue predominate by turns) all sorts of Colours are in all 5114places pretty equally blended, and compound an even whiteness. 5115 5116And since by the 15th Observation the Rays endued with one Colour are 5117transmitted, where those of another Colour are reflected, the reason of 5118the Colours made by the transmitted Light in the 9th and 20th 5119Observations is from hence evident. 5120 5121If not only the Order and Species of these Colours, but also the precise 5122thickness of the Plate, or thin Body at which they are exhibited, be 5123desired in parts of an Inch, that may be also obtained by assistance of 5124the 6th or 16th Observations. For according to those Observations the 5125thickness of the thinned Air, which between two Glasses exhibited the 5126most luminous parts of the first six Rings were 1/178000, 3/178000, 51275/178000, 7/178000, 9/178000, 11/178000 parts of an Inch. Suppose the 5128Light reflected most copiously at these thicknesses be the bright 5129citrine yellow, or confine of yellow and orange, and these thicknesses 5130will be F[Greek: l], F[Greek: m], F[Greek: u], F[Greek: x], F[Greek: o], 5131F[Greek: t]. And this being known, it is easy to determine what 5132thickness of Air is represented by G[Greek: ph], or by any other 5133distance of the Ruler from AH. 5134 5135But farther, since by the 10th Observation the thickness of Air was to 5136the thickness of Water, which between the same Glasses exhibited the 5137same Colour, as 4 to 3, and by the 21st Observation the Colours of thin 5138Bodies are not varied by varying the ambient Medium; the thickness of a 5139Bubble of Water, exhibiting any Colour, will be 3/4 of the thickness of 5140Air producing the same Colour. And so according to the same 10th and 514121st Observations, the thickness of a Plate of Glass, whose Refraction 5142of the mean refrangible Ray, is measured by the proportion of the Sines 514331 to 20, may be 20/31 of the thickness of Air producing the same 5144Colours; and the like of other Mediums. I do not affirm, that this 5145proportion of 20 to 31, holds in all the Rays; for the Sines of other 5146sorts of Rays have other Proportions. But the differences of those 5147Proportions are so little that I do not here consider them. On these 5148Grounds I have composed the following Table, wherein the thickness of 5149Air, Water, and Glass, at which each Colour is most intense and 5150specifick, is expressed in parts of an Inch divided into ten hundred 5151thousand equal parts. 5152 5153Now if this Table be compared with the 6th Scheme, you will there see 5154the constitution of each Colour, as to its Ingredients, or the original 5155Colours of which it is compounded, and thence be enabled to judge of its 5156Intenseness or Imperfection; which may suffice in explication of the 4th 5157and 18th Observations, unless it be farther desired to delineate the 5158manner how the Colours appear, when the two Object-glasses are laid upon 5159one another. To do which, let there be described a large Arc of a 5160Circle, and a streight Line which may touch that Arc, and parallel to 5161that Tangent several occult Lines, at such distances from it, as the 5162Numbers set against the several Colours in the Table denote. For the 5163Arc, and its Tangent, will represent the Superficies of the Glasses 5164terminating the interjacent Air; and the places where the occult Lines 5165cut the Arc will show at what distances from the center, or Point of 5166contact, each Colour is reflected. 5167 5168_The thickness of colour'd Plates and Particles of_ 5169 _____________|_______________ 5170 / \ 5171 Air. Water. Glass. 5172 |---------+----------+----------+ 5173 {Very black | 1/2 | 3/8 | 10/31 | 5174 {Black | 1 | 3/4 | 20/31 | 5175 {Beginning of | | | | 5176 { Black | 2 | 1-1/2 | 1-2/7 | 5177Their Colours of the {Blue | 2-2/5 | 1-4/5 | 1-11/22 | 5178first Order, {White | 5-1/4 | 3-7/8 | 3-2/5 | 5179 {Yellow | 7-1/9 | 5-1/3 | 4-3/5 | 5180 {Orange | 8 | 6 | 5-1/6 | 5181 {Red | 9 | 6-3/4 | 5-4/5 | 5182 |---------+----------+----------| 5183 {Violet | 11-1/6 | 8-3/8 | 7-1/5 | 5184 {Indigo | 12-5/6 | 9-5/8 | 8-2/11 | 5185 {Blue | 14 | 10-1/2 | 9 | 5186 {Green | 15-1/8 | 11-2/3 | 9-5/7 | 5187Of the second order, {Yellow | 16-2/7 | 12-1/5 | 10-2/5 | 5188 {Orange | 17-2/9 | 13 | 11-1/9 | 5189 {Bright red | 18-1/3 | 13-3/4 | 11-5/6 | 5190 {Scarlet | 19-2/3 | 14-3/4 | 12-2/3 | 5191 |---------+----------+----------| 5192 {Purple | 21 | 15-3/4 | 13-11/20 | 5193 {Indigo | 22-1/10 | 16-4/7 | 14-1/4 | 5194 {Blue | 23-2/5 | 17-11/20 | 15-1/10 | 5195Of the third Order, {Green | 25-1/5 | 18-9/10 | 16-1/4 | 5196 {Yellow | 27-1/7 | 20-1/3 | 17-1/2 | 5197 {Red | 29 | 21-3/4 | 18-5/7 | 5198 {Bluish red | 32 | 24 | 20-2/3 | 5199 |---------+----------+----------| 5200 {Bluish green | 34 | 25-1/2 | 22 | 5201 {Green | 35-2/7 | 26-1/2 | 22-3/4 | 5202Of the fourth Order, {Yellowish green | 36 | 27 | 23-2/9 | 5203 {Red | 40-1/3 | 30-1/4 | 26 | 5204 |---------+----------+----------| 5205 {Greenish blue | 46 | 34-1/2 | 29-2/3 | 5206Of the fifth Order, {Red | 52-1/2 | 39-3/8 | 34 | 5207 |---------+----------+----------| 5208 {Greenish blue | 58-3/4 | 44 | 38 | 5209Of the sixth Order, {Red | 65 | 48-3/4 | 42 | 5210 |---------+----------+----------| 5211Of the seventh Order, {Greenish blue | 71 | 53-1/4 | 45-4/5 | 5212 {Ruddy White | 77 | 57-3/4 | 49-2/3 | 5213 |---------+----------+----------| 5214 5215There are also other Uses of this Table: For by its assistance the 5216thickness of the Bubble in the 19th Observation was determin'd by the 5217Colours which it exhibited. And so the bigness of the parts of natural 5218Bodies may be conjectured by their Colours, as shall be hereafter shewn. 5219Also, if two or more very thin Plates be laid one upon another, so as to 5220compose one Plate equalling them all in thickness, the resulting Colour 5221may be hereby determin'd. For instance, Mr. _Hook_ observed, as is 5222mentioned in his _Micrographia_, that a faint yellow Plate of _Muscovy_ 5223Glass laid upon a blue one, constituted a very deep purple. The yellow 5224of the first Order is a faint one, and the thickness of the Plate 5225exhibiting it, according to the Table is 4-3/5, to which add 9, the 5226thickness exhibiting blue of the second Order, and the Sum will be 522713-3/5, which is the thickness exhibiting the purple of the third Order. 5228 5229To explain, in the next place, the circumstances of the 2d and 3d 5230Observations; that is, how the Rings of the Colours may (by turning the 5231Prisms about their common Axis the contrary way to that expressed in 5232those Observations) be converted into white and black Rings, and 5233afterwards into Rings of Colours again, the Colours of each Ring lying 5234now in an inverted order; it must be remember'd, that those Rings of 5235Colours are dilated by the obliquation of the Rays to the Air which 5236intercedes the Glasses, and that according to the Table in the 7th 5237Observation, their Dilatation or Increase of their Diameter is most 5238manifest and speedy when they are obliquest. Now the Rays of yellow 5239being more refracted by the first Superficies of the said Air than those 5240of red, are thereby made more oblique to the second Superficies, at 5241which they are reflected to produce the colour'd Rings, and consequently 5242the yellow Circle in each Ring will be more dilated than the red; and 5243the Excess of its Dilatation will be so much the greater, by how much 5244the greater is the obliquity of the Rays, until at last it become of 5245equal extent with the red of the same Ring. And for the same reason the 5246green, blue and violet, will be also so much dilated by the still 5247greater obliquity of their Rays, as to become all very nearly of equal 5248extent with the red, that is, equally distant from the center of the 5249Rings. And then all the Colours of the same Ring must be co-incident, 5250and by their mixture exhibit a white Ring. And these white Rings must 5251have black and dark Rings between them, because they do not spread and 5252interfere with one another, as before. And for that reason also they 5253must become distincter, and visible to far greater numbers. But yet the 5254violet being obliquest will be something more dilated, in proportion to 5255its extent, than the other Colours, and so very apt to appear at the 5256exterior Verges of the white. 5257 5258Afterwards, by a greater obliquity of the Rays, the violet and blue 5259become more sensibly dilated than the red and yellow, and so being 5260farther removed from the center of the Rings, the Colours must emerge 5261out of the white in an order contrary to that which they had before; the 5262violet and blue at the exterior Limbs of each Ring, and the red and 5263yellow at the interior. And the violet, by reason of the greatest 5264obliquity of its Rays, being in proportion most of all expanded, will 5265soonest appear at the exterior Limb of each white Ring, and become more 5266conspicuous than the rest. And the several Series of Colours belonging 5267to the several Rings, will, by their unfolding and spreading, begin 5268again to interfere, and thereby render the Rings less distinct, and not 5269visible to so great numbers. 5270 5271If instead of the Prisms the Object-glasses be made use of, the Rings 5272which they exhibit become not white and distinct by the obliquity of the 5273Eye, by reason that the Rays in their passage through that Air which 5274intercedes the Glasses are very nearly parallel to those Lines in which 5275they were first incident on the Glasses, and consequently the Rays 5276endued with several Colours are not inclined one more than another to 5277that Air, as it happens in the Prisms. 5278 5279There is yet another circumstance of these Experiments to be consider'd, 5280and that is why the black and white Rings which when view'd at a 5281distance appear distinct, should not only become confused by viewing 5282them near at hand, but also yield a violet Colour at both the edges of 5283every white Ring. And the reason is, that the Rays which enter the Eye 5284at several parts of the Pupil, have several Obliquities to the Glasses, 5285and those which are most oblique, if consider'd apart, would represent 5286the Rings bigger than those which are the least oblique. Whence the 5287breadth of the Perimeter of every white Ring is expanded outwards by the 5288obliquest Rays, and inwards by the least oblique. And this Expansion is 5289so much the greater by how much the greater is the difference of the 5290Obliquity; that is, by how much the Pupil is wider, or the Eye nearer to 5291the Glasses. And the breadth of the violet must be most expanded, 5292because the Rays apt to excite a Sensation of that Colour are most 5293oblique to a second or farther Superficies of the thinn'd Air at which 5294they are reflected, and have also the greatest variation of Obliquity, 5295which makes that Colour soonest emerge out of the edges of the white. 5296And as the breadth of every Ring is thus augmented, the dark Intervals 5297must be diminish'd, until the neighbouring Rings become continuous, and 5298are blended, the exterior first, and then those nearer the center; so 5299that they can no longer be distinguish'd apart, but seem to constitute 5300an even and uniform whiteness. 5301 5302Among all the Observations there is none accompanied with so odd 5303circumstances as the twenty-fourth. Of those the principal are, that in 5304thin Plates, which to the naked Eye seem of an even and uniform 5305transparent whiteness, without any terminations of Shadows, the 5306Refraction of a Prism should make Rings of Colours appear, whereas it 5307usually makes Objects appear colour'd only there where they are 5308terminated with Shadows, or have parts unequally luminous; and that it 5309should make those Rings exceedingly distinct and white, although it 5310usually renders Objects confused and coloured. The Cause of these things 5311you will understand by considering, that all the Rings of Colours are 5312really in the Plate, when view'd with the naked Eye, although by reason 5313of the great breadth of their Circumferences they so much interfere and 5314are blended together, that they seem to constitute an uniform whiteness. 5315But when the Rays pass through the Prism to the Eye, the Orbits of the 5316several Colours in every Ring are refracted, some more than others, 5317according to their degrees of Refrangibility: By which means the Colours 5318on one side of the Ring (that is in the circumference on one side of its 5319center), become more unfolded and dilated, and those on the other side 5320more complicated and contracted. And where by a due Refraction they are 5321so much contracted, that the several Rings become narrower than to 5322interfere with one another, they must appear distinct, and also white, 5323if the constituent Colours be so much contracted as to be wholly 5324co-incident. But on the other side, where the Orbit of every Ring is 5325made broader by the farther unfolding of its Colours, it must interfere 5326more with other Rings than before, and so become less distinct. 5327 5328[Illustration: FIG. 7.] 5329 5330To explain this a little farther, suppose the concentrick Circles AV, 5331and BX, [in _Fig._ 7.] represent the red and violet of any Order, which, 5332together with the intermediate Colours, constitute any one of these 5333Rings. Now these being view'd through a Prism, the violet Circle BX, 5334will, by a greater Refraction, be farther translated from its place than 5335the red AV, and so approach nearer to it on that side of the Circles, 5336towards which the Refractions are made. For instance, if the red be 5337translated to _av_, the violet may be translated to _bx_, so as to 5338approach nearer to it at _x_ than before; and if the red be farther 5339translated to av, the violet may be so much farther translated to bx as 5340to convene with it at x; and if the red be yet farther translated to 5341[Greek: aY], the violet may be still so much farther translated to 5342[Greek: bx] as to pass beyond it at [Greek: x], and convene with it at 5343_e_ and _f_. And this being understood not only of the red and violet, 5344but of all the other intermediate Colours, and also of every revolution 5345of those Colours, you will easily perceive how those of the same 5346revolution or order, by their nearness at _xv_ and [Greek: Yx], and 5347their coincidence at xv, _e_ and _f_, ought to constitute pretty 5348distinct Arcs of Circles, especially at xv, or at _e_ and _f_; and that 5349they will appear severally at _x_[Greek: u] and at xv exhibit whiteness 5350by their coincidence, and again appear severally at [Greek: Yx], but yet 5351in a contrary order to that which they had before, and still retain 5352beyond _e_ and _f_. But on the other side, at _ab_, ab, or [Greek: ab], 5353these Colours must become much more confused by being dilated and spread 5354so as to interfere with those of other Orders. And the same confusion 5355will happen at [Greek: Ux] between _e_ and _f_, if the Refraction be 5356very great, or the Prism very distant from the Object-glasses: In which 5357case no parts of the Rings will be seen, save only two little Arcs at 5358_e_ and _f_, whose distance from one another will be augmented by 5359removing the Prism still farther from the Object-glasses: And these 5360little Arcs must be distinctest and whitest at their middle, and at 5361their ends, where they begin to grow confused, they must be colour'd. 5362And the Colours at one end of every Arc must be in a contrary order to 5363those at the other end, by reason that they cross in the intermediate 5364white; namely, their ends, which verge towards [Greek: Ux], will be red 5365and yellow on that side next the center, and blue and violet on the 5366other side. But their other ends which verge from [Greek: Ux], will on 5367the contrary be blue and violet on that side towards the center, and on 5368the other side red and yellow. 5369 5370Now as all these things follow from the properties of Light by a 5371mathematical way of reasoning, so the truth of them may be manifested by 5372Experiments. For in a dark Room, by viewing these Rings through a Prism, 5373by reflexion of the several prismatick Colours, which an assistant 5374causes to move to and fro upon a Wall or Paper from whence they are 5375reflected, whilst the Spectator's Eye, the Prism, and the 5376Object-glasses, (as in the 13th Observation,) are placed steady; the 5377Position of the Circles made successively by the several Colours, will 5378be found such, in respect of one another, as I have described in the 5379Figures _abxv_, or abxv, or _[Greek: abxU]_. And by the same method the 5380truth of the Explications of other Observations may be examined. 5381 5382By what hath been said, the like Phænomena of Water and thin Plates of 5383Glass may be understood. But in small fragments of those Plates there is 5384this farther observable, that where they lie flat upon a Table, and are 5385turned about their centers whilst they are view'd through a Prism, they 5386will in some postures exhibit Waves of various Colours; and some of them 5387exhibit these Waves in one or two Positions only, but the most of them 5388do in all Positions exhibit them, and make them for the most part appear 5389almost all over the Plates. The reason is, that the Superficies of such 5390Plates are not even, but have many Cavities and Swellings, which, how 5391shallow soever, do a little vary the thickness of the Plate. For at the 5392several sides of those Cavities, for the Reasons newly described, there 5393ought to be produced Waves in several postures of the Prism. Now though 5394it be but some very small and narrower parts of the Glass, by which 5395these Waves for the most part are caused, yet they may seem to extend 5396themselves over the whole Glass, because from the narrowest of those 5397parts there are Colours of several Orders, that is, of several Rings, 5398confusedly reflected, which by Refraction of the Prism are unfolded, 5399separated, and, according to their degrees of Refraction, dispersed to 5400several places, so as to constitute so many several Waves, as there were 5401divers orders of Colours promiscuously reflected from that part of the 5402Glass. 5403 5404These are the principal Phænomena of thin Plates or Bubbles, whose 5405Explications depend on the properties of Light, which I have heretofore 5406deliver'd. And these you see do necessarily follow from them, and agree 5407with them, even to their very least circumstances; and not only so, but 5408do very much tend to their proof. Thus, by the 24th Observation it 5409appears, that the Rays of several Colours, made as well by thin Plates 5410or Bubbles, as by Refractions of a Prism, have several degrees of 5411Refrangibility; whereby those of each order, which at the reflexion from 5412the Plate or Bubble are intermix'd with those of other orders, are 5413separated from them by Refraction, and associated together so as to 5414become visible by themselves like Arcs of Circles. For if the Rays were 5415all alike refrangible, 'tis impossible that the whiteness, which to the 5416naked Sense appears uniform, should by Refraction have its parts 5417transposed and ranged into those black and white Arcs. 5418 5419It appears also that the unequal Refractions of difform Rays proceed not 5420from any contingent irregularities; such as are Veins, an uneven Polish, 5421or fortuitous Position of the Pores of Glass; unequal and casual Motions 5422in the Air or Æther, the spreading, breaking, or dividing the same Ray 5423into many diverging parts; or the like. For, admitting any such 5424irregularities, it would be impossible for Refractions to render those 5425Rings so very distinct, and well defined, as they do in the 24th 5426Observation. It is necessary therefore that every Ray have its proper 5427and constant degree of Refrangibility connate with it, according to 5428which its refraction is ever justly and regularly perform'd; and that 5429several Rays have several of those degrees. 5430 5431And what is said of their Refrangibility may be also understood of their 5432Reflexibility, that is, of their Dispositions to be reflected, some at a 5433greater, and others at a less thickness of thin Plates or Bubbles; 5434namely, that those Dispositions are also connate with the Rays, and 5435immutable; as may appear by the 13th, 14th, and 15th Observations, 5436compared with the fourth and eighteenth. 5437 5438By the Precedent Observations it appears also, that whiteness is a 5439dissimilar mixture of all Colours, and that Light is a mixture of Rays 5440endued with all those Colours. For, considering the multitude of the 5441Rings of Colours in the 3d, 12th, and 24th Observations, it is manifest, 5442that although in the 4th and 18th Observations there appear no more than 5443eight or nine of those Rings, yet there are really a far greater number, 5444which so much interfere and mingle with one another, as after those 5445eight or nine revolutions to dilute one another wholly, and constitute 5446an even and sensibly uniform whiteness. And consequently that whiteness 5447must be allow'd a mixture of all Colours, and the Light which conveys it 5448to the Eye must be a mixture of Rays endued with all those Colours. 5449 5450But farther; by the 24th Observation it appears, that there is a 5451constant relation between Colours and Refrangibility; the most 5452refrangible Rays being violet, the least refrangible red, and those of 5453intermediate Colours having proportionably intermediate degrees of 5454Refrangibility. And by the 13th, 14th, and 15th Observations, compared 5455with the 4th or 18th there appears to be the same constant relation 5456between Colour and Reflexibility; the violet being in like circumstances 5457reflected at least thicknesses of any thin Plate or Bubble, the red at 5458greatest thicknesses, and the intermediate Colours at intermediate 5459thicknesses. Whence it follows, that the colorifick Dispositions of 5460Rays are also connate with them, and immutable; and by consequence, that 5461all the Productions and Appearances of Colours in the World are derived, 5462not from any physical Change caused in Light by Refraction or Reflexion, 5463but only from the various Mixtures or Separations of Rays, by virtue of 5464their different Refrangibility or Reflexibility. And in this respect the 5465Science of Colours becomes a Speculation as truly mathematical as any 5466other part of Opticks. I mean, so far as they depend on the Nature of 5467Light, and are not produced or alter'd by the Power of Imagination, or 5468by striking or pressing the Eye. 5469 5470 5471 5472 5473THE 5474 5475SECOND BOOK 5476 5477OF 5478 5479OPTICKS 5480 5481 5482_PART III._ 5483 5484_Of the permanent Colours of natural Bodies, and the Analogy between 5485them and the Colours of thin transparent Plates._ 5486 5487I am now come to another part of this Design, which is to consider how 5488the Phænomena of thin transparent Plates stand related to those of all 5489other natural Bodies. Of these Bodies I have already told you that they 5490appear of divers Colours, accordingly as they are disposed to reflect 5491most copiously the Rays originally endued with those Colours. But their 5492Constitutions, whereby they reflect some Rays more copiously than 5493others, remain to be discover'd; and these I shall endeavour to manifest 5494in the following Propositions. 5495 5496 5497PROP. I. 5498 5499_Those Superficies of transparent Bodies reflect the greatest quantity 5500of Light, which have the greatest refracting Power; that is, which 5501intercede Mediums that differ most in their refractive Densities. And in 5502the Confines of equally refracting Mediums there is no Reflexion._ 5503 5504The Analogy between Reflexion and Refraction will appear by considering, 5505that when Light passeth obliquely out of one Medium into another which 5506refracts from the perpendicular, the greater is the difference of their 5507refractive Density, the less Obliquity of Incidence is requisite to 5508cause a total Reflexion. For as the Sines are which measure the 5509Refraction, so is the Sine of Incidence at which the total Reflexion 5510begins, to the Radius of the Circle; and consequently that Angle of 5511Incidence is least where there is the greatest difference of the Sines. 5512Thus in the passing of Light out of Water into Air, where the Refraction 5513is measured by the Ratio of the Sines 3 to 4, the total Reflexion begins 5514when the Angle of Incidence is about 48 Degrees 35 Minutes. In passing 5515out of Glass into Air, where the Refraction is measured by the Ratio of 5516the Sines 20 to 31, the total Reflexion begins when the Angle of 5517Incidence is 40 Degrees 10 Minutes; and so in passing out of Crystal, or 5518more strongly refracting Mediums into Air, there is still a less 5519obliquity requisite to cause a total reflexion. Superficies therefore 5520which refract most do soonest reflect all the Light which is incident on 5521them, and so must be allowed most strongly reflexive. 5522 5523But the truth of this Proposition will farther appear by observing, that 5524in the Superficies interceding two transparent Mediums, (such as are 5525Air, Water, Oil, common Glass, Crystal, metalline Glasses, Island 5526Glasses, white transparent Arsenick, Diamonds, &c.) the Reflexion is 5527stronger or weaker accordingly, as the Superficies hath a greater or 5528less refracting Power. For in the Confine of Air and Sal-gem 'tis 5529stronger than in the Confine of Air and Water, and still stronger in the 5530Confine of Air and common Glass or Crystal, and stronger in the Confine 5531of Air and a Diamond. If any of these, and such like transparent Solids, 5532be immerged in Water, its Reflexion becomes, much weaker than before; 5533and still weaker if they be immerged in the more strongly refracting 5534Liquors of well rectified Oil of Vitriol or Spirit of Turpentine. If 5535Water be distinguish'd into two parts by any imaginary Surface, the 5536Reflexion in the Confine of those two parts is none at all. In the 5537Confine of Water and Ice 'tis very little; in that of Water and Oil 'tis 5538something greater; in that of Water and Sal-gem still greater; and in 5539that of Water and Glass, or Crystal or other denser Substances still 5540greater, accordingly as those Mediums differ more or less in their 5541refracting Powers. Hence in the Confine of common Glass and Crystal, 5542there ought to be a weak Reflexion, and a stronger Reflexion in the 5543Confine of common and metalline Glass; though I have not yet tried 5544this. But in the Confine of two Glasses of equal density, there is not 5545any sensible Reflexion; as was shewn in the first Observation. And the 5546same may be understood of the Superficies interceding two Crystals, or 5547two Liquors, or any other Substances in which no Refraction is caused. 5548So then the reason why uniform pellucid Mediums (such as Water, Glass, 5549or Crystal,) have no sensible Reflexion but in their external 5550Superficies, where they are adjacent to other Mediums of a different 5551density, is because all their contiguous parts have one and the same 5552degree of density. 5553 5554 5555PROP. II. 5556 5557_The least parts of almost all natural Bodies are in some measure 5558transparent: And the Opacity of those Bodies ariseth from the multitude 5559of Reflexions caused in their internal Parts._ 5560 5561That this is so has been observed by others, and will easily be granted 5562by them that have been conversant with Microscopes. And it may be also 5563tried by applying any substance to a hole through which some Light is 5564immitted into a dark Room. For how opake soever that Substance may seem 5565in the open Air, it will by that means appear very manifestly 5566transparent, if it be of a sufficient thinness. Only white metalline 5567Bodies must be excepted, which by reason of their excessive density seem 5568to reflect almost all the Light incident on their first Superficies; 5569unless by solution in Menstruums they be reduced into very small 5570Particles, and then they become transparent. 5571 5572 5573PROP. III. 5574 5575_Between the parts of opake and colour'd Bodies are many Spaces, either 5576empty, or replenish'd with Mediums of other Densities; as Water between 5577the tinging Corpuscles wherewith any Liquor is impregnated, Air between 5578the aqueous Globules that constitute Clouds or Mists; and for the most 5579part Spaces void of both Air and Water, but yet perhaps not wholly void 5580of all Substance, between the parts of hard Bodies._ 5581 5582The truth of this is evinced by the two precedent Propositions: For by 5583the second Proposition there are many Reflexions made by the internal 5584parts of Bodies, which, by the first Proposition, would not happen if 5585the parts of those Bodies were continued without any such Interstices 5586between them; because Reflexions are caused only in Superficies, which 5587intercede Mediums of a differing density, by _Prop._ 1. 5588 5589But farther, that this discontinuity of parts is the principal Cause of 5590the opacity of Bodies, will appear by considering, that opake Substances 5591become transparent by filling their Pores with any Substance of equal or 5592almost equal density with their parts. Thus Paper dipped in Water or 5593Oil, the _Oculus Mundi_ Stone steep'd in Water, Linnen Cloth oiled or 5594varnish'd, and many other Substances soaked in such Liquors as will 5595intimately pervade their little Pores, become by that means more 5596transparent than otherwise; so, on the contrary, the most transparent 5597Substances, may, by evacuating their Pores, or separating their parts, 5598be render'd sufficiently opake; as Salts or wet Paper, or the _Oculus 5599Mundi_ Stone by being dried, Horn by being scraped, Glass by being 5600reduced to Powder, or otherwise flawed; Turpentine by being stirred 5601about with Water till they mix imperfectly, and Water by being form'd 5602into many small Bubbles, either alone in the form of Froth, or by 5603shaking it together with Oil of Turpentine, or Oil Olive, or with some 5604other convenient Liquor, with which it will not perfectly incorporate. 5605And to the increase of the opacity of these Bodies, it conduces 5606something, that by the 23d Observation the Reflexions of very thin 5607transparent Substances are considerably stronger than those made by the 5608same Substances of a greater thickness. 5609 5610 5611PROP. IV. 5612 5613_The Parts of Bodies and their Interstices must not be less than of some 5614definite bigness, to render them opake and colour'd._ 5615 5616For the opakest Bodies, if their parts be subtilly divided, (as Metals, 5617by being dissolved in acid Menstruums, &c.) become perfectly 5618transparent. And you may also remember, that in the eighth Observation 5619there was no sensible reflexion at the Superficies of the 5620Object-glasses, where they were very near one another, though they did 5621not absolutely touch. And in the 17th Observation the Reflexion of the 5622Water-bubble where it became thinnest was almost insensible, so as to 5623cause very black Spots to appear on the top of the Bubble, by the want 5624of reflected Light. 5625 5626On these grounds I perceive it is that Water, Salt, Glass, Stones, and 5627such like Substances, are transparent. For, upon divers Considerations, 5628they seem to be as full of Pores or Interstices between their parts as 5629other Bodies are, but yet their Parts and Interstices to be too small to 5630cause Reflexions in their common Surfaces. 5631 5632 5633PROP. V. 5634 5635_The transparent parts of Bodies, according to their several sizes, 5636reflect Rays of one Colour, and transmit those of another, on the same 5637grounds that thin Plates or Bubbles do reflect or transmit those Rays. 5638And this I take to be the ground of all their Colours._ 5639 5640For if a thinn'd or plated Body, which being of an even thickness, 5641appears all over of one uniform Colour, should be slit into Threads, or 5642broken into Fragments, of the same thickness with the Plate; I see no 5643reason why every Thread or Fragment should not keep its Colour, and by 5644consequence why a heap of those Threads or Fragments should not 5645constitute a Mass or Powder of the same Colour, which the Plate 5646exhibited before it was broken. And the parts of all natural Bodies 5647being like so many Fragments of a Plate, must on the same grounds 5648exhibit the same Colours. 5649 5650Now, that they do so will appear by the affinity of their Properties. 5651The finely colour'd Feathers of some Birds, and particularly those of 5652Peacocks Tails, do, in the very same part of the Feather, appear of 5653several Colours in several Positions of the Eye, after the very same 5654manner that thin Plates were found to do in the 7th and 19th 5655Observations, and therefore their Colours arise from the thinness of the 5656transparent parts of the Feathers; that is, from the slenderness of the 5657very fine Hairs, or _Capillamenta_, which grow out of the sides of the 5658grosser lateral Branches or Fibres of those Feathers. And to the same 5659purpose it is, that the Webs of some Spiders, by being spun very fine, 5660have appeared colour'd, as some have observ'd, and that the colour'd 5661Fibres of some Silks, by varying the Position of the Eye, do vary their 5662Colour. Also the Colours of Silks, Cloths, and other Substances, which 5663Water or Oil can intimately penetrate, become more faint and obscure by 5664being immerged in those Liquors, and recover their Vigor again by being 5665dried; much after the manner declared of thin Bodies in the 10th and 566621st Observations. Leaf-Gold, some sorts of painted Glass, the Infusion 5667of _Lignum Nephriticum_, and some other Substances, reflect one Colour, 5668and transmit another; like thin Bodies in the 9th and 20th Observations. 5669And some of those colour'd Powders which Painters use, may have their 5670Colours a little changed, by being very elaborately and finely ground. 5671Where I see not what can be justly pretended for those changes, besides 5672the breaking of their parts into less parts by that contrition, after 5673the same manner that the Colour of a thin Plate is changed by varying 5674its thickness. For which reason also it is that the colour'd Flowers of 5675Plants and Vegetables, by being bruised, usually become more transparent 5676than before, or at least in some degree or other change their Colours. 5677Nor is it much less to my purpose, that, by mixing divers Liquors, very 5678odd and remarkable Productions and Changes of Colours may be effected, 5679of which no cause can be more obvious and rational than that the saline 5680Corpuscles of one Liquor do variously act upon or unite with the tinging 5681Corpuscles of another, so as to make them swell, or shrink, (whereby not 5682only their bulk but their density also may be changed,) or to divide 5683them into smaller Corpuscles, (whereby a colour'd Liquor may become 5684transparent,) or to make many of them associate into one cluster, 5685whereby two transparent Liquors may compose a colour'd one. For we see 5686how apt those saline Menstruums are to penetrate and dissolve Substances 5687to which they are applied, and some of them to precipitate what others 5688dissolve. In like manner, if we consider the various Phænomena of the 5689Atmosphere, we may observe, that when Vapours are first raised, they 5690hinder not the transparency of the Air, being divided into parts too 5691small to cause any Reflexion in their Superficies. But when in order to 5692compose drops of Rain they begin to coalesce and constitute Globules of 5693all intermediate sizes, those Globules, when they become of convenient 5694size to reflect some Colours and transmit others, may constitute Clouds 5695of various Colours according to their sizes. And I see not what can be 5696rationally conceived in so transparent a Substance as Water for the 5697production of these Colours, besides the various sizes of its fluid and 5698globular Parcels. 5699 5700 5701PROP. VI. 5702 5703_The parts of Bodies on which their Colours depend, are denser than the 5704Medium which pervades their Interstices._ 5705 5706This will appear by considering, that the Colour of a Body depends not 5707only on the Rays which are incident perpendicularly on its parts, but on 5708those also which are incident at all other Angles. And that according to 5709the 7th Observation, a very little variation of obliquity will change 5710the reflected Colour, where the thin Body or small Particles is rarer 5711than the ambient Medium, insomuch that such a small Particle will at 5712diversly oblique Incidences reflect all sorts of Colours, in so great a 5713variety that the Colour resulting from them all, confusedly reflected 5714from a heap of such Particles, must rather be a white or grey than any 5715other Colour, or at best it must be but a very imperfect and dirty 5716Colour. Whereas if the thin Body or small Particle be much denser than 5717the ambient Medium, the Colours, according to the 19th Observation, are 5718so little changed by the variation of obliquity, that the Rays which 5719are reflected least obliquely may predominate over the rest, so much as 5720to cause a heap of such Particles to appear very intensely of their 5721Colour. 5722 5723It conduces also something to the confirmation of this Proposition, 5724that, according to the 22d Observation, the Colours exhibited by the 5725denser thin Body within the rarer, are more brisk than those exhibited 5726by the rarer within the denser. 5727 5728 5729PROP. VII. 5730 5731_The bigness of the component parts of natural Bodies may be conjectured 5732by their Colours._ 5733 5734For since the parts of these Bodies, by _Prop._ 5. do most probably 5735exhibit the same Colours with a Plate of equal thickness, provided they 5736have the same refractive density; and since their parts seem for the 5737most part to have much the same density with Water or Glass, as by many 5738circumstances is obvious to collect; to determine the sizes of those 5739parts, you need only have recourse to the precedent Tables, in which the 5740thickness of Water or Glass exhibiting any Colour is expressed. Thus if 5741it be desired to know the diameter of a Corpuscle, which being of equal 5742density with Glass shall reflect green of the third Order; the Number 574316-1/4 shews it to be (16-1/4)/10000 parts of an Inch. 5744 5745The greatest difficulty is here to know of what Order the Colour of any 5746Body is. And for this end we must have recourse to the 4th and 18th 5747Observations; from whence may be collected these particulars. 5748 5749_Scarlets_, and other _reds_, _oranges_, and _yellows_, if they be pure 5750and intense, are most probably of the second order. Those of the first 5751and third order also may be pretty good; only the yellow of the first 5752order is faint, and the orange and red of the third Order have a great 5753Mixture of violet and blue. 5754 5755There may be good _Greens_ of the fourth Order, but the purest are of 5756the third. And of this Order the green of all Vegetables seems to be, 5757partly by reason of the Intenseness of their Colours, and partly because 5758when they wither some of them turn to a greenish yellow, and others to a 5759more perfect yellow or orange, or perhaps to red, passing first through 5760all the aforesaid intermediate Colours. Which Changes seem to be 5761effected by the exhaling of the Moisture which may leave the tinging 5762Corpuscles more dense, and something augmented by the Accretion of the 5763oily and earthy Part of that Moisture. Now the green, without doubt, is 5764of the same Order with those Colours into which it changeth, because the 5765Changes are gradual, and those Colours, though usually not very full, 5766yet are often too full and lively to be of the fourth Order. 5767 5768_Blues_ and _Purples_ may be either of the second or third Order, but 5769the best are of the third. Thus the Colour of Violets seems to be of 5770that Order, because their Syrup by acid Liquors turns red, and by 5771urinous and alcalizate turns green. For since it is of the Nature of 5772Acids to dissolve or attenuate, and of Alcalies to precipitate or 5773incrassate, if the Purple Colour of the Syrup was of the second Order, 5774an acid Liquor by attenuating its tinging Corpuscles would change it to 5775a red of the first Order, and an Alcali by incrassating them would 5776change it to a green of the second Order; which red and green, 5777especially the green, seem too imperfect to be the Colours produced by 5778these Changes. But if the said Purple be supposed of the third Order, 5779its Change to red of the second, and green of the third, may without any 5780Inconvenience be allow'd. 5781 5782If there be found any Body of a deeper and less reddish Purple than that 5783of the Violets, its Colour most probably is of the second Order. But yet 5784there being no Body commonly known whose Colour is constantly more deep 5785than theirs, I have made use of their Name to denote the deepest and 5786least reddish Purples, such as manifestly transcend their Colour in 5787purity. 5788 5789The _blue_ of the first Order, though very faint and little, may 5790possibly be the Colour of some Substances; and particularly the azure 5791Colour of the Skies seems to be of this Order. For all Vapours when they 5792begin to condense and coalesce into small Parcels, become first of that 5793Bigness, whereby such an Azure must be reflected before they can 5794constitute Clouds of other Colours. And so this being the first Colour 5795which Vapours begin to reflect, it ought to be the Colour of the finest 5796and most transparent Skies, in which Vapours are not arrived to that 5797Grossness requisite to reflect other Colours, as we find it is by 5798Experience. 5799 5800_Whiteness_, if most intense and luminous, is that of the first Order, 5801if less strong and luminous, a Mixture of the Colours of several Orders. 5802Of this last kind is the Whiteness of Froth, Paper, Linnen, and most 5803white Substances; of the former I reckon that of white Metals to be. For 5804whilst the densest of Metals, Gold, if foliated, is transparent, and all 5805Metals become transparent if dissolved in Menstruums or vitrified, the 5806Opacity of white Metals ariseth not from their Density alone. They being 5807less dense than Gold would be more transparent than it, did not some 5808other Cause concur with their Density to make them opake. And this Cause 5809I take to be such a Bigness of their Particles as fits them to reflect 5810the white of the first order. For, if they be of other Thicknesses they 5811may reflect other Colours, as is manifest by the Colours which appear 5812upon hot Steel in tempering it, and sometimes upon the Surface of melted 5813Metals in the Skin or Scoria which arises upon them in their cooling. 5814And as the white of the first order is the strongest which can be made 5815by Plates of transparent Substances, so it ought to be stronger in the 5816denser Substances of Metals than in the rarer of Air, Water, and Glass. 5817Nor do I see but that metallick Substances of such a Thickness as may 5818fit them to reflect the white of the first order, may, by reason of 5819their great Density (according to the Tenor of the first of these 5820Propositions) reflect all the Light incident upon them, and so be as 5821opake and splendent as it's possible for any Body to be. Gold, or Copper 5822mix'd with less than half their Weight of Silver, or Tin, or Regulus of 5823Antimony, in fusion, or amalgamed with a very little Mercury, become 5824white; which shews both that the Particles of white Metals have much 5825more Superficies, and so are smaller, than those of Gold and Copper, and 5826also that they are so opake as not to suffer the Particles of Gold or 5827Copper to shine through them. Now it is scarce to be doubted but that 5828the Colours of Gold and Copper are of the second and third order, and 5829therefore the Particles of white Metals cannot be much bigger than is 5830requisite to make them reflect the white of the first order. The 5831Volatility of Mercury argues that they are not much bigger, nor may they 5832be much less, lest they lose their Opacity, and become either 5833transparent as they do when attenuated by Vitrification, or by Solution 5834in Menstruums, or black as they do when ground smaller, by rubbing 5835Silver, or Tin, or Lead, upon other Substances to draw black Lines. The 5836first and only Colour which white Metals take by grinding their 5837Particles smaller, is black, and therefore their white ought to be that 5838which borders upon the black Spot in the Center of the Rings of Colours, 5839that is, the white of the first order. But, if you would hence gather 5840the Bigness of metallick Particles, you must allow for their Density. 5841For were Mercury transparent, its Density is such that the Sine of 5842Incidence upon it (by my Computation) would be to the Sine of its 5843Refraction, as 71 to 20, or 7 to 2. And therefore the Thickness of its 5844Particles, that they may exhibit the same Colours with those of Bubbles 5845of Water, ought to be less than the Thickness of the Skin of those 5846Bubbles in the Proportion of 2 to 7. Whence it's possible, that the 5847Particles of Mercury may be as little as the Particles of some 5848transparent and volatile Fluids, and yet reflect the white of the first 5849order. 5850 5851Lastly, for the production of _black_, the Corpuscles must be less than 5852any of those which exhibit Colours. For at all greater sizes there is 5853too much Light reflected to constitute this Colour. But if they be 5854supposed a little less than is requisite to reflect the white and very 5855faint blue of the first order, they will, according to the 4th, 8th, 585617th and 18th Observations, reflect so very little Light as to appear 5857intensely black, and yet may perhaps variously refract it to and fro 5858within themselves so long, until it happen to be stifled and lost, by 5859which means they will appear black in all positions of the Eye without 5860any transparency. And from hence may be understood why Fire, and the 5861more subtile dissolver Putrefaction, by dividing the Particles of 5862Substances, turn them to black, why small quantities of black Substances 5863impart their Colour very freely and intensely to other Substances to 5864which they are applied; the minute Particles of these, by reason of 5865their very great number, easily overspreading the gross Particles of 5866others; why Glass ground very elaborately with Sand on a Copper Plate, 5867'till it be well polish'd, makes the Sand, together with what is worn 5868off from the Glass and Copper, become very black: why black Substances 5869do soonest of all others become hot in the Sun's Light and burn, (which 5870Effect may proceed partly from the multitude of Refractions in a little 5871room, and partly from the easy Commotion of so very small Corpuscles;) 5872and why blacks are usually a little inclined to a bluish Colour. For 5873that they are so may be seen by illuminating white Paper by Light 5874reflected from black Substances. For the Paper will usually appear of a 5875bluish white; and the reason is, that black borders in the obscure blue 5876of the order described in the 18th Observation, and therefore reflects 5877more Rays of that Colour than of any other. 5878 5879In these Descriptions I have been the more particular, because it is not 5880impossible but that Microscopes may at length be improved to the 5881discovery of the Particles of Bodies on which their Colours depend, if 5882they are not already in some measure arrived to that degree of 5883perfection. For if those Instruments are or can be so far improved as 5884with sufficient distinctness to represent Objects five or six hundred 5885times bigger than at a Foot distance they appear to our naked Eyes, I 5886should hope that we might be able to discover some of the greatest of 5887those Corpuscles. And by one that would magnify three or four thousand 5888times perhaps they might all be discover'd, but those which produce 5889blackness. In the mean while I see nothing material in this Discourse 5890that may rationally be doubted of, excepting this Position: That 5891transparent Corpuscles of the same thickness and density with a Plate, 5892do exhibit the same Colour. And this I would have understood not without 5893some Latitude, as well because those Corpuscles may be of irregular 5894Figures, and many Rays must be obliquely incident on them, and so have 5895a shorter way through them than the length of their Diameters, as 5896because the straitness of the Medium put in on all sides within such 5897Corpuscles may a little alter its Motions or other qualities on which 5898the Reflexion depends. But yet I cannot much suspect the last, because I 5899have observed of some small Plates of Muscovy Glass which were of an 5900even thickness, that through a Microscope they have appeared of the same 5901Colour at their edges and corners where the included Medium was 5902terminated, which they appeared of in other places. However it will add 5903much to our Satisfaction, if those Corpuscles can be discover'd with 5904Microscopes; which if we shall at length attain to, I fear it will be 5905the utmost improvement of this Sense. For it seems impossible to see the 5906more secret and noble Works of Nature within the Corpuscles by reason of 5907their transparency. 5908 5909 5910PROP. VIII. 5911 5912_The Cause of Reflexion is not the impinging of Light on the solid or 5913impervious parts of Bodies, as is commonly believed._ 5914 5915This will appear by the following Considerations. First, That in the 5916passage of Light out of Glass into Air there is a Reflexion as strong as 5917in its passage out of Air into Glass, or rather a little stronger, and 5918by many degrees stronger than in its passage out of Glass into Water. 5919And it seems not probable that Air should have more strongly reflecting 5920parts than Water or Glass. But if that should possibly be supposed, yet 5921it will avail nothing; for the Reflexion is as strong or stronger when 5922the Air is drawn away from the Glass, (suppose by the Air-Pump invented 5923by _Otto Gueriet_, and improved and made useful by Mr. _Boyle_) as when 5924it is adjacent to it. Secondly, If Light in its passage out of Glass 5925into Air be incident more obliquely than at an Angle of 40 or 41 Degrees 5926it is wholly reflected, if less obliquely it is in great measure 5927transmitted. Now it is not to be imagined that Light at one degree of 5928obliquity should meet with Pores enough in the Air to transmit the 5929greater part of it, and at another degree of obliquity should meet with 5930nothing but parts to reflect it wholly, especially considering that in 5931its passage out of Air into Glass, how oblique soever be its Incidence, 5932it finds Pores enough in the Glass to transmit a great part of it. If 5933any Man suppose that it is not reflected by the Air, but by the outmost 5934superficial parts of the Glass, there is still the same difficulty: 5935Besides, that such a Supposition is unintelligible, and will also appear 5936to be false by applying Water behind some part of the Glass instead of 5937Air. For so in a convenient obliquity of the Rays, suppose of 45 or 46 5938Degrees, at which they are all reflected where the Air is adjacent to 5939the Glass, they shall be in great measure transmitted where the Water is 5940adjacent to it; which argues, that their Reflexion or Transmission 5941depends on the constitution of the Air and Water behind the Glass, and 5942not on the striking of the Rays upon the parts of the Glass. Thirdly, 5943If the Colours made by a Prism placed at the entrance of a Beam of Light 5944into a darken'd Room be successively cast on a second Prism placed at a 5945greater distance from the former, in such manner that they are all alike 5946incident upon it, the second Prism may be so inclined to the incident 5947Rays, that those which are of a blue Colour shall be all reflected by 5948it, and yet those of a red Colour pretty copiously transmitted. Now if 5949the Reflexion be caused by the parts of Air or Glass, I would ask, why 5950at the same Obliquity of Incidence the blue should wholly impinge on 5951those parts, so as to be all reflected, and yet the red find Pores 5952enough to be in a great measure transmitted. Fourthly, Where two Glasses 5953touch one another, there is no sensible Reflexion, as was declared in 5954the first Observation; and yet I see no reason why the Rays should not 5955impinge on the parts of Glass, as much when contiguous to other Glass as 5956when contiguous to Air. Fifthly, When the top of a Water-Bubble (in the 595717th Observation,) by the continual subsiding and exhaling of the Water 5958grew very thin, there was such a little and almost insensible quantity 5959of Light reflected from it, that it appeared intensely black; whereas 5960round about that black Spot, where the Water was thicker, the Reflexion 5961was so strong as to make the Water seem very white. Nor is it only at 5962the least thickness of thin Plates or Bubbles, that there is no manifest 5963Reflexion, but at many other thicknesses continually greater and 5964greater. For in the 15th Observation the Rays of the same Colour were by 5965turns transmitted at one thickness, and reflected at another thickness, 5966for an indeterminate number of Successions. And yet in the Superficies 5967of the thinned Body, where it is of any one thickness, there are as many 5968parts for the Rays to impinge on, as where it is of any other thickness. 5969Sixthly, If Reflexion were caused by the parts of reflecting Bodies, it 5970would be impossible for thin Plates or Bubbles, at one and the same 5971place, to reflect the Rays of one Colour, and transmit those of another, 5972as they do according to the 13th and 15th Observations. For it is not to 5973be imagined that at one place the Rays which, for instance, exhibit a 5974blue Colour, should have the fortune to dash upon the parts, and those 5975which exhibit a red to hit upon the Pores of the Body; and then at 5976another place, where the Body is either a little thicker or a little 5977thinner, that on the contrary the blue should hit upon its pores, and 5978the red upon its parts. Lastly, Were the Rays of Light reflected by 5979impinging on the solid parts of Bodies, their Reflexions from polish'd 5980Bodies could not be so regular as they are. For in polishing Glass with 5981Sand, Putty, or Tripoly, it is not to be imagined that those Substances 5982can, by grating and fretting the Glass, bring all its least Particles to 5983an accurate Polish; so that all their Surfaces shall be truly plain or 5984truly spherical, and look all the same way, so as together to compose 5985one even Surface. The smaller the Particles of those Substances are, the 5986smaller will be the Scratches by which they continually fret and wear 5987away the Glass until it be polish'd; but be they never so small they can 5988wear away the Glass no otherwise than by grating and scratching it, and 5989breaking the Protuberances; and therefore polish it no otherwise than by 5990bringing its roughness to a very fine Grain, so that the Scratches and 5991Frettings of the Surface become too small to be visible. And therefore 5992if Light were reflected by impinging upon the solid parts of the Glass, 5993it would be scatter'd as much by the most polish'd Glass as by the 5994roughest. So then it remains a Problem, how Glass polish'd by fretting 5995Substances can reflect Light so regularly as it does. And this Problem 5996is scarce otherwise to be solved, than by saying, that the Reflexion of 5997a Ray is effected, not by a single point of the reflecting Body, but by 5998some power of the Body which is evenly diffused all over its Surface, 5999and by which it acts upon the Ray without immediate Contact. For that 6000the parts of Bodies do act upon Light at a distance shall be shewn 6001hereafter. 6002 6003Now if Light be reflected, not by impinging on the solid parts of 6004Bodies, but by some other principle; it's probable that as many of its 6005Rays as impinge on the solid parts of Bodies are not reflected but 6006stifled and lost in the Bodies. For otherwise we must allow two sorts of 6007Reflexions. Should all the Rays be reflected which impinge on the 6008internal parts of clear Water or Crystal, those Substances would rather 6009have a cloudy Colour than a clear Transparency. To make Bodies look 6010black, it's necessary that many Rays be stopp'd, retained, and lost in 6011them; and it seems not probable that any Rays can be stopp'd and 6012stifled in them which do not impinge on their parts. 6013 6014And hence we may understand that Bodies are much more rare and porous 6015than is commonly believed. Water is nineteen times lighter, and by 6016consequence nineteen times rarer than Gold; and Gold is so rare as very 6017readily and without the least opposition to transmit the magnetick 6018Effluvia, and easily to admit Quicksilver into its Pores, and to let 6019Water pass through it. For a concave Sphere of Gold filled with Water, 6020and solder'd up, has, upon pressing the Sphere with great force, let the 6021Water squeeze through it, and stand all over its outside in multitudes 6022of small Drops, like Dew, without bursting or cracking the Body of the 6023Gold, as I have been inform'd by an Eye witness. From all which we may 6024conclude, that Gold has more Pores than solid parts, and by consequence 6025that Water has above forty times more Pores than Parts. And he that 6026shall find out an Hypothesis, by which Water may be so rare, and yet not 6027be capable of compression by force, may doubtless by the same Hypothesis 6028make Gold, and Water, and all other Bodies, as much rarer as he pleases; 6029so that Light may find a ready passage through transparent Substances. 6030 6031The Magnet acts upon Iron through all dense Bodies not magnetick nor red 6032hot, without any diminution of its Virtue; as for instance, through 6033Gold, Silver, Lead, Glass, Water. The gravitating Power of the Sun is 6034transmitted through the vast Bodies of the Planets without any 6035diminution, so as to act upon all their parts to their very centers 6036with the same Force and according to the same Laws, as if the part upon 6037which it acts were not surrounded with the Body of the Planet, The Rays 6038of Light, whether they be very small Bodies projected, or only Motion or 6039Force propagated, are moved in right Lines; and whenever a Ray of Light 6040is by any Obstacle turned out of its rectilinear way, it will never 6041return into the same rectilinear way, unless perhaps by very great 6042accident. And yet Light is transmitted through pellucid solid Bodies in 6043right Lines to very great distances. How Bodies can have a sufficient 6044quantity of Pores for producing these Effects is very difficult to 6045conceive, but perhaps not altogether impossible. For the Colours of 6046Bodies arise from the Magnitudes of the Particles which reflect them, as 6047was explained above. Now if we conceive these Particles of Bodies to be 6048so disposed amongst themselves, that the Intervals or empty Spaces 6049between them may be equal in magnitude to them all; and that these 6050Particles may be composed of other Particles much smaller, which have as 6051much empty Space between them as equals all the Magnitudes of these 6052smaller Particles: And that in like manner these smaller Particles are 6053again composed of others much smaller, all which together are equal to 6054all the Pores or empty Spaces between them; and so on perpetually till 6055you come to solid Particles, such as have no Pores or empty Spaces 6056within them: And if in any gross Body there be, for instance, three such 6057degrees of Particles, the least of which are solid; this Body will have 6058seven times more Pores than solid Parts. But if there be four such 6059degrees of Particles, the least of which are solid, the Body will have 6060fifteen times more Pores than solid Parts. If there be five degrees, the 6061Body will have one and thirty times more Pores than solid Parts. If six 6062degrees, the Body will have sixty and three times more Pores than solid 6063Parts. And so on perpetually. And there are other ways of conceiving how 6064Bodies may be exceeding porous. But what is really their inward Frame is 6065not yet known to us. 6066 6067 6068PROP. IX. 6069 6070_Bodies reflect and refract Light by one and the same power, variously 6071exercised in various Circumstances._ 6072 6073This appears by several Considerations. First, Because when Light goes 6074out of Glass into Air, as obliquely as it can possibly do. If its 6075Incidence be made still more oblique, it becomes totally reflected. For 6076the power of the Glass after it has refracted the Light as obliquely as 6077is possible, if the Incidence be still made more oblique, becomes too 6078strong to let any of its Rays go through, and by consequence causes 6079total Reflexions. Secondly, Because Light is alternately reflected and 6080transmitted by thin Plates of Glass for many Successions, accordingly as 6081the thickness of the Plate increases in an arithmetical Progression. For 6082here the thickness of the Glass determines whether that Power by which 6083Glass acts upon Light shall cause it to be reflected, or suffer it to 6084be transmitted. And, Thirdly, because those Surfaces of transparent 6085Bodies which have the greatest refracting power, reflect the greatest 6086quantity of Light, as was shewn in the first Proposition. 6087 6088 6089PROP. X. 6090 6091_If Light be swifter in Bodies than in Vacuo, in the proportion of the 6092Sines which measure the Refraction of the Bodies, the Forces of the 6093Bodies to reflect and refract Light, are very nearly proportional to the 6094densities of the same Bodies; excepting that unctuous and sulphureous 6095Bodies refract more than others of this same density._ 6096 6097[Illustration: FIG. 8.] 6098 6099Let AB represent the refracting plane Surface of any Body, and IC a Ray 6100incident very obliquely upon the Body in C, so that the Angle ACI may be 6101infinitely little, and let CR be the refracted Ray. From a given Point B 6102perpendicular to the refracting Surface erect BR meeting with the 6103refracting Ray CR in R, and if CR represent the Motion of the refracted 6104Ray, and this Motion be distinguish'd into two Motions CB and BR, 6105whereof CB is parallel to the refracting Plane, and BR perpendicular to 6106it: CB shall represent the Motion of the incident Ray, and BR the 6107Motion generated by the Refraction, as Opticians have of late explain'd. 6108 6109Now if any Body or Thing, in moving through any Space of a given breadth 6110terminated on both sides by two parallel Planes, be urged forward in all 6111parts of that Space by Forces tending directly forwards towards the last 6112Plane, and before its Incidence on the first Plane, had no Motion 6113towards it, or but an infinitely little one; and if the Forces in all 6114parts of that Space, between the Planes, be at equal distances from the 6115Planes equal to one another, but at several distances be bigger or less 6116in any given Proportion, the Motion generated by the Forces in the whole 6117passage of the Body or thing through that Space shall be in a 6118subduplicate Proportion of the Forces, as Mathematicians will easily 6119understand. And therefore, if the Space of activity of the refracting 6120Superficies of the Body be consider'd as such a Space, the Motion of the 6121Ray generated by the refracting Force of the Body, during its passage 6122through that Space, that is, the Motion BR, must be in subduplicate 6123Proportion of that refracting Force. I say therefore, that the Square of 6124the Line BR, and by consequence the refracting Force of the Body, is 6125very nearly as the density of the same Body. For this will appear by the 6126following Table, wherein the Proportion of the Sines which measure the 6127Refractions of several Bodies, the Square of BR, supposing CB an unite, 6128the Densities of the Bodies estimated by their Specifick Gravities, and 6129their Refractive Power in respect of their Densities are set down in 6130several Columns. 6131 6132---------------------+----------------+----------------+----------+----------- 6133 | | | | 6134 | | The Square | The | The 6135 | | of BR, to | density | refractive 6136 | The Proportion | which the | and | Power of 6137 | of the Sines of| refracting | specifick| the Body 6138 | Incidence and | force of the | gravity | in respect 6139 The refracting | Refraction of | Body is | of the | of its 6140 Bodies. | yellow Light. | proportionate. | Body. | density. 6141---------------------+----------------+----------------+----------+----------- 6142A Pseudo-Topazius, | | | | 6143 being a natural, | | | | 6144 pellucid, brittle, | 23 to 14 | 1'699 | 4'27 | 3979 6145 hairy Stone, of a | | | | 6146 yellow Colour. | | | | 6147Air. | 3201 to 3200 | 0'000625 | 0'0012 | 5208 6148Glass of Antimony. | 17 to 9 | 2'568 | 5'28 | 4864 6149A Selenitis. | 61 to 41 | 1'213 | 2'252 | 5386 6150Glass vulgar. | 31 to 20 | 1'4025 | 2'58 | 5436 6151Crystal of the Rock. | 25 to 16 | 1'445 | 2'65 | 5450 6152Island Crystal. | 5 to 3 | 1'778 | 2'72 | 6536 6153Sal Gemmæ. | 17 to 11 | 1'388 | 2'143 | 6477 6154Alume. | 35 to 24 | 1'1267 | 1'714 | 6570 6155Borax. | 22 to 15 | 1'1511 | 1'714 | 6716 6156Niter. | 32 to 21 | 1'345 | 1'9 | 7079 6157Dantzick Vitriol. | 303 to 200 | 1'295 | 1'715 | 7551 6158Oil of Vitriol. | 10 to 7 | 1'041 | 1'7 | 6124 6159Rain Water. | 529 to 396 | 0'7845 | 1' | 7845 6160Gum Arabick. | 31 to 21 | 1'179 | 1'375 | 8574 6161Spirit of Wine well | | | | 6162 rectified. | 100 to 73 | 0'8765 | 0'866 | 10121 6163Camphire. | 3 to 2 | 1'25 | 0'996 | 12551 6164Oil Olive. | 22 to 15 | 1'1511 | 0'913 | 12607 6165Linseed Oil. | 40 to 27 | 1'1948 | 0'932 | 12819 6166Spirit of Turpentine.| 25 to 17 | 1'1626 | 0'874 | 13222 6167Amber. | 14 to 9 | 1'42 | 1'04 | 13654 6168A Diamond. | 100 to 41 | 4'949 | 3'4 | 14556 6169---------------------+----------------+----------------+----------+----------- 6170 6171The Refraction of the Air in this Table is determin'd by that of the 6172Atmosphere observed by Astronomers. For, if Light pass through many 6173refracting Substances or Mediums gradually denser and denser, and 6174terminated with parallel Surfaces, the Sum of all the Refractions will 6175be equal to the single Refraction which it would have suffer'd in 6176passing immediately out of the first Medium into the last. And this 6177holds true, though the Number of the refracting Substances be increased 6178to Infinity, and the Distances from one another as much decreased, so 6179that the Light may be refracted in every Point of its Passage, and by 6180continual Refractions bent into a Curve-Line. And therefore the whole 6181Refraction of Light in passing through the Atmosphere from the highest 6182and rarest Part thereof down to the lowest and densest Part, must be 6183equal to the Refraction which it would suffer in passing at like 6184Obliquity out of a Vacuum immediately into Air of equal Density with 6185that in the lowest Part of the Atmosphere. 6186 6187Now, although a Pseudo-Topaz, a Selenitis, Rock Crystal, Island Crystal, 6188Vulgar Glass (that is, Sand melted together) and Glass of Antimony, 6189which are terrestrial stony alcalizate Concretes, and Air which probably 6190arises from such Substances by Fermentation, be Substances very 6191differing from one another in Density, yet by this Table, they have 6192their refractive Powers almost in the same Proportion to one another as 6193their Densities are, excepting that the Refraction of that strange 6194Substance, Island Crystal is a little bigger than the rest. And 6195particularly Air, which is 3500 Times rarer than the Pseudo-Topaz, and 61964400 Times rarer than Glass of Antimony, and 2000 Times rarer than the 6197Selenitis, Glass vulgar, or Crystal of the Rock, has notwithstanding its 6198rarity the same refractive Power in respect of its Density which those 6199very dense Substances have in respect of theirs, excepting so far as 6200those differ from one another. 6201 6202Again, the Refraction of Camphire, Oil Olive, Linseed Oil, Spirit of 6203Turpentine and Amber, which are fat sulphureous unctuous Bodies, and a 6204Diamond, which probably is an unctuous Substance coagulated, have their 6205refractive Powers in Proportion to one another as their Densities 6206without any considerable Variation. But the refractive Powers of these 6207unctuous Substances are two or three Times greater in respect of their 6208Densities than the refractive Powers of the former Substances in respect 6209of theirs. 6210 6211Water has a refractive Power in a middle degree between those two sorts 6212of Substances, and probably is of a middle nature. For out of it grow 6213all vegetable and animal Substances, which consist as well of 6214sulphureous fat and inflamable Parts, as of earthy lean and alcalizate 6215ones. 6216 6217Salts and Vitriols have refractive Powers in a middle degree between 6218those of earthy Substances and Water, and accordingly are composed of 6219those two sorts of Substances. For by distillation and rectification of 6220their Spirits a great Part of them goes into Water, and a great Part 6221remains behind in the form of a dry fix'd Earth capable of 6222Vitrification. 6223 6224Spirit of Wine has a refractive Power in a middle degree between those 6225of Water and oily Substances, and accordingly seems to be composed of 6226both, united by Fermentation; the Water, by means of some saline Spirits 6227with which 'tis impregnated, dissolving the Oil, and volatizing it by 6228the Action. For Spirit of Wine is inflamable by means of its oily Parts, 6229and being distilled often from Salt of Tartar, grow by every 6230distillation more and more aqueous and phlegmatick. And Chymists 6231observe, that Vegetables (as Lavender, Rue, Marjoram, &c.) distilled 6232_per se_, before fermentation yield Oils without any burning Spirits, 6233but after fermentation yield ardent Spirits without Oils: Which shews, 6234that their Oil is by fermentation converted into Spirit. They find also, 6235that if Oils be poured in a small quantity upon fermentating Vegetables, 6236they distil over after fermentation in the form of Spirits. 6237 6238So then, by the foregoing Table, all Bodies seem to have their 6239refractive Powers proportional to their Densities, (or very nearly;) 6240excepting so far as they partake more or less of sulphureous oily 6241Particles, and thereby have their refractive Power made greater or less. 6242Whence it seems rational to attribute the refractive Power of all Bodies 6243chiefly, if not wholly, to the sulphureous Parts with which they abound. 6244For it's probable that all Bodies abound more or less with Sulphurs. And 6245as Light congregated by a Burning-glass acts most upon sulphureous 6246Bodies, to turn them into Fire and Flame; so, since all Action is 6247mutual, Sulphurs ought to act most upon Light. For that the action 6248between Light and Bodies is mutual, may appear from this Consideration; 6249That the densest Bodies which refract and reflect Light most strongly, 6250grow hottest in the Summer Sun, by the action of the refracted or 6251reflected Light. 6252 6253I have hitherto explain'd the power of Bodies to reflect and refract, 6254and shew'd, that thin transparent Plates, Fibres, and Particles, do, 6255according to their several thicknesses and densities, reflect several 6256sorts of Rays, and thereby appear of several Colours; and by consequence 6257that nothing more is requisite for producing all the Colours of natural 6258Bodies, than the several sizes and densities of their transparent 6259Particles. But whence it is that these Plates, Fibres, and Particles, 6260do, according to their several thicknesses and densities, reflect 6261several sorts of Rays, I have not yet explain'd. To give some insight 6262into this matter, and make way for understanding the next part of this 6263Book, I shall conclude this part with a few more Propositions. Those 6264which preceded respect the nature of Bodies, these the nature of Light: 6265For both must be understood, before the reason of their Actions upon one 6266another can be known. And because the last Proposition depended upon the 6267velocity of Light, I will begin with a Proposition of that kind. 6268 6269 6270PROP. XI. 6271 6272_Light is propagated from luminous Bodies in time, and spends about 6273seven or eight Minutes of an Hour in passing from the Sun to the Earth._ 6274 6275This was observed first by _Roemer_, and then by others, by means of the 6276Eclipses of the Satellites of _Jupiter_. For these Eclipses, when the 6277Earth is between the Sun and _Jupiter_, happen about seven or eight 6278Minutes sooner than they ought to do by the Tables, and when the Earth 6279is beyond the Sun they happen about seven or eight Minutes later than 6280they ought to do; the reason being, that the Light of the Satellites has 6281farther to go in the latter case than in the former by the Diameter of 6282the Earth's Orbit. Some inequalities of time may arise from the 6283Excentricities of the Orbs of the Satellites; but those cannot answer in 6284all the Satellites, and at all times to the Position and Distance of the 6285Earth from the Sun. The mean motions of _Jupiter_'s Satellites is also 6286swifter in his descent from his Aphelium to his Perihelium, than in his 6287ascent in the other half of his Orb. But this inequality has no respect 6288to the position of the Earth, and in the three interior Satellites is 6289insensible, as I find by computation from the Theory of their Gravity. 6290 6291 6292PROP. XII. 6293 6294_Every Ray of Light in its passage through any refracting Surface is put 6295into a certain transient Constitution or State, which in the progress of 6296the Ray returns at equal Intervals, and disposes the Ray at every return 6297to be easily transmitted through the next refracting Surface, and 6298between the returns to be easily reflected by it._ 6299 6300This is manifest by the 5th, 9th, 12th, and 15th Observations. For by 6301those Observations it appears, that one and the same sort of Rays at 6302equal Angles of Incidence on any thin transparent Plate, is alternately 6303reflected and transmitted for many Successions accordingly as the 6304thickness of the Plate increases in arithmetical Progression of the 6305Numbers, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, &c. so that if the first Reflexion 6306(that which makes the first or innermost of the Rings of Colours there 6307described) be made at the thickness 1, the Rays shall be transmitted at 6308the thicknesses 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, &c. and thereby make the central 6309Spot and Rings of Light, which appear by transmission, and be reflected 6310at the thickness 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, 11, &c. and thereby make the Rings which 6311appear by Reflexion. And this alternate Reflexion and Transmission, as I 6312gather by the 24th Observation, continues for above an hundred 6313vicissitudes, and by the Observations in the next part of this Book, for 6314many thousands, being propagated from one Surface of a Glass Plate to 6315the other, though the thickness of the Plate be a quarter of an Inch or 6316above: So that this alternation seems to be propagated from every 6317refracting Surface to all distances without end or limitation. 6318 6319This alternate Reflexion and Refraction depends on both the Surfaces of 6320every thin Plate, because it depends on their distance. By the 21st 6321Observation, if either Surface of a thin Plate of _Muscovy_ Glass be 6322wetted, the Colours caused by the alternate Reflexion and Refraction 6323grow faint, and therefore it depends on them both. 6324 6325It is therefore perform'd at the second Surface; for if it were 6326perform'd at the first, before the Rays arrive at the second, it would 6327not depend on the second. 6328 6329It is also influenced by some action or disposition, propagated from the 6330first to the second, because otherwise at the second it would not depend 6331on the first. And this action or disposition, in its propagation, 6332intermits and returns by equal Intervals, because in all its progress it 6333inclines the Ray at one distance from the first Surface to be reflected 6334by the second, at another to be transmitted by it, and that by equal 6335Intervals for innumerable vicissitudes. And because the Ray is disposed 6336to Reflexion at the distances 1, 3, 5, 7, 9, &c. and to Transmission at 6337the distances 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, &c. (for its transmission through the 6338first Surface, is at the distance 0, and it is transmitted through both 6339together, if their distance be infinitely little or much less than 1) 6340the disposition to be transmitted at the distances 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, &c. 6341is to be accounted a return of the same disposition which the Ray first 6342had at the distance 0, that is at its transmission through the first 6343refracting Surface. All which is the thing I would prove. 6344 6345What kind of action or disposition this is; Whether it consists in a 6346circulating or a vibrating motion of the Ray, or of the Medium, or 6347something else, I do not here enquire. Those that are averse from 6348assenting to any new Discoveries, but such as they can explain by an 6349Hypothesis, may for the present suppose, that as Stones by falling upon 6350Water put the Water into an undulating Motion, and all Bodies by 6351percussion excite vibrations in the Air; so the Rays of Light, by 6352impinging on any refracting or reflecting Surface, excite vibrations in 6353the refracting or reflecting Medium or Substance, and by exciting them 6354agitate the solid parts of the refracting or reflecting Body, and by 6355agitating them cause the Body to grow warm or hot; that the vibrations 6356thus excited are propagated in the refracting or reflecting Medium or 6357Substance, much after the manner that vibrations are propagated in the 6358Air for causing Sound, and move faster than the Rays so as to overtake 6359them; and that when any Ray is in that part of the vibration which 6360conspires with its Motion, it easily breaks through a refracting 6361Surface, but when it is in the contrary part of the vibration which 6362impedes its Motion, it is easily reflected; and, by consequence, that 6363every Ray is successively disposed to be easily reflected, or easily 6364transmitted, by every vibration which overtakes it. But whether this 6365Hypothesis be true or false I do not here consider. I content my self 6366with the bare Discovery, that the Rays of Light are by some cause or 6367other alternately disposed to be reflected or refracted for many 6368vicissitudes. 6369 6370 6371DEFINITION. 6372 6373_The returns of the disposition of any Ray to be reflected I will call 6374its_ Fits of easy Reflexion, _and those of its disposition to be 6375transmitted its_ Fits of easy Transmission, _and the space it passes 6376between every return and the next return, the_ Interval of its Fits. 6377 6378 6379PROP. XIII. 6380 6381_The reason why the Surfaces of all thick transparent Bodies reflect 6382part of the Light incident on them, and refract the rest, is, that some 6383Rays at their Incidence are in Fits of easy Reflexion, and others in 6384Fits of easy Transmission._ 6385 6386This may be gather'd from the 24th Observation, where the Light 6387reflected by thin Plates of Air and Glass, which to the naked Eye 6388appear'd evenly white all over the Plate, did through a Prism appear 6389waved with many Successions of Light and Darkness made by alternate Fits 6390of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission, the Prism severing and 6391distinguishing the Waves of which the white reflected Light was 6392composed, as was explain'd above. 6393 6394And hence Light is in Fits of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission, 6395before its Incidence on transparent Bodies. And probably it is put into 6396such fits at its first emission from luminous Bodies, and continues in 6397them during all its progress. For these Fits are of a lasting nature, as 6398will appear by the next part of this Book. 6399 6400In this Proposition I suppose the transparent Bodies to be thick; 6401because if the thickness of the Body be much less than the Interval of 6402the Fits of easy Reflexion and Transmission of the Rays, the Body loseth 6403its reflecting power. For if the Rays, which at their entering into the 6404Body are put into Fits of easy Transmission, arrive at the farthest 6405Surface of the Body before they be out of those Fits, they must be 6406transmitted. And this is the reason why Bubbles of Water lose their 6407reflecting power when they grow very thin; and why all opake Bodies, 6408when reduced into very small parts, become transparent. 6409 6410 6411PROP. XIV. 6412 6413_Those Surfaces of transparent Bodies, which if the Ray be in a Fit of 6414Refraction do refract it most strongly, if the Ray be in a Fit of 6415Reflexion do reflect it most easily._ 6416 6417For we shewed above, in _Prop._ 8. that the cause of Reflexion is not 6418the impinging of Light on the solid impervious parts of Bodies, but some 6419other power by which those solid parts act on Light at a distance. We 6420shewed also in _Prop._ 9. that Bodies reflect and refract Light by one 6421and the same power, variously exercised in various circumstances; and in 6422_Prop._ 1. that the most strongly refracting Surfaces reflect the most 6423Light: All which compared together evince and rarify both this and the 6424last Proposition. 6425 6426 6427PROP. XV. 6428 6429_In any one and the same sort of Rays, emerging in any Angle out of any 6430refracting Surface into one and the same Medium, the Interval of the 6431following Fits of easy Reflexion and Transmission are either accurately 6432or very nearly, as the Rectangle of the Secant of the Angle of 6433Refraction, and of the Secant of another Angle, whose Sine is the first 6434of 106 arithmetical mean Proportionals, between the Sines of Incidence 6435and Refraction, counted from the Sine of Refraction._ 6436 6437This is manifest by the 7th and 19th Observations. 6438 6439 6440PROP. XVI. 6441 6442_In several sorts of Rays emerging in equal Angles out of any refracting 6443Surface into the same Medium, the Intervals of the following Fits of 6444easy Reflexion and easy Transmission are either accurately, or very 6445nearly, as the Cube-Roots of the Squares of the lengths of a Chord, 6446which found the Notes in an Eight_, sol, la, fa, sol, la, mi, fa, sol, 6447_with all their intermediate degrees answering to the Colours of those 6448Rays, according to the Analogy described in the seventh Experiment of 6449the second Part of the first Book._ 6450 6451This is manifest by the 13th and 14th Observations. 6452 6453 6454PROP. XVII. 6455 6456_If Rays of any sort pass perpendicularly into several Mediums, the 6457Intervals of the Fits of easy Reflexion and Transmission in any one 6458Medium, are to those Intervals in any other, as the Sine of Incidence to 6459the Sine of Refraction, when the Rays pass out of the first of those two 6460Mediums into the second._ 6461 6462This is manifest by the 10th Observation. 6463 6464 6465PROP. XVIII. 6466 6467_If the Rays which paint the Colour in the Confine of yellow and orange 6468pass perpendicularly out of any Medium into Air, the Intervals of their 6469Fits of easy Reflexion are the 1/89000th part of an Inch. And of the 6470same length are the Intervals of their Fits of easy Transmission._ 6471 6472This is manifest by the 6th Observation. From these Propositions it is 6473easy to collect the Intervals of the Fits of easy Reflexion and easy 6474Transmission of any sort of Rays refracted in any angle into any Medium; 6475and thence to know, whether the Rays shall be reflected or transmitted 6476at their subsequent Incidence upon any other pellucid Medium. Which 6477thing, being useful for understanding the next part of this Book, was 6478here to be set down. And for the same reason I add the two following 6479Propositions. 6480 6481 6482PROP. XIX. 6483 6484_If any sort of Rays falling on the polite Surface of any pellucid 6485Medium be reflected back, the Fits of easy Reflexion, which they have at 6486the point of Reflexion, shall still continue to return; and the Returns 6487shall be at distances from the point of Reflexion in the arithmetical 6488progression of the Numbers 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, &c. and between these 6489Fits the Rays shall be in Fits of easy Transmission._ 6490 6491For since the Fits of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission are of a 6492returning nature, there is no reason why these Fits, which continued 6493till the Ray arrived at the reflecting Medium, and there inclined the 6494Ray to Reflexion, should there cease. And if the Ray at the point of 6495Reflexion was in a Fit of easy Reflexion, the progression of the 6496distances of these Fits from that point must begin from 0, and so be of 6497the Numbers 0, 2, 4, 6, 8, &c. And therefore the progression of the 6498distances of the intermediate Fits of easy Transmission, reckon'd from 6499the same point, must be in the progression of the odd Numbers 1, 3, 5, 65007, 9, &c. contrary to what happens when the Fits are propagated from 6501points of Refraction. 6502 6503 6504PROP. XX. 6505 6506_The Intervals of the Fits of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission, 6507propagated from points of Reflexion into any Medium, are equal to the 6508Intervals of the like Fits, which the same Rays would have, if refracted 6509into the same Medium in Angles of Refraction equal to their Angles of 6510Reflexion._ 6511 6512For when Light is reflected by the second Surface of thin Plates, it 6513goes out afterwards freely at the first Surface to make the Rings of 6514Colours which appear by Reflexion; and, by the freedom of its egress, 6515makes the Colours of these Rings more vivid and strong than those which 6516appear on the other side of the Plates by the transmitted Light. The 6517reflected Rays are therefore in Fits of easy Transmission at their 6518egress; which would not always happen, if the Intervals of the Fits 6519within the Plate after Reflexion were not equal, both in length and 6520number, to their Intervals before it. And this confirms also the 6521proportions set down in the former Proposition. For if the Rays both in 6522going in and out at the first Surface be in Fits of easy Transmission, 6523and the Intervals and Numbers of those Fits between the first and second 6524Surface, before and after Reflexion, be equal, the distances of the Fits 6525of easy Transmission from either Surface, must be in the same 6526progression after Reflexion as before; that is, from the first Surface 6527which transmitted them in the progression of the even Numbers 0, 2, 4, 65286, 8, &c. and from the second which reflected them, in that of the odd 6529Numbers 1, 3, 5, 7, &c. But these two Propositions will become much more 6530evident by the Observations in the following part of this Book. 6531 6532 6533 6534 6535THE 6536 6537SECOND BOOK 6538 6539OF 6540 6541OPTICKS 6542 6543 6544_PART IV._ 6545 6546_Observations concerning the Reflexions and Colours of thick transparent 6547polish'd Plates._ 6548 6549There is no Glass or Speculum how well soever polished, but, besides the 6550Light which it refracts or reflects regularly, scatters every way 6551irregularly a faint Light, by means of which the polish'd Surface, when 6552illuminated in a dark room by a beam of the Sun's Light, may be easily 6553seen in all positions of the Eye. There are certain Phænomena of this 6554scatter'd Light, which when I first observed them, seem'd very strange 6555and surprizing to me. My Observations were as follows. 6556 6557_Obs._ 1. The Sun shining into my darken'd Chamber through a hole one 6558third of an Inch wide, I let the intromitted beam of Light fall 6559perpendicularly upon a Glass Speculum ground concave on one side and 6560convex on the other, to a Sphere of five Feet and eleven Inches Radius, 6561and Quick-silver'd over on the convex side. And holding a white opake 6562Chart, or a Quire of Paper at the center of the Spheres to which the 6563Speculum was ground, that is, at the distance of about five Feet and 6564eleven Inches from the Speculum, in such manner, that the beam of Light 6565might pass through a little hole made in the middle of the Chart to the 6566Speculum, and thence be reflected back to the same hole: I observed upon 6567the Chart four or five concentric Irises or Rings of Colours, like 6568Rain-bows, encompassing the hole much after the manner that those, which 6569in the fourth and following Observations of the first part of this Book 6570appear'd between the Object-glasses, encompassed the black Spot, but yet 6571larger and fainter than those. These Rings as they grew larger and 6572larger became diluter and fainter, so that the fifth was scarce visible. 6573Yet sometimes, when the Sun shone very clear, there appear'd faint 6574Lineaments of a sixth and seventh. If the distance of the Chart from the 6575Speculum was much greater or much less than that of six Feet, the Rings 6576became dilute and vanish'd. And if the distance of the Speculum from the 6577Window was much greater than that of six Feet, the reflected beam of 6578Light would be so broad at the distance of six Feet from the Speculum 6579where the Rings appear'd, as to obscure one or two of the innermost 6580Rings. And therefore I usually placed the Speculum at about six Feet 6581from the Window; so that its Focus might there fall in with the center 6582of its concavity at the Rings upon the Chart. And this Posture is always 6583to be understood in the following Observations where no other is 6584express'd. 6585 6586_Obs._ 2. The Colours of these Rain-bows succeeded one another from the 6587center outwards, in the same form and order with those which were made 6588in the ninth Observation of the first Part of this Book by Light not 6589reflected, but transmitted through the two Object-glasses. For, first, 6590there was in their common center a white round Spot of faint Light, 6591something broader than the reflected beam of Light, which beam sometimes 6592fell upon the middle of the Spot, and sometimes by a little inclination 6593of the Speculum receded from the middle, and left the Spot white to the 6594center. 6595 6596This white Spot was immediately encompassed with a dark grey or russet, 6597and that dark grey with the Colours of the first Iris; which Colours on 6598the inside next the dark grey were a little violet and indigo, and next 6599to that a blue, which on the outside grew pale, and then succeeded a 6600little greenish yellow, and after that a brighter yellow, and then on 6601the outward edge of the Iris a red which on the outside inclined to 6602purple. 6603 6604This Iris was immediately encompassed with a second, whose Colours were 6605in order from the inside outwards, purple, blue, green, yellow, light 6606red, a red mix'd with purple. 6607 6608Then immediately follow'd the Colours of the third Iris, which were in 6609order outwards a green inclining to purple, a good green, and a red more 6610bright than that of the former Iris. 6611 6612The fourth and fifth Iris seem'd of a bluish green within, and red 6613without, but so faintly that it was difficult to discern the Colours. 6614 6615_Obs._ 3. Measuring the Diameters of these Rings upon the Chart as 6616accurately as I could, I found them also in the same proportion to one 6617another with the Rings made by Light transmitted through the two 6618Object-glasses. For the Diameters of the four first of the bright Rings 6619measured between the brightest parts of their Orbits, at the distance of 6620six Feet from the Speculum were 1-11/16, 2-3/8, 2-11/12, 3-3/8 Inches, 6621whose Squares are in arithmetical progression of the numbers 1, 2, 3, 4. 6622If the white circular Spot in the middle be reckon'd amongst the Rings, 6623and its central Light, where it seems to be most luminous, be put 6624equipollent to an infinitely little Ring; the Squares of the Diameters 6625of the Rings will be in the progression 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, &c. I measured 6626also the Diameters of the dark Circles between these luminous ones, and 6627found their Squares in the progression of the numbers 1/2, 1-1/2, 2-1/2, 66283-1/2, &c. the Diameters of the first four at the distance of six Feet 6629from the Speculum, being 1-3/16, 2-1/16, 2-2/3, 3-3/20 Inches. If the 6630distance of the Chart from the Speculum was increased or diminished, the 6631Diameters of the Circles were increased or diminished proportionally. 6632 6633_Obs._ 4. By the analogy between these Rings and those described in the 6634Observations of the first Part of this Book, I suspected that there 6635were many more of them which spread into one another, and by interfering 6636mix'd their Colours, and diluted one another so that they could not be 6637seen apart. I viewed them therefore through a Prism, as I did those in 6638the 24th Observation of the first Part of this Book. And when the Prism 6639was so placed as by refracting the Light of their mix'd Colours to 6640separate them, and distinguish the Rings from one another, as it did 6641those in that Observation, I could then see them distincter than before, 6642and easily number eight or nine of them, and sometimes twelve or 6643thirteen. And had not their Light been so very faint, I question not but 6644that I might have seen many more. 6645 6646_Obs._ 5. Placing a Prism at the Window to refract the intromitted beam 6647of Light, and cast the oblong Spectrum of Colours on the Speculum: I 6648covered the Speculum with a black Paper which had in the middle of it a 6649hole to let any one of the Colours pass through to the Speculum, whilst 6650the rest were intercepted by the Paper. And now I found Rings of that 6651Colour only which fell upon the Speculum. If the Speculum was 6652illuminated with red, the Rings were totally red with dark Intervals, if 6653with blue they were totally blue, and so of the other Colours. And when 6654they were illuminated with any one Colour, the Squares of their 6655Diameters measured between their most luminous Parts, were in the 6656arithmetical Progression of the Numbers, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 and the Squares 6657of the Diameters of their dark Intervals in the Progression of the 6658intermediate Numbers 1/2, 1-1/2, 2-1/2, 3-1/2. But if the Colour was 6659varied, they varied their Magnitude. In the red they were largest, in 6660the indigo and violet least, and in the intermediate Colours yellow, 6661green, and blue, they were of several intermediate Bignesses answering 6662to the Colour, that is, greater in yellow than in green, and greater in 6663green than in blue. And hence I knew, that when the Speculum was 6664illuminated with white Light, the red and yellow on the outside of the 6665Rings were produced by the least refrangible Rays, and the blue and 6666violet by the most refrangible, and that the Colours of each Ring spread 6667into the Colours of the neighbouring Rings on either side, after the 6668manner explain'd in the first and second Part of this Book, and by 6669mixing diluted one another so that they could not be distinguish'd, 6670unless near the Center where they were least mix'd. For in this 6671Observation I could see the Rings more distinctly, and to a greater 6672Number than before, being able in the yellow Light to number eight or 6673nine of them, besides a faint shadow of a tenth. To satisfy my self how 6674much the Colours of the several Rings spread into one another, I 6675measured the Diameters of the second and third Rings, and found them 6676when made by the Confine of the red and orange to be to the same 6677Diameters when made by the Confine of blue and indigo, as 9 to 8, or 6678thereabouts. For it was hard to determine this Proportion accurately. 6679Also the Circles made successively by the red, yellow, and green, 6680differ'd more from one another than those made successively by the 6681green, blue, and indigo. For the Circle made by the violet was too dark 6682to be seen. To carry on the Computation, let us therefore suppose that 6683the Differences of the Diameters of the Circles made by the outmost red, 6684the Confine of red and orange, the Confine of orange and yellow, the 6685Confine of yellow and green, the Confine of green and blue, the Confine 6686of blue and indigo, the Confine of indigo and violet, and outmost 6687violet, are in proportion as the Differences of the Lengths of a 6688Monochord which sound the Tones in an Eight; _sol_, _la_, _fa_, _sol_, 6689_la_, _mi_, _fa_, _sol_, that is, as the Numbers 1/9, 1/18, 1/12, 1/12, 66902/27, 1/27, 1/18. And if the Diameter of the Circle made by the Confine 6691of red and orange be 9A, and that of the Circle made by the Confine of 6692blue and indigo be 8A as above; their difference 9A-8A will be to the 6693difference of the Diameters of the Circles made by the outmost red, and 6694by the Confine of red and orange, as 1/18 + 1/12 + 1/12 + 2/27 to 1/9, 6695that is as 8/27 to 1/9, or 8 to 3, and to the difference of the Circles 6696made by the outmost violet, and by the Confine of blue and indigo, as 66971/18 + 1/12 + 1/12 + 2/27 to 1/27 + 1/18, that is, as 8/27 to 5/54, or 6698as 16 to 5. And therefore these differences will be 3/8A and 5/16A. Add 6699the first to 9A and subduct the last from 8A, and you will have the 6700Diameters of the Circles made by the least and most refrangible Rays 670175/8A and ((61-1/2)/8)A. These diameters are therefore to one another as 670275 to 61-1/2 or 50 to 41, and their Squares as 2500 to 1681, that is, as 67033 to 2 very nearly. Which proportion differs not much from the 6704proportion of the Diameters of the Circles made by the outmost red and 6705outmost violet, in the 13th Observation of the first part of this Book. 6706 6707_Obs._ 6. Placing my Eye where these Rings appear'd plainest, I saw the 6708Speculum tinged all over with Waves of Colours, (red, yellow, green, 6709blue;) like those which in the Observations of the first part of this 6710Book appeared between the Object-glasses, and upon Bubbles of Water, but 6711much larger. And after the manner of those, they were of various 6712magnitudes in various Positions of the Eye, swelling and shrinking as I 6713moved my Eye this way and that way. They were formed like Arcs of 6714concentrick Circles, as those were; and when my Eye was over against the 6715center of the concavity of the Speculum, (that is, 5 Feet and 10 Inches 6716distant from the Speculum,) their common center was in a right Line with 6717that center of concavity, and with the hole in the Window. But in other 6718postures of my Eye their center had other positions. They appear'd by 6719the Light of the Clouds propagated to the Speculum through the hole in 6720the Window; and when the Sun shone through that hole upon the Speculum, 6721his Light upon it was of the Colour of the Ring whereon it fell, but by 6722its splendor obscured the Rings made by the Light of the Clouds, unless 6723when the Speculum was removed to a great distance from the Window, so 6724that his Light upon it might be broad and faint. By varying the position 6725of my Eye, and moving it nearer to or farther from the direct beam of 6726the Sun's Light, the Colour of the Sun's reflected Light constantly 6727varied upon the Speculum, as it did upon my Eye, the same Colour always 6728appearing to a Bystander upon my Eye which to me appear'd upon the 6729Speculum. And thence I knew that the Rings of Colours upon the Chart 6730were made by these reflected Colours, propagated thither from the 6731Speculum in several Angles, and that their production depended not upon 6732the termination of Light and Shadow. 6733 6734_Obs._ 7. By the Analogy of all these Phænomena with those of the like 6735Rings of Colours described in the first part of this Book, it seemed to 6736me that these Colours were produced by this thick Plate of Glass, much 6737after the manner that those were produced by very thin Plates. For, upon 6738trial, I found that if the Quick-silver were rubb'd off from the 6739backside of the Speculum, the Glass alone would cause the same Rings of 6740Colours, but much more faint than before; and therefore the Phænomenon 6741depends not upon the Quick-silver, unless so far as the Quick-silver by 6742increasing the Reflexion of the backside of the Glass increases the 6743Light of the Rings of Colours. I found also that a Speculum of Metal 6744without Glass made some Years since for optical uses, and very well 6745wrought, produced none of those Rings; and thence I understood that 6746these Rings arise not from one specular Surface alone, but depend upon 6747the two Surfaces of the Plate of Glass whereof the Speculum was made, 6748and upon the thickness of the Glass between them. For as in the 7th and 674919th Observations of the first part of this Book a thin Plate of Air, 6750Water, or Glass of an even thickness appeared of one Colour when the 6751Rays were perpendicular to it, of another when they were a little 6752oblique, of another when more oblique, of another when still more 6753oblique, and so on; so here, in the sixth Observation, the Light which 6754emerged out of the Glass in several Obliquities, made the Glass appear 6755of several Colours, and being propagated in those Obliquities to the 6756Chart, there painted Rings of those Colours. And as the reason why a 6757thin Plate appeared of several Colours in several Obliquities of the 6758Rays, was, that the Rays of one and the same sort are reflected by the 6759thin Plate at one obliquity and transmitted at another, and those of 6760other sorts transmitted where these are reflected, and reflected where 6761these are transmitted: So the reason why the thick Plate of Glass 6762whereof the Speculum was made did appear of various Colours in various 6763Obliquities, and in those Obliquities propagated those Colours to the 6764Chart, was, that the Rays of one and the same sort did at one Obliquity 6765emerge out of the Glass, at another did not emerge, but were reflected 6766back towards the Quick-silver by the hither Surface of the Glass, and 6767accordingly as the Obliquity became greater and greater, emerged and 6768were reflected alternately for many Successions; and that in one and the 6769same Obliquity the Rays of one sort were reflected, and those of another 6770transmitted. This is manifest by the fifth Observation of this part of 6771this Book. For in that Observation, when the Speculum was illuminated by 6772any one of the prismatick Colours, that Light made many Rings of the 6773same Colour upon the Chart with dark Intervals, and therefore at its 6774emergence out of the Speculum was alternately transmitted and not 6775transmitted from the Speculum to the Chart for many Successions, 6776according to the various Obliquities of its Emergence. And when the 6777Colour cast on the Speculum by the Prism was varied, the Rings became of 6778the Colour cast on it, and varied their bigness with their Colour, and 6779therefore the Light was now alternately transmitted and not transmitted 6780from the Speculum to the Chart at other Obliquities than before. It 6781seemed to me therefore that these Rings were of one and the same 6782original with those of thin Plates, but yet with this difference, that 6783those of thin Plates are made by the alternate Reflexions and 6784Transmissions of the Rays at the second Surface of the Plate, after one 6785passage through it; but here the Rays go twice through the Plate before 6786they are alternately reflected and transmitted. First, they go through 6787it from the first Surface to the Quick-silver, and then return through 6788it from the Quick-silver to the first Surface, and there are either 6789transmitted to the Chart or reflected back to the Quick-silver, 6790accordingly as they are in their Fits of easy Reflexion or Transmission 6791when they arrive at that Surface. For the Intervals of the Fits of the 6792Rays which fall perpendicularly on the Speculum, and are reflected back 6793in the same perpendicular Lines, by reason of the equality of these 6794Angles and Lines, are of the same length and number within the Glass 6795after Reflexion as before, by the 19th Proposition of the third part of 6796this Book. And therefore since all the Rays that enter through the 6797first Surface are in their Fits of easy Transmission at their entrance, 6798and as many of these as are reflected by the second are in their Fits of 6799easy Reflexion there, all these must be again in their Fits of easy 6800Transmission at their return to the first, and by consequence there go 6801out of the Glass to the Chart, and form upon it the white Spot of Light 6802in the center of the Rings. For the reason holds good in all sorts of 6803Rays, and therefore all sorts must go out promiscuously to that Spot, 6804and by their mixture cause it to be white. But the Intervals of the Fits 6805of those Rays which are reflected more obliquely than they enter, must 6806be greater after Reflexion than before, by the 15th and 20th 6807Propositions. And thence it may happen that the Rays at their return to 6808the first Surface, may in certain Obliquities be in Fits of easy 6809Reflexion, and return back to the Quick-silver, and in other 6810intermediate Obliquities be again in Fits of easy Transmission, and so 6811go out to the Chart, and paint on it the Rings of Colours about the 6812white Spot. And because the Intervals of the Fits at equal obliquities 6813are greater and fewer in the less refrangible Rays, and less and more 6814numerous in the more refrangible, therefore the less refrangible at 6815equal obliquities shall make fewer Rings than the more refrangible, and 6816the Rings made by those shall be larger than the like number of Rings 6817made by these; that is, the red Rings shall be larger than the yellow, 6818the yellow than the green, the green than the blue, and the blue than 6819the violet, as they were really found to be in the fifth Observation. 6820And therefore the first Ring of all Colours encompassing the white Spot 6821of Light shall be red without any violet within, and yellow, and green, 6822and blue in the middle, as it was found in the second Observation; and 6823these Colours in the second Ring, and those that follow, shall be more 6824expanded, till they spread into one another, and blend one another by 6825interfering. 6826 6827These seem to be the reasons of these Rings in general; and this put me 6828upon observing the thickness of the Glass, and considering whether the 6829dimensions and proportions of the Rings may be truly derived from it by 6830computation. 6831 6832_Obs._ 8. I measured therefore the thickness of this concavo-convex 6833Plate of Glass, and found it every where 1/4 of an Inch precisely. Now, 6834by the sixth Observation of the first Part of this Book, a thin Plate of 6835Air transmits the brightest Light of the first Ring, that is, the bright 6836yellow, when its thickness is the 1/89000th part of an Inch; and by the 6837tenth Observation of the same Part, a thin Plate of Glass transmits the 6838same Light of the same Ring, when its thickness is less in proportion of 6839the Sine of Refraction to the Sine of Incidence, that is, when its 6840thickness is the 11/1513000th or 1/137545th part of an Inch, supposing 6841the Sines are as 11 to 17. And if this thickness be doubled, it 6842transmits the same bright Light of the second Ring; if tripled, it 6843transmits that of the third, and so on; the bright yellow Light in all 6844these cases being in its Fits of Transmission. And therefore if its 6845thickness be multiplied 34386 times, so as to become 1/4 of an Inch, it 6846transmits the same bright Light of the 34386th Ring. Suppose this be the 6847bright yellow Light transmitted perpendicularly from the reflecting 6848convex side of the Glass through the concave side to the white Spot in 6849the center of the Rings of Colours on the Chart: And by a Rule in the 68507th and 19th Observations in the first Part of this Book, and by the 685115th and 20th Propositions of the third Part of this Book, if the Rays 6852be made oblique to the Glass, the thickness of the Glass requisite to 6853transmit the same bright Light of the same Ring in any obliquity, is to 6854this thickness of 1/4 of an Inch, as the Secant of a certain Angle to 6855the Radius, the Sine of which Angle is the first of an hundred and six 6856arithmetical Means between the Sines of Incidence and Refraction, 6857counted from the Sine of Incidence when the Refraction is made out of 6858any plated Body into any Medium encompassing it; that is, in this case, 6859out of Glass into Air. Now if the thickness of the Glass be increased by 6860degrees, so as to bear to its first thickness, (_viz._ that of a quarter 6861of an Inch,) the Proportions which 34386 (the number of Fits of the 6862perpendicular Rays in going through the Glass towards the white Spot in 6863the center of the Rings,) hath to 34385, 34384, 34383, and 34382, (the 6864numbers of the Fits of the oblique Rays in going through the Glass 6865towards the first, second, third, and fourth Rings of Colours,) and if 6866the first thickness be divided into 100000000 equal parts, the increased 6867thicknesses will be 100002908, 100005816, 100008725, and 100011633, and 6868the Angles of which these thicknesses are Secants will be 26´ 13´´, 37´ 68695´´, 45´ 6´´, and 52´ 26´´, the Radius being 100000000; and the Sines of 6870these Angles are 762, 1079, 1321, and 1525, and the proportional Sines 6871of Refraction 1172, 1659, 2031, and 2345, the Radius being 100000. For 6872since the Sines of Incidence out of Glass into Air are to the Sines of 6873Refraction as 11 to 17, and to the above-mentioned Secants as 11 to the 6874first of 106 arithmetical Means between 11 and 17, that is, as 11 to 687511-6/106, those Secants will be to the Sines of Refraction as 11-6/106, 6876to 17, and by this Analogy will give these Sines. So then, if the 6877obliquities of the Rays to the concave Surface of the Glass be such that 6878the Sines of their Refraction in passing out of the Glass through that 6879Surface into the Air be 1172, 1659, 2031, 2345, the bright Light of the 688034386th Ring shall emerge at the thicknesses of the Glass, which are to 68811/4 of an Inch as 34386 to 34385, 34384, 34383, 34382, respectively. And 6882therefore, if the thickness in all these Cases be 1/4 of an Inch (as it 6883is in the Glass of which the Speculum was made) the bright Light of the 688434385th Ring shall emerge where the Sine of Refraction is 1172, and that 6885of the 34384th, 34383th, and 34382th Ring where the Sine is 1659, 2031, 6886and 2345 respectively. And in these Angles of Refraction the Light of 6887these Rings shall be propagated from the Speculum to the Chart, and 6888there paint Rings about the white central round Spot of Light which we 6889said was the Light of the 34386th Ring. And the Semidiameters of these 6890Rings shall subtend the Angles of Refraction made at the 6891Concave-Surface of the Speculum, and by consequence their Diameters 6892shall be to the distance of the Chart from the Speculum as those Sines 6893of Refraction doubled are to the Radius, that is, as 1172, 1659, 2031, 6894and 2345, doubled are to 100000. And therefore, if the distance of the 6895Chart from the Concave-Surface of the Speculum be six Feet (as it was in 6896the third of these Observations) the Diameters of the Rings of this 6897bright yellow Light upon the Chart shall be 1'688, 2'389, 2'925, 3'375 6898Inches: For these Diameters are to six Feet, as the above-mention'd 6899Sines doubled are to the Radius. Now, these Diameters of the bright 6900yellow Rings, thus found by Computation are the very same with those 6901found in the third of these Observations by measuring them, _viz._ with 69021-11/16, 2-3/8, 2-11/12, and 3-3/8 Inches, and therefore the Theory of 6903deriving these Rings from the thickness of the Plate of Glass of which 6904the Speculum was made, and from the Obliquity of the emerging Rays 6905agrees with the Observation. In this Computation I have equalled the 6906Diameters of the bright Rings made by Light of all Colours, to the 6907Diameters of the Rings made by the bright yellow. For this yellow makes 6908the brightest Part of the Rings of all Colours. If you desire the 6909Diameters of the Rings made by the Light of any other unmix'd Colour, 6910you may find them readily by putting them to the Diameters of the bright 6911yellow ones in a subduplicate Proportion of the Intervals of the Fits of 6912the Rays of those Colours when equally inclined to the refracting or 6913reflecting Surface which caused those Fits, that is, by putting the 6914Diameters of the Rings made by the Rays in the Extremities and Limits of 6915the seven Colours, red, orange, yellow, green, blue, indigo, violet, 6916proportional to the Cube-roots of the Numbers, 1, 8/9, 5/6, 3/4, 2/3, 69173/5, 9/16, 1/2, which express the Lengths of a Monochord sounding the 6918Notes in an Eighth: For by this means the Diameters of the Rings of 6919these Colours will be found pretty nearly in the same Proportion to one 6920another, which they ought to have by the fifth of these Observations. 6921 6922And thus I satisfy'd my self, that these Rings were of the same kind and 6923Original with those of thin Plates, and by consequence that the Fits or 6924alternate Dispositions of the Rays to be reflected and transmitted are 6925propagated to great distances from every reflecting and refracting 6926Surface. But yet to put the matter out of doubt, I added the following 6927Observation. 6928 6929_Obs._ 9. If these Rings thus depend on the thickness of the Plate of 6930Glass, their Diameters at equal distances from several Speculums made of 6931such concavo-convex Plates of Glass as are ground on the same Sphere, 6932ought to be reciprocally in a subduplicate Proportion of the thicknesses 6933of the Plates of Glass. And if this Proportion be found true by 6934experience it will amount to a demonstration that these Rings (like 6935those formed in thin Plates) do depend on the thickness of the Glass. I 6936procured therefore another concavo-convex Plate of Glass ground on both 6937sides to the same Sphere with the former Plate. Its thickness was 5/62 6938Parts of an Inch; and the Diameters of the three first bright Rings 6939measured between the brightest Parts of their Orbits at the distance of 6940six Feet from the Glass were 3·4-1/6·5-1/8· Inches. Now, the thickness 6941of the other Glass being 1/4 of an Inch was to the thickness of this 6942Glass as 1/4 to 5/62, that is as 31 to 10, or 310000000 to 100000000, 6943and the Roots of these Numbers are 17607 and 10000, and in the 6944Proportion of the first of these Roots to the second are the Diameters 6945of the bright Rings made in this Observation by the thinner Glass, 69463·4-1/6·5-1/8, to the Diameters of the same Rings made in the third of 6947these Observations by the thicker Glass 1-11/16, 2-3/8. 2-11/12, that 6948is, the Diameters of the Rings are reciprocally in a subduplicate 6949Proportion of the thicknesses of the Plates of Glass. 6950 6951So then in Plates of Glass which are alike concave on one side, and 6952alike convex on the other side, and alike quick-silver'd on the convex 6953sides, and differ in nothing but their thickness, the Diameters of the 6954Rings are reciprocally in a subduplicate Proportion of the thicknesses 6955of the Plates. And this shews sufficiently that the Rings depend on both 6956the Surfaces of the Glass. They depend on the convex Surface, because 6957they are more luminous when that Surface is quick-silver'd over than 6958when it is without Quick-silver. They depend also upon the concave 6959Surface, because without that Surface a Speculum makes them not. They 6960depend on both Surfaces, and on the distances between them, because 6961their bigness is varied by varying only that distance. And this 6962dependence is of the same kind with that which the Colours of thin 6963Plates have on the distance of the Surfaces of those Plates, because the 6964bigness of the Rings, and their Proportion to one another, and the 6965variation of their bigness arising from the variation of the thickness 6966of the Glass, and the Orders of their Colours, is such as ought to 6967result from the Propositions in the end of the third Part of this Book, 6968derived from the Phænomena of the Colours of thin Plates set down in the 6969first Part. 6970 6971There are yet other Phænomena of these Rings of Colours, but such as 6972follow from the same Propositions, and therefore confirm both the Truth 6973of those Propositions, and the Analogy between these Rings and the Rings 6974of Colours made by very thin Plates. I shall subjoin some of them. 6975 6976_Obs._ 10. When the beam of the Sun's Light was reflected back from the 6977Speculum not directly to the hole in the Window, but to a place a little 6978distant from it, the common center of that Spot, and of all the Rings of 6979Colours fell in the middle way between the beam of the incident Light, 6980and the beam of the reflected Light, and by consequence in the center of 6981the spherical concavity of the Speculum, whenever the Chart on which the 6982Rings of Colours fell was placed at that center. And as the beam of 6983reflected Light by inclining the Speculum receded more and more from the 6984beam of incident Light and from the common center of the colour'd Rings 6985between them, those Rings grew bigger and bigger, and so also did the 6986white round Spot, and new Rings of Colours emerged successively out of 6987their common center, and the white Spot became a white Ring 6988encompassing them; and the incident and reflected beams of Light always 6989fell upon the opposite parts of this white Ring, illuminating its 6990Perimeter like two mock Suns in the opposite parts of an Iris. So then 6991the Diameter of this Ring, measured from the middle of its Light on one 6992side to the middle of its Light on the other side, was always equal to 6993the distance between the middle of the incident beam of Light, and the 6994middle of the reflected beam measured at the Chart on which the Rings 6995appeared: And the Rays which form'd this Ring were reflected by the 6996Speculum in Angles equal to their Angles of Incidence, and by 6997consequence to their Angles of Refraction at their entrance into the 6998Glass, but yet their Angles of Reflexion were not in the same Planes 6999with their Angles of Incidence. 7000 7001_Obs._ 11. The Colours of the new Rings were in a contrary order to 7002those of the former, and arose after this manner. The white round Spot 7003of Light in the middle of the Rings continued white to the center till 7004the distance of the incident and reflected beams at the Chart was about 70057/8 parts of an Inch, and then it began to grow dark in the middle. And 7006when that distance was about 1-3/16 of an Inch, the white Spot was 7007become a Ring encompassing a dark round Spot which in the middle 7008inclined to violet and indigo. And the luminous Rings encompassing it 7009were grown equal to those dark ones which in the four first Observations 7010encompassed them, that is to say, the white Spot was grown a white Ring 7011equal to the first of those dark Rings, and the first of those luminous 7012Rings was now grown equal to the second of those dark ones, and the 7013second of those luminous ones to the third of those dark ones, and so 7014on. For the Diameters of the luminous Rings were now 1-3/16, 2-1/16, 70152-2/3, 3-3/20, &c. Inches. 7016 7017When the distance between the incident and reflected beams of Light 7018became a little bigger, there emerged out of the middle of the dark Spot 7019after the indigo a blue, and then out of that blue a pale green, and 7020soon after a yellow and red. And when the Colour at the center was 7021brightest, being between yellow and red, the bright Rings were grown 7022equal to those Rings which in the four first Observations next 7023encompassed them; that is to say, the white Spot in the middle of those 7024Rings was now become a white Ring equal to the first of those bright 7025Rings, and the first of those bright ones was now become equal to the 7026second of those, and so on. For the Diameters of the white Ring, and of 7027the other luminous Rings encompassing it, were now 1-11/16, 2-3/8, 70282-11/12, 3-3/8, &c. or thereabouts. 7029 7030When the distance of the two beams of Light at the Chart was a little 7031more increased, there emerged out of the middle in order after the red, 7032a purple, a blue, a green, a yellow, and a red inclining much to purple, 7033and when the Colour was brightest being between yellow and red, the 7034former indigo, blue, green, yellow and red, were become an Iris or Ring 7035of Colours equal to the first of those luminous Rings which appeared in 7036the four first Observations, and the white Ring which was now become 7037the second of the luminous Rings was grown equal to the second of those, 7038and the first of those which was now become the third Ring was become 7039equal to the third of those, and so on. For their Diameters were 70401-11/16, 2-3/8, 2-11/12, 3-3/8 Inches, the distance of the two beams of 7041Light, and the Diameter of the white Ring being 2-3/8 Inches. 7042 7043When these two beams became more distant there emerged out of the middle 7044of the purplish red, first a darker round Spot, and then out of the 7045middle of that Spot a brighter. And now the former Colours (purple, 7046blue, green, yellow, and purplish red) were become a Ring equal to the 7047first of the bright Rings mentioned in the four first Observations, and 7048the Rings about this Ring were grown equal to the Rings about that 7049respectively; the distance between the two beams of Light and the 7050Diameter of the white Ring (which was now become the third Ring) being 7051about 3 Inches. 7052 7053The Colours of the Rings in the middle began now to grow very dilute, 7054and if the distance between the two Beams was increased half an Inch, or 7055an Inch more, they vanish'd whilst the white Ring, with one or two of 7056the Rings next it on either side, continued still visible. But if the 7057distance of the two beams of Light was still more increased, these also 7058vanished: For the Light which coming from several parts of the hole in 7059the Window fell upon the Speculum in several Angles of Incidence, made 7060Rings of several bignesses, which diluted and blotted out one another, 7061as I knew by intercepting some part of that Light. For if I intercepted 7062that part which was nearest to the Axis of the Speculum the Rings would 7063be less, if the other part which was remotest from it they would be 7064bigger. 7065 7066_Obs._ 12. When the Colours of the Prism were cast successively on the 7067Speculum, that Ring which in the two last Observations was white, was of 7068the same bigness in all the Colours, but the Rings without it were 7069greater in the green than in the blue, and still greater in the yellow, 7070and greatest in the red. And, on the contrary, the Rings within that 7071white Circle were less in the green than in the blue, and still less in 7072the yellow, and least in the red. For the Angles of Reflexion of those 7073Rays which made this Ring, being equal to their Angles of Incidence, the 7074Fits of every reflected Ray within the Glass after Reflexion are equal 7075in length and number to the Fits of the same Ray within the Glass before 7076its Incidence on the reflecting Surface. And therefore since all the 7077Rays of all sorts at their entrance into the Glass were in a Fit of 7078Transmission, they were also in a Fit of Transmission at their returning 7079to the same Surface after Reflexion; and by consequence were 7080transmitted, and went out to the white Ring on the Chart. This is the 7081reason why that Ring was of the same bigness in all the Colours, and why 7082in a mixture of all it appears white. But in Rays which are reflected in 7083other Angles, the Intervals of the Fits of the least refrangible being 7084greatest, make the Rings of their Colour in their progress from this 7085white Ring, either outwards or inwards, increase or decrease by the 7086greatest steps; so that the Rings of this Colour without are greatest, 7087and within least. And this is the reason why in the last Observation, 7088when the Speculum was illuminated with white Light, the exterior Rings 7089made by all Colours appeared red without and blue within, and the 7090interior blue without and red within. 7091 7092These are the Phænomena of thick convexo-concave Plates of Glass, which 7093are every where of the same thickness. There are yet other Phænomena 7094when these Plates are a little thicker on one side than on the other, 7095and others when the Plates are more or less concave than convex, or 7096plano-convex, or double-convex. For in all these cases the Plates make 7097Rings of Colours, but after various manners; all which, so far as I have 7098yet observed, follow from the Propositions in the end of the third part 7099of this Book, and so conspire to confirm the truth of those 7100Propositions. But the Phænomena are too various, and the Calculations 7101whereby they follow from those Propositions too intricate to be here 7102prosecuted. I content my self with having prosecuted this kind of 7103Phænomena so far as to discover their Cause, and by discovering it to 7104ratify the Propositions in the third Part of this Book. 7105 7106_Obs._ 13. As Light reflected by a Lens quick-silver'd on the backside 7107makes the Rings of Colours above described, so it ought to make the like 7108Rings of Colours in passing through a drop of Water. At the first 7109Reflexion of the Rays within the drop, some Colours ought to be 7110transmitted, as in the case of a Lens, and others to be reflected back 7111to the Eye. For instance, if the Diameter of a small drop or globule of 7112Water be about the 500th part of an Inch, so that a red-making Ray in 7113passing through the middle of this globule has 250 Fits of easy 7114Transmission within the globule, and that all the red-making Rays which 7115are at a certain distance from this middle Ray round about it have 249 7116Fits within the globule, and all the like Rays at a certain farther 7117distance round about it have 248 Fits, and all those at a certain 7118farther distance 247 Fits, and so on; these concentrick Circles of Rays 7119after their transmission, falling on a white Paper, will make 7120concentrick Rings of red upon the Paper, supposing the Light which 7121passes through one single globule, strong enough to be sensible. And, in 7122like manner, the Rays of other Colours will make Rings of other Colours. 7123Suppose now that in a fair Day the Sun shines through a thin Cloud of 7124such globules of Water or Hail, and that the globules are all of the 7125same bigness; and the Sun seen through this Cloud shall appear 7126encompassed with the like concentrick Rings of Colours, and the Diameter 7127of the first Ring of red shall be 7-1/4 Degrees, that of the second 712810-1/4 Degrees, that of the third 12 Degrees 33 Minutes. And accordingly 7129as the Globules of Water are bigger or less, the Rings shall be less or 7130bigger. This is the Theory, and Experience answers it. For in _June_ 71311692, I saw by reflexion in a Vessel of stagnating Water three Halos, 7132Crowns, or Rings of Colours about the Sun, like three little Rain-bows, 7133concentrick to his Body. The Colours of the first or innermost Crown 7134were blue next the Sun, red without, and white in the middle between the 7135blue and red. Those of the second Crown were purple and blue within, and 7136pale red without, and green in the middle. And those of the third were 7137pale blue within, and pale red without; these Crowns enclosed one 7138another immediately, so that their Colours proceeded in this continual 7139order from the Sun outward: blue, white, red; purple, blue, green, pale 7140yellow and red; pale blue, pale red. The Diameter of the second Crown 7141measured from the middle of the yellow and red on one side of the Sun, 7142to the middle of the same Colour on the other side was 9-1/3 Degrees, or 7143thereabouts. The Diameters of the first and third I had not time to 7144measure, but that of the first seemed to be about five or six Degrees, 7145and that of the third about twelve. The like Crowns appear sometimes 7146about the Moon; for in the beginning of the Year 1664, _Febr._ 19th at 7147Night, I saw two such Crowns about her. The Diameter of the first or 7148innermost was about three Degrees, and that of the second about five 7149Degrees and an half. Next about the Moon was a Circle of white, and next 7150about that the inner Crown, which was of a bluish green within next the 7151white, and of a yellow and red without, and next about these Colours 7152were blue and green on the inside of the outward Crown, and red on the 7153outside of it. At the same time there appear'd a Halo about 22 Degrees 715435´ distant from the center of the Moon. It was elliptical, and its long 7155Diameter was perpendicular to the Horizon, verging below farthest from 7156the Moon. I am told that the Moon has sometimes three or more 7157concentrick Crowns of Colours encompassing one another next about her 7158Body. The more equal the globules of Water or Ice are to one another, 7159the more Crowns of Colours will appear, and the Colours will be the more 7160lively. The Halo at the distance of 22-1/2 Degrees from the Moon is of 7161another sort. By its being oval and remoter from the Moon below than 7162above, I conclude, that it was made by Refraction in some sort of Hail 7163or Snow floating in the Air in an horizontal posture, the refracting 7164Angle being about 58 or 60 Degrees. 7165 7166 7167 7168 7169THE 7170 7171THIRD BOOK 7172 7173OF 7174 7175OPTICKS 7176 7177 7178_PART I._ 7179 7180_Observations concerning the Inflexions of the Rays of Light, and the 7181Colours made thereby._ 7182 7183Grimaldo has inform'd us, that if a beam of the Sun's Light be let into 7184a dark Room through a very small hole, the Shadows of things in this 7185Light will be larger than they ought to be if the Rays went on by the 7186Bodies in straight Lines, and that these Shadows have three parallel 7187Fringes, Bands or Ranks of colour'd Light adjacent to them. But if the 7188Hole be enlarged the Fringes grow broad and run into one another, so 7189that they cannot be distinguish'd. These broad Shadows and Fringes have 7190been reckon'd by some to proceed from the ordinary refraction of the 7191Air, but without due examination of the Matter. For the circumstances of 7192the Phænomenon, so far as I have observed them, are as follows. 7193 7194_Obs._ 1. I made in a piece of Lead a small Hole with a Pin, whose 7195breadth was the 42d part of an Inch. For 21 of those Pins laid together 7196took up the breadth of half an Inch. Through this Hole I let into my 7197darken'd Chamber a beam of the Sun's Light, and found that the Shadows 7198of Hairs, Thred, Pins, Straws, and such like slender Substances placed 7199in this beam of Light, were considerably broader than they ought to be, 7200if the Rays of Light passed on by these Bodies in right Lines. And 7201particularly a Hair of a Man's Head, whose breadth was but the 280th 7202part of an Inch, being held in this Light, at the distance of about 7203twelve Feet from the Hole, did cast a Shadow which at the distance of 7204four Inches from the Hair was the sixtieth part of an Inch broad, that 7205is, above four times broader than the Hair, and at the distance of two 7206Feet from the Hair was about the eight and twentieth part of an Inch 7207broad, that is, ten times broader than the Hair, and at the distance of 7208ten Feet was the eighth part of an Inch broad, that is 35 times broader. 7209 7210Nor is it material whether the Hair be encompassed with Air, or with any 7211other pellucid Substance. For I wetted a polish'd Plate of Glass, and 7212laid the Hair in the Water upon the Glass, and then laying another 7213polish'd Plate of Glass upon it, so that the Water might fill up the 7214space between the Glasses, I held them in the aforesaid beam of Light, 7215so that the Light might pass through them perpendicularly, and the 7216Shadow of the Hair was at the same distances as big as before. The 7217Shadows of Scratches made in polish'd Plates of Glass were also much 7218broader than they ought to be, and the Veins in polish'd Plates of Glass 7219did also cast the like broad Shadows. And therefore the great breadth of 7220these Shadows proceeds from some other cause than the Refraction of the 7221Air. 7222 7223Let the Circle X [in _Fig._ 1.] represent the middle of the Hair; ADG, 7224BEH, CFI, three Rays passing by one side of the Hair at several 7225distances; KNQ, LOR, MPS, three other Rays passing by the other side of 7226the Hair at the like distances; D, E, F, and N, O, P, the places where 7227the Rays are bent in their passage by the Hair; G, H, I, and Q, R, S, 7228the places where the Rays fall on a Paper GQ; IS the breadth of the 7229Shadow of the Hair cast on the Paper, and TI, VS, two Rays passing to 7230the Points I and S without bending when the Hair is taken away. And it's 7231manifest that all the Light between these two Rays TI and VS is bent in 7232passing by the Hair, and turned aside from the Shadow IS, because if any 7233part of this Light were not bent it would fall on the Paper within the 7234Shadow, and there illuminate the Paper, contrary to experience. And 7235because when the Paper is at a great distance from the Hair, the Shadow 7236is broad, and therefore the Rays TI and VS are at a great distance from 7237one another, it follows that the Hair acts upon the Rays of Light at a 7238good distance in their passing by it. But the Action is strongest on the 7239Rays which pass by at least distances, and grows weaker and weaker 7240accordingly as the Rays pass by at distances greater and greater, as is 7241represented in the Scheme: For thence it comes to pass, that the Shadow 7242of the Hair is much broader in proportion to the distance of the Paper 7243from the Hair, when the Paper is nearer the Hair, than when it is at a 7244great distance from it. 7245 7246_Obs._ 2. The Shadows of all Bodies (Metals, Stones, Glass, Wood, Horn, 7247Ice, &c.) in this Light were border'd with three Parallel Fringes or 7248Bands of colour'd Light, whereof that which was contiguous to the Shadow 7249was broadest and most luminous, and that which was remotest from it was 7250narrowest, and so faint, as not easily to be visible. It was difficult 7251to distinguish the Colours, unless when the Light fell very obliquely 7252upon a smooth Paper, or some other smooth white Body, so as to make them 7253appear much broader than they would otherwise do. And then the Colours 7254were plainly visible in this Order: The first or innermost Fringe was 7255violet and deep blue next the Shadow, and then light blue, green, and 7256yellow in the middle, and red without. The second Fringe was almost 7257contiguous to the first, and the third to the second, and both were blue 7258within, and yellow and red without, but their Colours were very faint, 7259especially those of the third. The Colours therefore proceeded in this 7260order from the Shadow; violet, indigo, pale blue, green, yellow, red; 7261blue, yellow, red; pale blue, pale yellow and red. The Shadows made by 7262Scratches and Bubbles in polish'd Plates of Glass were border'd with the 7263like Fringes of colour'd Light. And if Plates of Looking-glass sloop'd 7264off near the edges with a Diamond-cut, be held in the same beam of 7265Light, the Light which passes through the parallel Planes of the Glass 7266will be border'd with the like Fringes of Colours where those Planes 7267meet with the Diamond-cut, and by this means there will sometimes appear 7268four or five Fringes of Colours. Let AB, CD [in _Fig._ 2.] represent the 7269parallel Planes of a Looking-glass, and BD the Plane of the Diamond-cut, 7270making at B a very obtuse Angle with the Plane AB. And let all the Light 7271between the Rays ENI and FBM pass directly through the parallel Planes 7272of the Glass, and fall upon the Paper between I and M, and all the Light 7273between the Rays GO and HD be refracted by the oblique Plane of the 7274Diamond-cut BD, and fall upon the Paper between K and L; and the Light 7275which passes directly through the parallel Planes of the Glass, and 7276falls upon the Paper between I and M, will be border'd with three or 7277more Fringes at M. 7278 7279[Illustration: FIG. 1.] 7280 7281[Illustration: FIG. 2.] 7282 7283So by looking on the Sun through a Feather or black Ribband held close 7284to the Eye, several Rain-bows will appear; the Shadows which the Fibres 7285or Threds cast on the _Tunica Retina_, being border'd with the like 7286Fringes of Colours. 7287 7288_Obs._ 3. When the Hair was twelve Feet distant from this Hole, and its 7289Shadow fell obliquely upon a flat white Scale of Inches and Parts of an 7290Inch placed half a Foot beyond it, and also when the Shadow fell 7291perpendicularly upon the same Scale placed nine Feet beyond it; I 7292measured the breadth of the Shadow and Fringes as accurately as I could, 7293and found them in Parts of an Inch as follows. 7294 7295-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7296 | half a | Nine 7297 At the Distance of | Foot | Feet 7298-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7299The breadth of the Shadow | 1/54 | 1/9 7300-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7301The breadth between the Middles of the | 1/38 | 7302 brightest Light of the innermost Fringes | or | 7303 on either side the Shadow | 1/39 | 7/50 7304-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7305The breadth between the Middles of the | | 7306 brightest Light of the middlemost Fringes| | 7307 on either side the Shadow | 1/23-1/2 | 4/17 7308-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7309The breadth between the Middles of the | 1/18 | 7310 brightest Light of the outmost Fringes | or | 7311 on either side the Shadow | 1/18-1/2 | 3/10 7312-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7313The distance between the Middles of the | | 7314 brightest Light of the first and second | | 7315 Fringes | 1/120 | 1/21 7316-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7317The distance between the Middles of the | | 7318 brightest Light of the second and third | | 7319 Fringes | 1/170 | 1/31 7320-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7321The breadth of the luminous Part (green, | | 7322 white, yellow, and red) of the first | | 7323 Fringe | 1/170 | 1/32 7324-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7325The breadth of the darker Space between | | 7326 the first and second Fringes | 1/240 | 1/45 7327-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7328The breadth of the luminous Part of the | | 7329 second Fringe | 1/290 | 1/55 7330-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7331The breadth of the darker Space between | | 7332 the second and third Fringes | 1/340 | 1/63 7333-------------------------------------------+-----------+-------- 7334 7335These Measures I took by letting the Shadow of the Hair, at half a Foot 7336distance, fall so obliquely on the Scale, as to appear twelve times 7337broader than when it fell perpendicularly on it at the same distance, 7338and setting down in this Table the twelfth part of the Measures I then 7339took. 7340 7341_Obs._ 4. When the Shadow and Fringes were cast obliquely upon a smooth 7342white Body, and that Body was removed farther and farther from the Hair, 7343the first Fringe began to appear and look brighter than the rest of the 7344Light at the distance of less than a quarter of an Inch from the Hair, 7345and the dark Line or Shadow between that and the second Fringe began to 7346appear at a less distance from the Hair than that of the third part of 7347an Inch. The second Fringe began to appear at a distance from the Hair 7348of less than half an Inch, and the Shadow between that and the third 7349Fringe at a distance less than an inch, and the third Fringe at a 7350distance less than three Inches. At greater distances they became much 7351more sensible, but kept very nearly the same proportion of their 7352breadths and intervals which they had at their first appearing. For the 7353distance between the middle of the first, and middle of the second 7354Fringe, was to the distance between the middle of the second and middle 7355of the third Fringe, as three to two, or ten to seven. And the last of 7356these two distances was equal to the breadth of the bright Light or 7357luminous part of the first Fringe. And this breadth was to the breadth 7358of the bright Light of the second Fringe as seven to four, and to the 7359dark Interval of the first and second Fringe as three to two, and to 7360the like dark Interval between the second and third as two to one. For 7361the breadths of the Fringes seem'd to be in the progression of the 7362Numbers 1, sqrt(1/3), sqrt(1/5), and their Intervals to be in the 7363same progression with them; that is, the Fringes and their Intervals 7364together to be in the continual progression of the Numbers 1, 7365sqrt(1/2), sqrt(1/3), sqrt(1/4), sqrt(1/5), or thereabouts. And 7366these Proportions held the same very nearly at all distances from the 7367Hair; the dark Intervals of the Fringes being as broad in proportion to 7368the breadth of the Fringes at their first appearance as afterwards at 7369great distances from the Hair, though not so dark and distinct. 7370 7371_Obs._ 5. The Sun shining into my darken'd Chamber through a hole a 7372quarter of an Inch broad, I placed at the distance of two or three Feet 7373from the Hole a Sheet of Pasteboard, which was black'd all over on both 7374sides, and in the middle of it had a hole about three quarters of an 7375Inch square for the Light to pass through. And behind the hole I 7376fasten'd to the Pasteboard with Pitch the blade of a sharp Knife, to 7377intercept some part of the Light which passed through the hole. The 7378Planes of the Pasteboard and blade of the Knife were parallel to one 7379another, and perpendicular to the Rays. And when they were so placed 7380that none of the Sun's Light fell on the Pasteboard, but all of it 7381passed through the hole to the Knife, and there part of it fell upon the 7382blade of the Knife, and part of it passed by its edge; I let this part 7383of the Light which passed by, fall on a white Paper two or three Feet 7384beyond the Knife, and there saw two streams of faint Light shoot out 7385both ways from the beam of Light into the shadow, like the Tails of 7386Comets. But because the Sun's direct Light by its brightness upon the 7387Paper obscured these faint streams, so that I could scarce see them, I 7388made a little hole in the midst of the Paper for that Light to pass 7389through and fall on a black Cloth behind it; and then I saw the two 7390streams plainly. They were like one another, and pretty nearly equal in 7391length, and breadth, and quantity of Light. Their Light at that end next 7392the Sun's direct Light was pretty strong for the space of about a 7393quarter of an Inch, or half an Inch, and in all its progress from that 7394direct Light decreased gradually till it became insensible. The whole 7395length of either of these streams measured upon the paper at the 7396distance of three Feet from the Knife was about six or eight Inches; so 7397that it subtended an Angle at the edge of the Knife of about 10 or 12, 7398or at most 14 Degrees. Yet sometimes I thought I saw it shoot three or 7399four Degrees farther, but with a Light so very faint that I could scarce 7400perceive it, and suspected it might (in some measure at least) arise 7401from some other cause than the two streams did. For placing my Eye in 7402that Light beyond the end of that stream which was behind the Knife, and 7403looking towards the Knife, I could see a line of Light upon its edge, 7404and that not only when my Eye was in the line of the Streams, but also 7405when it was without that line either towards the point of the Knife, or 7406towards the handle. This line of Light appear'd contiguous to the edge 7407of the Knife, and was narrower than the Light of the innermost Fringe, 7408and narrowest when my Eye was farthest from the direct Light, and 7409therefore seem'd to pass between the Light of that Fringe and the edge 7410of the Knife, and that which passed nearest the edge to be most bent, 7411though not all of it. 7412 7413_Obs._ 6. I placed another Knife by this, so that their edges might be 7414parallel, and look towards one another, and that the beam of Light might 7415fall upon both the Knives, and some part of it pass between their edges. 7416And when the distance of their edges was about the 400th part of an 7417Inch, the stream parted in the middle, and left a Shadow between the two 7418parts. This Shadow was so black and dark that all the Light which passed 7419between the Knives seem'd to be bent, and turn'd aside to the one hand 7420or to the other. And as the Knives still approach'd one another the 7421Shadow grew broader, and the streams shorter at their inward ends which 7422were next the Shadow, until upon the contact of the Knives the whole 7423Light vanish'd, leaving its place to the Shadow. 7424 7425And hence I gather that the Light which is least bent, and goes to the 7426inward ends of the streams, passes by the edges of the Knives at the 7427greatest distance, and this distance when the Shadow begins to appear 7428between the streams, is about the 800th part of an Inch. And the Light 7429which passes by the edges of the Knives at distances still less and 7430less, is more and more bent, and goes to those parts of the streams 7431which are farther and farther from the direct Light; because when the 7432Knives approach one another till they touch, those parts of the streams 7433vanish last which are farthest from the direct Light. 7434 7435_Obs._ 7. In the fifth Observation the Fringes did not appear, but by 7436reason of the breadth of the hole in the Window became so broad as to 7437run into one another, and by joining, to make one continued Light in the 7438beginning of the streams. But in the sixth, as the Knives approached one 7439another, a little before the Shadow appeared between the two streams, 7440the Fringes began to appear on the inner ends of the Streams on either 7441side of the direct Light; three on one side made by the edge of one 7442Knife, and three on the other side made by the edge of the other Knife. 7443They were distinctest when the Knives were placed at the greatest 7444distance from the hole in the Window, and still became more distinct by 7445making the hole less, insomuch that I could sometimes see a faint 7446lineament of a fourth Fringe beyond the three above mention'd. And as 7447the Knives continually approach'd one another, the Fringes grew 7448distincter and larger, until they vanish'd. The outmost Fringe vanish'd 7449first, and the middlemost next, and the innermost last. And after they 7450were all vanish'd, and the line of Light which was in the middle between 7451them was grown very broad, enlarging it self on both sides into the 7452streams of Light described in the fifth Observation, the above-mention'd 7453Shadow began to appear in the middle of this line, and divide it along 7454the middle into two lines of Light, and increased until the whole Light 7455vanish'd. This enlargement of the Fringes was so great that the Rays 7456which go to the innermost Fringe seem'd to be bent above twenty times 7457more when this Fringe was ready to vanish, than when one of the Knives 7458was taken away. 7459 7460And from this and the former Observation compared, I gather, that the 7461Light of the first Fringe passed by the edge of the Knife at a distance 7462greater than the 800th part of an Inch, and the Light of the second 7463Fringe passed by the edge of the Knife at a greater distance than the 7464Light of the first Fringe did, and that of the third at a greater 7465distance than that of the second, and that of the streams of Light 7466described in the fifth and sixth Observations passed by the edges of the 7467Knives at less distances than that of any of the Fringes. 7468 7469_Obs._ 8. I caused the edges of two Knives to be ground truly strait, 7470and pricking their points into a Board so that their edges might look 7471towards one another, and meeting near their points contain a rectilinear 7472Angle, I fasten'd their Handles together with Pitch to make this Angle 7473invariable. The distance of the edges of the Knives from one another at 7474the distance of four Inches from the angular Point, where the edges of 7475the Knives met, was the eighth part of an Inch; and therefore the Angle 7476contain'd by the edges was about one Degree 54: The Knives thus fix'd 7477together I placed in a beam of the Sun's Light, let into my darken'd 7478Chamber through a Hole the 42d Part of an Inch wide, at the distance of 747910 or 15 Feet from the Hole, and let the Light which passed between 7480their edges fall very obliquely upon a smooth white Ruler at the 7481distance of half an Inch, or an Inch from the Knives, and there saw the 7482Fringes by the two edges of the Knives run along the edges of the 7483Shadows of the Knives in Lines parallel to those edges without growing 7484sensibly broader, till they met in Angles equal to the Angle contained 7485by the edges of the Knives, and where they met and joined they ended 7486without crossing one another. But if the Ruler was held at a much 7487greater distance from the Knives, the Fringes where they were farther 7488from the Place of their Meeting, were a little narrower, and became 7489something broader and broader as they approach'd nearer and nearer to 7490one another, and after they met they cross'd one another, and then 7491became much broader than before. 7492 7493Whence I gather that the distances at which the Fringes pass by the 7494Knives are not increased nor alter'd by the approach of the Knives, but 7495the Angles in which the Rays are there bent are much increased by that 7496approach; and that the Knife which is nearest any Ray determines which 7497way the Ray shall be bent, and the other Knife increases the bent. 7498 7499_Obs._ 9. When the Rays fell very obliquely upon the Ruler at the 7500distance of the third Part of an Inch from the Knives, the dark Line 7501between the first and second Fringe of the Shadow of one Knife, and the 7502dark Line between the first and second Fringe of the Shadow of the other 7503knife met with one another, at the distance of the fifth Part of an Inch 7504from the end of the Light which passed between the Knives at the 7505concourse of their edges. And therefore the distance of the edges of the 7506Knives at the meeting of these dark Lines was the 160th Part of an Inch. 7507For as four Inches to the eighth Part of an Inch, so is any Length of 7508the edges of the Knives measured from the point of their concourse to 7509the distance of the edges of the Knives at the end of that Length, and 7510so is the fifth Part of an Inch to the 160th Part. So then the dark 7511Lines above-mention'd meet in the middle of the Light which passes 7512between the Knives where they are distant the 160th Part of an Inch, and 7513the one half of that Light passes by the edge of one Knife at a distance 7514not greater than the 320th Part of an Inch, and falling upon the Paper 7515makes the Fringes of the Shadow of that Knife, and the other half passes 7516by the edge of the other Knife, at a distance not greater than the 320th 7517Part of an Inch, and falling upon the Paper makes the Fringes of the 7518Shadow of the other Knife. But if the Paper be held at a distance from 7519the Knives greater than the third Part of an Inch, the dark Lines 7520above-mention'd meet at a greater distance than the fifth Part of an 7521Inch from the end of the Light which passed between the Knives at the 7522concourse of their edges; and therefore the Light which falls upon the 7523Paper where those dark Lines meet passes between the Knives where the 7524edges are distant above the 160th part of an Inch. 7525 7526For at another time, when the two Knives were distant eight Feet and 7527five Inches from the little hole in the Window, made with a small Pin as 7528above, the Light which fell upon the Paper where the aforesaid dark 7529lines met, passed between the Knives, where the distance between their 7530edges was as in the following Table, when the distance of the Paper from 7531the Knives was also as follows. 7532 7533-----------------------------+------------------------------ 7534 | Distances between the edges 7535 Distances of the Paper | of the Knives in millesimal 7536 from the Knives in Inches. | parts of an Inch. 7537-----------------------------+------------------------------ 7538 1-1/2. | 0'012 7539 3-1/3. | 0'020 7540 8-3/5. | 0'034 7541 32. | 0'057 7542 96. | 0'081 7543 131. | 0'087 7544_____________________________|______________________________ 7545 7546And hence I gather, that the Light which makes the Fringes upon the 7547Paper is not the same Light at all distances of the Paper from the 7548Knives, but when the Paper is held near the Knives, the Fringes are made 7549by Light which passes by the edges of the Knives at a less distance, and 7550is more bent than when the Paper is held at a greater distance from the 7551Knives. 7552 7553[Illustration: FIG. 3.] 7554 7555_Obs._ 10. When the Fringes of the Shadows of the Knives fell 7556perpendicularly upon a Paper at a great distance from the Knives, they 7557were in the form of Hyperbola's, and their Dimensions were as follows. 7558Let CA, CB [in _Fig._ 3.] represent Lines drawn upon the Paper parallel 7559to the edges of the Knives, and between which all the Light would fall, 7560if it passed between the edges of the Knives without inflexion; DE a 7561Right Line drawn through C making the Angles ACD, BCE, equal to one 7562another, and terminating all the Light which falls upon the Paper from 7563the point where the edges of the Knives meet; _eis_, _fkt_, and _glv_, 7564three hyperbolical Lines representing the Terminus of the Shadow of one 7565of the Knives, the dark Line between the first and second Fringes of 7566that Shadow, and the dark Line between the second and third Fringes of 7567the same Shadow; _xip_, _ykq_, and _zlr_, three other hyperbolical Lines 7568representing the Terminus of the Shadow of the other Knife, the dark 7569Line between the first and second Fringes of that Shadow, and the dark 7570line between the second and third Fringes of the same Shadow. And 7571conceive that these three Hyperbola's are like and equal to the former 7572three, and cross them in the points _i_, _k_, and _l_, and that the 7573Shadows of the Knives are terminated and distinguish'd from the first 7574luminous Fringes by the lines _eis_ and _xip_, until the meeting and 7575crossing of the Fringes, and then those lines cross the Fringes in the 7576form of dark lines, terminating the first luminous Fringes within side, 7577and distinguishing them from another Light which begins to appear at 7578_i_, and illuminates all the triangular space _ip_DE_s_ comprehended by 7579these dark lines, and the right line DE. Of these Hyperbola's one 7580Asymptote is the line DE, and their other Asymptotes are parallel to the 7581lines CA and CB. Let _rv_ represent a line drawn any where upon the 7582Paper parallel to the Asymptote DE, and let this line cross the right 7583lines AC in _m_, and BC in _n_, and the six dark hyperbolical lines in 7584_p_, _q_, _r_; _s_, _t_, _v_; and by measuring the distances _ps_, _qt_, 7585_rv_, and thence collecting the lengths of the Ordinates _np_, _nq_, 7586_nr_ or _ms_, _mt_, _mv_, and doing this at several distances of the 7587line _rv_ from the Asymptote DD, you may find as many points of these 7588Hyperbola's as you please, and thereby know that these curve lines are 7589Hyperbola's differing little from the conical Hyperbola. And by 7590measuring the lines C_i_, C_k_, C_l_, you may find other points of these 7591Curves. 7592 7593For instance; when the Knives were distant from the hole in the Window 7594ten Feet, and the Paper from the Knives nine Feet, and the Angle 7595contained by the edges of the Knives to which the Angle ACB is equal, 7596was subtended by a Chord which was to the Radius as 1 to 32, and the 7597distance of the line _rv_ from the Asymptote DE was half an Inch: I 7598measured the lines _ps_, _qt_, _rv_, and found them 0'35, 0'65, 0'98 7599Inches respectively; and by adding to their halfs the line 1/2 _mn_, 7600(which here was the 128th part of an Inch, or 0'0078 Inches,) the Sums 7601_np_, _nq_, _nr_, were 0'1828, 0'3328, 0'4978 Inches. I measured also 7602the distances of the brightest parts of the Fringes which run between 7603_pq_ and _st_, _qr_ and _tv_, and next beyond _r_ and _v_, and found 7604them 0'5, 0'8, and 1'17 Inches. 7605 7606_Obs._ 11. The Sun shining into my darken'd Room through a small round 7607hole made in a Plate of Lead with a slender Pin, as above; I placed at 7608the hole a Prism to refract the Light, and form on the opposite Wall the 7609Spectrum of Colours, described in the third Experiment of the first 7610Book. And then I found that the Shadows of all Bodies held in the 7611colour'd Light between the Prism and the Wall, were border'd with 7612Fringes of the Colour of that Light in which they were held. In the full 7613red Light they were totally red without any sensible blue or violet, and 7614in the deep blue Light they were totally blue without any sensible red 7615or yellow; and so in the green Light they were totally green, excepting 7616a little yellow and blue, which were mixed in the green Light of the 7617Prism. And comparing the Fringes made in the several colour'd Lights, I 7618found that those made in the red Light were largest, those made in the 7619violet were least, and those made in the green were of a middle bigness. 7620For the Fringes with which the Shadow of a Man's Hair were bordered, 7621being measured cross the Shadow at the distance of six Inches from the 7622Hair, the distance between the middle and most luminous part of the 7623first or innermost Fringe on one side of the Shadow, and that of the 7624like Fringe on the other side of the Shadow, was in the full red Light 76251/37-1/4 of an Inch, and in the full violet 7/46. And the like distance 7626between the middle and most luminous parts of the second Fringes on 7627either side the Shadow was in the full red Light 1/22, and in the violet 76281/27 of an Inch. And these distances of the Fringes held the same 7629proportion at all distances from the Hair without any sensible 7630variation. 7631 7632So then the Rays which made these Fringes in the red Light passed by the 7633Hair at a greater distance than those did which made the like Fringes in 7634the violet; and therefore the Hair in causing these Fringes acted alike 7635upon the red Light or least refrangible Rays at a greater distance, and 7636upon the violet or most refrangible Rays at a less distance, and by 7637those actions disposed the red Light into Larger Fringes, and the violet 7638into smaller, and the Lights of intermediate Colours into Fringes of 7639intermediate bignesses without changing the Colour of any sort of Light. 7640 7641When therefore the Hair in the first and second of these Observations 7642was held in the white beam of the Sun's Light, and cast a Shadow which 7643was border'd with three Fringes of coloured Light, those Colours arose 7644not from any new modifications impress'd upon the Rays of Light by the 7645Hair, but only from the various inflexions whereby the several Sorts of 7646Rays were separated from one another, which before separation, by the 7647mixture of all their Colours, composed the white beam of the Sun's 7648Light, but whenever separated compose Lights of the several Colours 7649which they are originally disposed to exhibit. In this 11th Observation, 7650where the Colours are separated before the Light passes by the Hair, the 7651least refrangible Rays, which when separated from the rest make red, 7652were inflected at a greater distance from the Hair, so as to make three 7653red Fringes at a greater distance from the middle of the Shadow of the 7654Hair; and the most refrangible Rays which when separated make violet, 7655were inflected at a less distance from the Hair, so as to make three 7656violet Fringes at a less distance from the middle of the Shadow of the 7657Hair. And other Rays of intermediate degrees of Refrangibility were 7658inflected at intermediate distances from the Hair, so as to make Fringes 7659of intermediate Colours at intermediate distances from the middle of the 7660Shadow of the Hair. And in the second Observation, where all the Colours 7661are mix'd in the white Light which passes by the Hair, these Colours are 7662separated by the various inflexions of the Rays, and the Fringes which 7663they make appear all together, and the innermost Fringes being 7664contiguous make one broad Fringe composed of all the Colours in due 7665order, the violet lying on the inside of the Fringe next the Shadow, the 7666red on the outside farthest from the Shadow, and the blue, green, and 7667yellow, in the middle. And, in like manner, the middlemost Fringes of 7668all the Colours lying in order, and being contiguous, make another broad 7669Fringe composed of all the Colours; and the outmost Fringes of all the 7670Colours lying in order, and being contiguous, make a third broad Fringe 7671composed of all the Colours. These are the three Fringes of colour'd 7672Light with which the Shadows of all Bodies are border'd in the second 7673Observation. 7674 7675When I made the foregoing Observations, I design'd to repeat most of 7676them with more care and exactness, and to make some new ones for 7677determining the manner how the Rays of Light are bent in their passage 7678by Bodies, for making the Fringes of Colours with the dark lines between 7679them. But I was then interrupted, and cannot now think of taking these 7680things into farther Consideration. And since I have not finish'd this 7681part of my Design, I shall conclude with proposing only some Queries, in 7682order to a farther search to be made by others. 7683 7684_Query_ 1. Do not Bodies act upon Light at a distance, and by their 7685action bend its Rays; and is not this action (_cæteris paribus_) 7686strongest at the least distance? 7687 7688_Qu._ 2. Do not the Rays which differ in Refrangibility differ also in 7689Flexibity; and are they not by their different Inflexions separated from 7690one another, so as after separation to make the Colours in the three 7691Fringes above described? And after what manner are they inflected to 7692make those Fringes? 7693 7694_Qu._ 3. Are not the Rays of Light in passing by the edges and sides of 7695Bodies, bent several times backwards and forwards, with a motion like 7696that of an Eel? And do not the three Fringes of colour'd Light 7697above-mention'd arise from three such bendings? 7698 7699_Qu._ 4. Do not the Rays of Light which fall upon Bodies, and are 7700reflected or refracted, begin to bend before they arrive at the Bodies; 7701and are they not reflected, refracted, and inflected, by one and the 7702same Principle, acting variously in various Circumstances? 7703 7704_Qu._ 5. Do not Bodies and Light act mutually upon one another; that is 7705to say, Bodies upon Light in emitting, reflecting, refracting and 7706inflecting it, and Light upon Bodies for heating them, and putting their 7707parts into a vibrating motion wherein heat consists? 7708 7709_Qu._ 6. Do not black Bodies conceive heat more easily from Light than 7710those of other Colours do, by reason that the Light falling on them is 7711not reflected outwards, but enters the Bodies, and is often reflected 7712and refracted within them, until it be stifled and lost? 7713 7714_Qu._ 7. Is not the strength and vigor of the action between Light and 7715sulphureous Bodies observed above, one reason why sulphureous Bodies 7716take fire more readily, and burn more vehemently than other Bodies do? 7717 7718_Qu._ 8. Do not all fix'd Bodies, when heated beyond a certain degree, 7719emit Light and shine; and is not this Emission perform'd by the 7720vibrating motions of their parts? And do not all Bodies which abound 7721with terrestrial parts, and especially with sulphureous ones, emit Light 7722as often as those parts are sufficiently agitated; whether that 7723agitation be made by Heat, or by Friction, or Percussion, or 7724Putrefaction, or by any vital Motion, or any other Cause? As for 7725instance; Sea-Water in a raging Storm; Quick-silver agitated in _vacuo_; 7726the Back of a Cat, or Neck of a Horse, obliquely struck or rubbed in a 7727dark place; Wood, Flesh and Fish while they putrefy; Vapours arising 7728from putrefy'd Waters, usually call'd _Ignes Fatui_; Stacks of moist Hay 7729or Corn growing hot by fermentation; Glow-worms and the Eyes of some 7730Animals by vital Motions; the vulgar _Phosphorus_ agitated by the 7731attrition of any Body, or by the acid Particles of the Air; Amber and 7732some Diamonds by striking, pressing or rubbing them; Scrapings of Steel 7733struck off with a Flint; Iron hammer'd very nimbly till it become so hot 7734as to kindle Sulphur thrown upon it; the Axletrees of Chariots taking 7735fire by the rapid rotation of the Wheels; and some Liquors mix'd with 7736one another whose Particles come together with an Impetus, as Oil of 7737Vitriol distilled from its weight of Nitre, and then mix'd with twice 7738its weight of Oil of Anniseeds. So also a Globe of Glass about 8 or 10 7739Inches in diameter, being put into a Frame where it may be swiftly 7740turn'd round its Axis, will in turning shine where it rubs against the 7741palm of ones Hand apply'd to it: And if at the same time a piece of 7742white Paper or white Cloth, or the end of ones Finger be held at the 7743distance of about a quarter of an Inch or half an Inch from that part of 7744the Glass where it is most in motion, the electrick Vapour which is 7745excited by the friction of the Glass against the Hand, will by dashing 7746against the white Paper, Cloth or Finger, be put into such an agitation 7747as to emit Light, and make the white Paper, Cloth or Finger, appear 7748lucid like a Glowworm; and in rushing out of the Glass will sometimes 7749push against the finger so as to be felt. And the same things have been 7750found by rubbing a long and large Cylinder or Glass or Amber with a 7751Paper held in ones hand, and continuing the friction till the Glass grew 7752warm. 7753 7754_Qu._ 9. Is not Fire a Body heated so hot as to emit Light copiously? 7755For what else is a red hot Iron than Fire? And what else is a burning 7756Coal than red hot Wood? 7757 7758_Qu._ 10. Is not Flame a Vapour, Fume or Exhalation heated red hot, that 7759is, so hot as to shine? For Bodies do not flame without emitting a 7760copious Fume, and this Fume burns in the Flame. The _Ignis Fatuus_ is a 7761Vapour shining without heat, and is there not the same difference 7762between this Vapour and Flame, as between rotten Wood shining without 7763heat and burning Coals of Fire? In distilling hot Spirits, if the Head 7764of the Still be taken off, the Vapour which ascends out of the Still 7765will take fire at the Flame of a Candle, and turn into Flame, and the 7766Flame will run along the Vapour from the Candle to the Still. Some 7767Bodies heated by Motion, or Fermentation, if the heat grow intense, fume 7768copiously, and if the heat be great enough the Fumes will shine and 7769become Flame. Metals in fusion do not flame for want of a copious Fume, 7770except Spelter, which fumes copiously, and thereby flames. All flaming 7771Bodies, as Oil, Tallow, Wax, Wood, fossil Coals, Pitch, Sulphur, by 7772flaming waste and vanish into burning Smoke, which Smoke, if the Flame 7773be put out, is very thick and visible, and sometimes smells strongly, 7774but in the Flame loses its smell by burning, and according to the nature 7775of the Smoke the Flame is of several Colours, as that of Sulphur blue, 7776that of Copper open'd with sublimate green, that of Tallow yellow, that 7777of Camphire white. Smoke passing through Flame cannot but grow red hot, 7778and red hot Smoke can have no other appearance than that of Flame. When 7779Gun-powder takes fire, it goes away into Flaming Smoke. For the Charcoal 7780and Sulphur easily take fire, and set fire to the Nitre, and the Spirit 7781of the Nitre being thereby rarified into Vapour, rushes out with 7782Explosion much after the manner that the Vapour of Water rushes out of 7783an Æolipile; the Sulphur also being volatile is converted into Vapour, 7784and augments the Explosion. And the acid Vapour of the Sulphur (namely 7785that which distils under a Bell into Oil of Sulphur,) entring violently 7786into the fix'd Body of the Nitre, sets loose the Spirit of the Nitre, 7787and excites a great Fermentation, whereby the Heat is farther augmented, 7788and the fix'd Body of the Nitre is also rarified into Fume, and the 7789Explosion is thereby made more vehement and quick. For if Salt of Tartar 7790be mix'd with Gun-powder, and that Mixture be warm'd till it takes fire, 7791the Explosion will be more violent and quick than that of Gun-powder 7792alone; which cannot proceed from any other cause than the action of the 7793Vapour of the Gun-powder upon the Salt of Tartar, whereby that Salt is 7794rarified. The Explosion of Gun-powder arises therefore from the violent 7795action whereby all the Mixture being quickly and vehemently heated, is 7796rarified and converted into Fume and Vapour: which Vapour, by the 7797violence of that action, becoming so hot as to shine, appears in the 7798form of Flame. 7799 7800_Qu._ 11. Do not great Bodies conserve their heat the longest, their 7801parts heating one another, and may not great dense and fix'd Bodies, 7802when heated beyond a certain degree, emit Light so copiously, as by the 7803Emission and Re-action of its Light, and the Reflexions and Refractions 7804of its Rays within its Pores to grow still hotter, till it comes to a 7805certain period of heat, such as is that of the Sun? And are not the Sun 7806and fix'd Stars great Earths vehemently hot, whose heat is conserved by 7807the greatness of the Bodies, and the mutual Action and Reaction between 7808them, and the Light which they emit, and whose parts are kept from 7809fuming away, not only by their fixity, but also by the vast weight and 7810density of the Atmospheres incumbent upon them; and very strongly 7811compressing them, and condensing the Vapours and Exhalations which arise 7812from them? For if Water be made warm in any pellucid Vessel emptied of 7813Air, that Water in the _Vacuum_ will bubble and boil as vehemently as it 7814would in the open Air in a Vessel set upon the Fire till it conceives a 7815much greater heat. For the weight of the incumbent Atmosphere keeps down 7816the Vapours, and hinders the Water from boiling, until it grow much 7817hotter than is requisite to make it boil _in vacuo_. Also a mixture of 7818Tin and Lead being put upon a red hot Iron _in vacuo_ emits a Fume and 7819Flame, but the same Mixture in the open Air, by reason of the incumbent 7820Atmosphere, does not so much as emit any Fume which can be perceived by 7821Sight. In like manner the great weight of the Atmosphere which lies upon 7822the Globe of the Sun may hinder Bodies there from rising up and going 7823away from the Sun in the form of Vapours and Fumes, unless by means of a 7824far greater heat than that which on the Surface of our Earth would very 7825easily turn them into Vapours and Fumes. And the same great weight may 7826condense those Vapours and Exhalations as soon as they shall at any time 7827begin to ascend from the Sun, and make them presently fall back again 7828into him, and by that action increase his Heat much after the manner 7829that in our Earth the Air increases the Heat of a culinary Fire. And the 7830same weight may hinder the Globe of the Sun from being diminish'd, 7831unless by the Emission of Light, and a very small quantity of Vapours 7832and Exhalations. 7833 7834_Qu._ 12. Do not the Rays of Light in falling upon the bottom of the Eye 7835excite Vibrations in the _Tunica Retina_? Which Vibrations, being 7836propagated along the solid Fibres of the optick Nerves into the Brain, 7837cause the Sense of seeing. For because dense Bodies conserve their Heat 7838a long time, and the densest Bodies conserve their Heat the longest, the 7839Vibrations of their parts are of a lasting nature, and therefore may be 7840propagated along solid Fibres of uniform dense Matter to a great 7841distance, for conveying into the Brain the impressions made upon all the 7842Organs of Sense. For that Motion which can continue long in one and the 7843same part of a Body, can be propagated a long way from one part to 7844another, supposing the Body homogeneal, so that the Motion may not be 7845reflected, refracted, interrupted or disorder'd by any unevenness of the 7846Body. 7847 7848_Qu._ 13. Do not several sorts of Rays make Vibrations of several 7849bignesses, which according to their bignesses excite Sensations of 7850several Colours, much after the manner that the Vibrations of the Air, 7851according to their several bignesses excite Sensations of several 7852Sounds? And particularly do not the most refrangible Rays excite the 7853shortest Vibrations for making a Sensation of deep violet, the least 7854refrangible the largest for making a Sensation of deep red, and the 7855several intermediate sorts of Rays, Vibrations of several intermediate 7856bignesses to make Sensations of the several intermediate Colours? 7857 7858_Qu._ 14. May not the harmony and discord of Colours arise from the 7859proportions of the Vibrations propagated through the Fibres of the 7860optick Nerves into the Brain, as the harmony and discord of Sounds arise 7861from the proportions of the Vibrations of the Air? For some Colours, if 7862they be view'd together, are agreeable to one another, as those of Gold 7863and Indigo, and others disagree. 7864 7865_Qu._ 15. Are not the Species of Objects seen with both Eyes united 7866where the optick Nerves meet before they come into the Brain, the Fibres 7867on the right side of both Nerves uniting there, and after union going 7868thence into the Brain in the Nerve which is on the right side of the 7869Head, and the Fibres on the left side of both Nerves uniting in the same 7870place, and after union going into the Brain in the Nerve which is on the 7871left side of the Head, and these two Nerves meeting in the Brain in such 7872a manner that their Fibres make but one entire Species or Picture, half 7873of which on the right side of the Sensorium comes from the right side of 7874both Eyes through the right side of both optick Nerves to the place 7875where the Nerves meet, and from thence on the right side of the Head 7876into the Brain, and the other half on the left side of the Sensorium 7877comes in like manner from the left side of both Eyes. For the optick 7878Nerves of such Animals as look the same way with both Eyes (as of Men, 7879Dogs, Sheep, Oxen, &c.) meet before they come into the Brain, but the 7880optick Nerves of such Animals as do not look the same way with both Eyes 7881(as of Fishes, and of the Chameleon,) do not meet, if I am rightly 7882inform'd. 7883 7884_Qu._ 16. When a Man in the dark presses either corner of his Eye with 7885his Finger, and turns his Eye away from his Finger, he will see a Circle 7886of Colours like those in the Feather of a Peacock's Tail. If the Eye and 7887the Finger remain quiet these Colours vanish in a second Minute of Time, 7888but if the Finger be moved with a quavering Motion they appear again. Do 7889not these Colours arise from such Motions excited in the bottom of the 7890Eye by the Pressure and Motion of the Finger, as, at other times are 7891excited there by Light for causing Vision? And do not the Motions once 7892excited continue about a Second of Time before they cease? And when a 7893Man by a stroke upon his Eye sees a flash of Light, are not the like 7894Motions excited in the _Retina_ by the stroke? And when a Coal of Fire 7895moved nimbly in the circumference of a Circle, makes the whole 7896circumference appear like a Circle of Fire; is it not because the 7897Motions excited in the bottom of the Eye by the Rays of Light are of a 7898lasting nature, and continue till the Coal of Fire in going round 7899returns to its former place? And considering the lastingness of the 7900Motions excited in the bottom of the Eye by Light, are they not of a 7901vibrating nature? 7902 7903_Qu._ 17. If a stone be thrown into stagnating Water, the Waves excited 7904thereby continue some time to arise in the place where the Stone fell 7905into the Water, and are propagated from thence in concentrick Circles 7906upon the Surface of the Water to great distances. And the Vibrations or 7907Tremors excited in the Air by percussion, continue a little time to move 7908from the place of percussion in concentrick Spheres to great distances. 7909And in like manner, when a Ray of Light falls upon the Surface of any 7910pellucid Body, and is there refracted or reflected, may not Waves of 7911Vibrations, or Tremors, be thereby excited in the refracting or 7912reflecting Medium at the point of Incidence, and continue to arise 7913there, and to be propagated from thence as long as they continue to 7914arise and be propagated, when they are excited in the bottom of the Eye 7915by the Pressure or Motion of the Finger, or by the Light which comes 7916from the Coal of Fire in the Experiments above-mention'd? and are not 7917these Vibrations propagated from the point of Incidence to great 7918distances? And do they not overtake the Rays of Light, and by overtaking 7919them successively, do they not put them into the Fits of easy Reflexion 7920and easy Transmission described above? For if the Rays endeavour to 7921recede from the densest part of the Vibration, they may be alternately 7922accelerated and retarded by the Vibrations overtaking them. 7923 7924_Qu._ 18. If in two large tall cylindrical Vessels of Glass inverted, 7925two little Thermometers be suspended so as not to touch the Vessels, and 7926the Air be drawn out of one of these Vessels, and these Vessels thus 7927prepared be carried out of a cold place into a warm one; the Thermometer 7928_in vacuo_ will grow warm as much, and almost as soon as the Thermometer 7929which is not _in vacuo_. And when the Vessels are carried back into the 7930cold place, the Thermometer _in vacuo_ will grow cold almost as soon as 7931the other Thermometer. Is not the Heat of the warm Room convey'd through 7932the _Vacuum_ by the Vibrations of a much subtiler Medium than Air, which 7933after the Air was drawn out remained in the _Vacuum_? And is not this 7934Medium the same with that Medium by which Light is refracted and 7935reflected, and by whose Vibrations Light communicates Heat to Bodies, 7936and is put into Fits of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission? And do not 7937the Vibrations of this Medium in hot Bodies contribute to the 7938intenseness and duration of their Heat? And do not hot Bodies 7939communicate their Heat to contiguous cold ones, by the Vibrations of 7940this Medium propagated from them into the cold ones? And is not this 7941Medium exceedingly more rare and subtile than the Air, and exceedingly 7942more elastick and active? And doth it not readily pervade all Bodies? 7943And is it not (by its elastick force) expanded through all the Heavens? 7944 7945_Qu._ 19. Doth not the Refraction of Light proceed from the different 7946density of this Æthereal Medium in different places, the Light receding 7947always from the denser parts of the Medium? And is not the density 7948thereof greater in free and open Spaces void of Air and other grosser 7949Bodies, than within the Pores of Water, Glass, Crystal, Gems, and other 7950compact Bodies? For when Light passes through Glass or Crystal, and 7951falling very obliquely upon the farther Surface thereof is totally 7952reflected, the total Reflexion ought to proceed rather from the density 7953and vigour of the Medium without and beyond the Glass, than from the 7954rarity and weakness thereof. 7955 7956_Qu._ 20. Doth not this Æthereal Medium in passing out of Water, Glass, 7957Crystal, and other compact and dense Bodies into empty Spaces, grow 7958denser and denser by degrees, and by that means refract the Rays of 7959Light not in a point, but by bending them gradually in curve Lines? And 7960doth not the gradual condensation of this Medium extend to some distance 7961from the Bodies, and thereby cause the Inflexions of the Rays of Light, 7962which pass by the edges of dense Bodies, at some distance from the 7963Bodies? 7964 7965_Qu._ 21. Is not this Medium much rarer within the dense Bodies of the 7966Sun, Stars, Planets and Comets, than in the empty celestial Spaces 7967between them? And in passing from them to great distances, doth it not 7968grow denser and denser perpetually, and thereby cause the gravity of 7969those great Bodies towards one another, and of their parts towards the 7970Bodies; every Body endeavouring to go from the denser parts of the 7971Medium towards the rarer? For if this Medium be rarer within the Sun's 7972Body than at its Surface, and rarer there than at the hundredth part of 7973an Inch from its Body, and rarer there than at the fiftieth part of an 7974Inch from its Body, and rarer there than at the Orb of _Saturn_; I see 7975no reason why the Increase of density should stop any where, and not 7976rather be continued through all distances from the Sun to _Saturn_, and 7977beyond. And though this Increase of density may at great distances be 7978exceeding slow, yet if the elastick force of this Medium be exceeding 7979great, it may suffice to impel Bodies from the denser parts of the 7980Medium towards the rarer, with all that power which we call Gravity. And 7981that the elastick force of this Medium is exceeding great, may be 7982gather'd from the swiftness of its Vibrations. Sounds move about 1140 7983_English_ Feet in a second Minute of Time, and in seven or eight Minutes 7984of Time they move about one hundred _English_ Miles. Light moves from 7985the Sun to us in about seven or eight Minutes of Time, which distance is 7986about 70,000,000 _English_ Miles, supposing the horizontal Parallax of 7987the Sun to be about 12´´. And the Vibrations or Pulses of this Medium, 7988that they may cause the alternate Fits of easy Transmission and easy 7989Reflexion, must be swifter than Light, and by consequence above 700,000 7990times swifter than Sounds. And therefore the elastick force of this 7991Medium, in proportion to its density, must be above 700000 x 700000 7992(that is, above 490,000,000,000) times greater than the elastick force 7993of the Air is in proportion to its density. For the Velocities of the 7994Pulses of elastick Mediums are in a subduplicate _Ratio_ of the 7995Elasticities and the Rarities of the Mediums taken together. 7996 7997As Attraction is stronger in small Magnets than in great ones in 7998proportion to their Bulk, and Gravity is greater in the Surfaces of 7999small Planets than in those of great ones in proportion to their bulk, 8000and small Bodies are agitated much more by electric attraction than 8001great ones; so the smallness of the Rays of Light may contribute very 8002much to the power of the Agent by which they are refracted. And so if 8003any one should suppose that _Æther_ (like our Air) may contain Particles 8004which endeavour to recede from one another (for I do not know what this 8005_Æther_ is) and that its Particles are exceedingly smaller than those of 8006Air, or even than those of Light: The exceeding smallness of its 8007Particles may contribute to the greatness of the force by which those 8008Particles may recede from one another, and thereby make that Medium 8009exceedingly more rare and elastick than Air, and by consequence 8010exceedingly less able to resist the motions of Projectiles, and 8011exceedingly more able to press upon gross Bodies, by endeavouring to 8012expand it self. 8013 8014_Qu._ 22. May not Planets and Comets, and all gross Bodies, perform 8015their Motions more freely, and with less resistance in this Æthereal 8016Medium than in any Fluid, which fills all Space adequately without 8017leaving any Pores, and by consequence is much denser than Quick-silver 8018or Gold? And may not its resistance be so small, as to be 8019inconsiderable? For instance; If this _Æther_ (for so I will call it) 8020should be supposed 700000 times more elastick than our Air, and above 8021700000 times more rare; its resistance would be above 600,000,000 times 8022less than that of Water. And so small a resistance would scarce make any 8023sensible alteration in the Motions of the Planets in ten thousand 8024Years. If any one would ask how a Medium can be so rare, let him tell me 8025how the Air, in the upper parts of the Atmosphere, can be above an 8026hundred thousand thousand times rarer than Gold. Let him also tell me, 8027how an electrick Body can by Friction emit an Exhalation so rare and 8028subtile, and yet so potent, as by its Emission to cause no sensible 8029Diminution of the weight of the electrick Body, and to be expanded 8030through a Sphere, whose Diameter is above two Feet, and yet to be able 8031to agitate and carry up Leaf Copper, or Leaf Gold, at the distance of 8032above a Foot from the electrick Body? And how the Effluvia of a Magnet 8033can be so rare and subtile, as to pass through a Plate of Glass without 8034any Resistance or Diminution of their Force, and yet so potent as to 8035turn a magnetick Needle beyond the Glass? 8036 8037_Qu._ 23. Is not Vision perform'd chiefly by the Vibrations of this 8038Medium, excited in the bottom of the Eye by the Rays of Light, and 8039propagated through the solid, pellucid and uniform Capillamenta of the 8040optick Nerves into the place of Sensation? And is not Hearing perform'd 8041by the Vibrations either of this or some other Medium, excited in the 8042auditory Nerves by the Tremors of the Air, and propagated through the 8043solid, pellucid and uniform Capillamenta of those Nerves into the place 8044of Sensation? And so of the other Senses. 8045 8046_Qu._ 24. Is not Animal Motion perform'd by the Vibrations of this 8047Medium, excited in the Brain by the power of the Will, and propagated 8048from thence through the solid, pellucid and uniform Capillamenta of the 8049Nerves into the Muscles, for contracting and dilating them? I suppose 8050that the Capillamenta of the Nerves are each of them solid and uniform, 8051that the vibrating Motion of the Æthereal Medium may be propagated along 8052them from one end to the other uniformly, and without interruption: For 8053Obstructions in the Nerves create Palsies. And that they may be 8054sufficiently uniform, I suppose them to be pellucid when view'd singly, 8055tho' the Reflexions in their cylindrical Surfaces may make the whole 8056Nerve (composed of many Capillamenta) appear opake and white. For 8057opacity arises from reflecting Surfaces, such as may disturb and 8058interrupt the Motions of this Medium. 8059 8060[Sidenote: _See the following Scheme, p. 356._] 8061 8062_Qu._ 25. Are there not other original Properties of the Rays of Light, 8063besides those already described? An instance of another original 8064Property we have in the Refraction of Island Crystal, described first by 8065_Erasmus Bartholine_, and afterwards more exactly by _Hugenius_, in his 8066Book _De la Lumiere_. This Crystal is a pellucid fissile Stone, clear as 8067Water or Crystal of the Rock, and without Colour; enduring a red Heat 8068without losing its transparency, and in a very strong Heat calcining 8069without Fusion. Steep'd a Day or two in Water, it loses its natural 8070Polish. Being rubb'd on Cloth, it attracts pieces of Straws and other 8071light things, like Ambar or Glass; and with _Aqua fortis_ it makes an 8072Ebullition. It seems to be a sort of Talk, and is found in form of an 8073oblique Parallelopiped, with six parallelogram Sides and eight solid 8074Angles. The obtuse Angles of the Parallelograms are each of them 101 8075Degrees and 52 Minutes; the acute ones 78 Degrees and 8 Minutes. Two of 8076the solid Angles opposite to one another, as C and E, are compassed each 8077of them with three of these obtuse Angles, and each of the other six 8078with one obtuse and two acute ones. It cleaves easily in planes parallel 8079to any of its Sides, and not in any other Planes. It cleaves with a 8080glossy polite Surface not perfectly plane, but with some little 8081unevenness. It is easily scratch'd, and by reason of its softness it 8082takes a Polish very difficultly. It polishes better upon polish'd 8083Looking-glass than upon Metal, and perhaps better upon Pitch, Leather or 8084Parchment. Afterwards it must be rubb'd with a little Oil or white of an 8085Egg, to fill up its Scratches; whereby it will become very transparent 8086and polite. But for several Experiments, it is not necessary to polish 8087it. If a piece of this crystalline Stone be laid upon a Book, every 8088Letter of the Book seen through it will appear double, by means of a 8089double Refraction. And if any beam of Light falls either 8090perpendicularly, or in any oblique Angle upon any Surface of this 8091Crystal, it becomes divided into two beams by means of the same double 8092Refraction. Which beams are of the same Colour with the incident beam of 8093Light, and seem equal to one another in the quantity of their Light, or 8094very nearly equal. One of these Refractions is perform'd by the usual 8095Rule of Opticks, the Sine of Incidence out of Air into this Crystal 8096being to the Sine of Refraction, as five to three. The other 8097Refraction, which may be called the unusual Refraction, is perform'd by 8098the following Rule. 8099 8100[Illustration: FIG. 4.] 8101 8102Let ADBC represent the refracting Surface of the Crystal, C the biggest 8103solid Angle at that Surface, GEHF the opposite Surface, and CK a 8104perpendicular on that Surface. This perpendicular makes with the edge of 8105the Crystal CF, an Angle of 19 Degr. 3'. Join KF, and in it take KL, so 8106that the Angle KCL be 6 Degr. 40'. and the Angle LCF 12 Degr. 23'. And 8107if ST represent any beam of Light incident at T in any Angle upon the 8108refracting Surface ADBC, let TV be the refracted beam determin'd by the 8109given Portion of the Sines 5 to 3, according to the usual Rule of 8110Opticks. Draw VX parallel and equal to KL. Draw it the same way from V 8111in which L lieth from K; and joining TX, this line TX shall be the other 8112refracted beam carried from T to X, by the unusual Refraction. 8113 8114If therefore the incident beam ST be perpendicular to the refracting 8115Surface, the two beams TV and TX, into which it shall become divided, 8116shall be parallel to the lines CK and CL; one of those beams going 8117through the Crystal perpendicularly, as it ought to do by the usual Laws 8118of Opticks, and the other TX by an unusual Refraction diverging from the 8119perpendicular, and making with it an Angle VTX of about 6-2/3 Degrees, 8120as is found by Experience. And hence, the Plane VTX, and such like 8121Planes which are parallel to the Plane CFK, may be called the Planes of 8122perpendicular Refraction. And the Coast towards which the lines KL and 8123VX are drawn, may be call'd the Coast of unusual Refraction. 8124 8125In like manner Crystal of the Rock has a double Refraction: But the 8126difference of the two Refractions is not so great and manifest as in 8127Island Crystal. 8128 8129When the beam ST incident on Island Crystal is divided into two beams TV 8130and TX, and these two beams arrive at the farther Surface of the Glass; 8131the beam TV, which was refracted at the first Surface after the usual 8132manner, shall be again refracted entirely after the usual manner at the 8133second Surface; and the beam TX, which was refracted after the unusual 8134manner in the first Surface, shall be again refracted entirely after the 8135unusual manner in the second Surface; so that both these beams shall 8136emerge out of the second Surface in lines parallel to the first incident 8137beam ST. 8138 8139And if two pieces of Island Crystal be placed one after another, in such 8140manner that all the Surfaces of the latter be parallel to all the 8141corresponding Surfaces of the former: The Rays which are refracted after 8142the usual manner in the first Surface of the first Crystal, shall be 8143refracted after the usual manner in all the following Surfaces; and the 8144Rays which are refracted after the unusual manner in the first Surface, 8145shall be refracted after the unusual manner in all the following 8146Surfaces. And the same thing happens, though the Surfaces of the 8147Crystals be any ways inclined to one another, provided that their Planes 8148of perpendicular Refraction be parallel to one another. 8149 8150And therefore there is an original difference in the Rays of Light, by 8151means of which some Rays are in this Experiment constantly refracted 8152after the usual manner, and others constantly after the unusual manner: 8153For if the difference be not original, but arises from new Modifications 8154impress'd on the Rays at their first Refraction, it would be alter'd by 8155new Modifications in the three following Refractions; whereas it suffers 8156no alteration, but is constant, and has the same effect upon the Rays in 8157all the Refractions. The unusual Refraction is therefore perform'd by an 8158original property of the Rays. And it remains to be enquired, whether 8159the Rays have not more original Properties than are yet discover'd. 8160 8161_Qu._ 26. Have not the Rays of Light several sides, endued with several 8162original Properties? For if the Planes of perpendicular Refraction of 8163the second Crystal be at right Angles with the Planes of perpendicular 8164Refraction of the first Crystal, the Rays which are refracted after the 8165usual manner in passing through the first Crystal, will be all of them 8166refracted after the unusual manner in passing through the second 8167Crystal; and the Rays which are refracted after the unusual manner in 8168passing through the first Crystal, will be all of them refracted after 8169the usual manner in passing through the second Crystal. And therefore 8170there are not two sorts of Rays differing in their nature from one 8171another, one of which is constantly and in all Positions refracted after 8172the usual manner, and the other constantly and in all Positions after 8173the unusual manner. The difference between the two sorts of Rays in the 8174Experiment mention'd in the 25th Question, was only in the Positions of 8175the Sides of the Rays to the Planes of perpendicular Refraction. For one 8176and the same Ray is here refracted sometimes after the usual, and 8177sometimes after the unusual manner, according to the Position which its 8178Sides have to the Crystals. If the Sides of the Ray are posited the same 8179way to both Crystals, it is refracted after the same manner in them 8180both: But if that side of the Ray which looks towards the Coast of the 8181unusual Refraction of the first Crystal, be 90 Degrees from that side of 8182the same Ray which looks toward the Coast of the unusual Refraction of 8183the second Crystal, (which may be effected by varying the Position of 8184the second Crystal to the first, and by consequence to the Rays of 8185Light,) the Ray shall be refracted after several manners in the several 8186Crystals. There is nothing more required to determine whether the Rays 8187of Light which fall upon the second Crystal shall be refracted after 8188the usual or after the unusual manner, but to turn about this Crystal, 8189so that the Coast of this Crystal's unusual Refraction may be on this or 8190on that side of the Ray. And therefore every Ray may be consider'd as 8191having four Sides or Quarters, two of which opposite to one another 8192incline the Ray to be refracted after the unusual manner, as often as 8193either of them are turn'd towards the Coast of unusual Refraction; and 8194the other two, whenever either of them are turn'd towards the Coast of 8195unusual Refraction, do not incline it to be otherwise refracted than 8196after the usual manner. The two first may therefore be call'd the Sides 8197of unusual Refraction. And since these Dispositions were in the Rays 8198before their Incidence on the second, third, and fourth Surfaces of the 8199two Crystals, and suffered no alteration (so far as appears,) by the 8200Refraction of the Rays in their passage through those Surfaces, and the 8201Rays were refracted by the same Laws in all the four Surfaces; it 8202appears that those Dispositions were in the Rays originally, and 8203suffer'd no alteration by the first Refraction, and that by means of 8204those Dispositions the Rays were refracted at their Incidence on the 8205first Surface of the first Crystal, some of them after the usual, and 8206some of them after the unusual manner, accordingly as their Sides of 8207unusual Refraction were then turn'd towards the Coast of the unusual 8208Refraction of that Crystal, or sideways from it. 8209 8210Every Ray of Light has therefore two opposite Sides, originally endued 8211with a Property on which the unusual Refraction depends, and the other 8212two opposite Sides not endued with that Property. And it remains to be 8213enquired, whether there are not more Properties of Light by which the 8214Sides of the Rays differ, and are distinguished from one another. 8215 8216In explaining the difference of the Sides of the Rays above mention'd, I 8217have supposed that the Rays fall perpendicularly on the first Crystal. 8218But if they fall obliquely on it, the Success is the same. Those Rays 8219which are refracted after the usual manner in the first Crystal, will be 8220refracted after the unusual manner in the second Crystal, supposing the 8221Planes of perpendicular Refraction to be at right Angles with one 8222another, as above; and on the contrary. 8223 8224If the Planes of the perpendicular Refraction of the two Crystals be 8225neither parallel nor perpendicular to one another, but contain an acute 8226Angle: The two beams of Light which emerge out of the first Crystal, 8227will be each of them divided into two more at their Incidence on the 8228second Crystal. For in this case the Rays in each of the two beams will 8229some of them have their Sides of unusual Refraction, and some of them 8230their other Sides turn'd towards the Coast of the unusual Refraction of 8231the second Crystal. 8232 8233_Qu._ 27. Are not all Hypotheses erroneous which have hitherto been 8234invented for explaining the Phænomena of Light, by new Modifications of 8235the Rays? For those Phænomena depend not upon new Modifications, as has 8236been supposed, but upon the original and unchangeable Properties of the 8237Rays. 8238 8239_Qu._ 28. Are not all Hypotheses erroneous, in which Light is supposed 8240to consist in Pression or Motion, propagated through a fluid Medium? For 8241in all these Hypotheses the Phænomena of Light have been hitherto 8242explain'd by supposing that they arise from new Modifications of the 8243Rays; which is an erroneous Supposition. 8244 8245If Light consisted only in Pression propagated without actual Motion, it 8246would not be able to agitate and heat the Bodies which refract and 8247reflect it. If it consisted in Motion propagated to all distances in an 8248instant, it would require an infinite force every moment, in every 8249shining Particle, to generate that Motion. And if it consisted in 8250Pression or Motion, propagated either in an instant or in time, it would 8251bend into the Shadow. For Pression or Motion cannot be propagated in a 8252Fluid in right Lines, beyond an Obstacle which stops part of the Motion, 8253but will bend and spread every way into the quiescent Medium which lies 8254beyond the Obstacle. Gravity tends downwards, but the Pressure of Water 8255arising from Gravity tends every way with equal Force, and is propagated 8256as readily, and with as much force sideways as downwards, and through 8257crooked passages as through strait ones. The Waves on the Surface of 8258stagnating Water, passing by the sides of a broad Obstacle which stops 8259part of them, bend afterwards and dilate themselves gradually into the 8260quiet Water behind the Obstacle. The Waves, Pulses or Vibrations of the 8261Air, wherein Sounds consist, bend manifestly, though not so much as the 8262Waves of Water. For a Bell or a Cannon may be heard beyond a Hill which 8263intercepts the sight of the sounding Body, and Sounds are propagated as 8264readily through crooked Pipes as through streight ones. But Light is 8265never known to follow crooked Passages nor to bend into the Shadow. For 8266the fix'd Stars by the Interposition of any of the Planets cease to be 8267seen. And so do the Parts of the Sun by the Interposition of the Moon, 8268_Mercury_ or _Venus_. The Rays which pass very near to the edges of any 8269Body, are bent a little by the action of the Body, as we shew'd above; 8270but this bending is not towards but from the Shadow, and is perform'd 8271only in the passage of the Ray by the Body, and at a very small distance 8272from it. So soon as the Ray is past the Body, it goes right on. 8273 8274[Sidenote: _Mais pour dire comment cela se fait, je n'ay rien trove 8275jusqu' ici qui me satisfasse._ C. H. de la lumiere, c. 5, p. 91.] 8276 8277To explain the unusual Refraction of Island Crystal by Pression or 8278Motion propagated, has not hitherto been attempted (to my knowledge) 8279except by _Huygens_, who for that end supposed two several vibrating 8280Mediums within that Crystal. But when he tried the Refractions in two 8281successive pieces of that Crystal, and found them such as is mention'd 8282above; he confessed himself at a loss for explaining them. For Pressions 8283or Motions, propagated from a shining Body through an uniform Medium, 8284must be on all sides alike; whereas by those Experiments it appears, 8285that the Rays of Light have different Properties in their different 8286Sides. He suspected that the Pulses of _Æther_ in passing through the 8287first Crystal might receive certain new Modifications, which might 8288determine them to be propagated in this or that Medium within the 8289second Crystal, according to the Position of that Crystal. But what 8290Modifications those might be he could not say, nor think of any thing 8291satisfactory in that Point. And if he had known that the unusual 8292Refraction depends not on new Modifications, but on the original and 8293unchangeable Dispositions of the Rays, he would have found it as 8294difficult to explain how those Dispositions which he supposed to be 8295impress'd on the Rays by the first Crystal, could be in them before 8296their Incidence on that Crystal, and in general, how all Rays emitted by 8297shining Bodies, can have those Dispositions in them from the beginning. 8298To me, at least, this seems inexplicable, if Light be nothing else than 8299Pression or Motion propagated through _Æther_. 8300 8301And it is as difficult to explain by these Hypotheses, how Rays can be 8302alternately in Fits of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission; unless 8303perhaps one might suppose that there are in all Space two Æthereal 8304vibrating Mediums, and that the Vibrations of one of them constitute 8305Light, and the Vibrations of the other are swifter, and as often as they 8306overtake the Vibrations of the first, put them into those Fits. But how 8307two _Æthers_ can be diffused through all Space, one of which acts upon 8308the other, and by consequence is re-acted upon, without retarding, 8309shattering, dispersing and confounding one anothers Motions, is 8310inconceivable. And against filling the Heavens with fluid Mediums, 8311unless they be exceeding rare, a great Objection arises from the regular 8312and very lasting Motions of the Planets and Comets in all manner of 8313Courses through the Heavens. For thence it is manifest, that the Heavens 8314are void of all sensible Resistance, and by consequence of all sensible 8315Matter. 8316 8317For the resisting Power of fluid Mediums arises partly from the 8318Attrition of the Parts of the Medium, and partly from the _Vis inertiæ_ 8319of the Matter. That part of the Resistance of a spherical Body which 8320arises from the Attrition of the Parts of the Medium is very nearly as 8321the Diameter, or, at the most, as the _Factum_ of the Diameter, and the 8322Velocity of the spherical Body together. And that part of the Resistance 8323which arises from the _Vis inertiæ_ of the Matter, is as the Square of 8324that _Factum_. And by this difference the two sorts of Resistance may be 8325distinguish'd from one another in any Medium; and these being 8326distinguish'd, it will be found that almost all the Resistance of Bodies 8327of a competent Magnitude moving in Air, Water, Quick-silver, and such 8328like Fluids with a competent Velocity, arises from the _Vis inertiæ_ of 8329the Parts of the Fluid. 8330 8331Now that part of the resisting Power of any Medium which arises from the 8332Tenacity, Friction or Attrition of the Parts of the Medium, may be 8333diminish'd by dividing the Matter into smaller Parts, and making the 8334Parts more smooth and slippery: But that part of the Resistance which 8335arises from the _Vis inertiæ_, is proportional to the Density of the 8336Matter, and cannot be diminish'd by dividing the Matter into smaller 8337Parts, nor by any other means than by decreasing the Density of the 8338Medium. And for these Reasons the Density of fluid Mediums is very 8339nearly proportional to their Resistance. Liquors which differ not much 8340in Density, as Water, Spirit of Wine, Spirit of Turpentine, hot Oil, 8341differ not much in Resistance. Water is thirteen or fourteen times 8342lighter than Quick-silver and by consequence thirteen or fourteen times 8343rarer, and its Resistance is less than that of Quick-silver in the same 8344Proportion, or thereabouts, as I have found by Experiments made with 8345Pendulums. The open Air in which we breathe is eight or nine hundred 8346times lighter than Water, and by consequence eight or nine hundred times 8347rarer, and accordingly its Resistance is less than that of Water in the 8348same Proportion, or thereabouts; as I have also found by Experiments 8349made with Pendulums. And in thinner Air the Resistance is still less, 8350and at length, by ratifying the Air, becomes insensible. For small 8351Feathers falling in the open Air meet with great Resistance, but in a 8352tall Glass well emptied of Air, they fall as fast as Lead or Gold, as I 8353have seen tried several times. Whence the Resistance seems still to 8354decrease in proportion to the Density of the Fluid. For I do not find by 8355any Experiments, that Bodies moving in Quick-silver, Water or Air, meet 8356with any other sensible Resistance than what arises from the Density and 8357Tenacity of those sensible Fluids, as they would do if the Pores of 8358those Fluids, and all other Spaces, were filled with a dense and 8359subtile Fluid. Now if the Resistance in a Vessel well emptied of Air, 8360was but an hundred times less than in the open Air, it would be about a 8361million of times less than in Quick-silver. But it seems to be much less 8362in such a Vessel, and still much less in the Heavens, at the height of 8363three or four hundred Miles from the Earth, or above. For Mr. _Boyle_ 8364has shew'd that Air may be rarified above ten thousand times in Vessels 8365of Glass; and the Heavens are much emptier of Air than any _Vacuum_ we 8366can make below. For since the Air is compress'd by the Weight of the 8367incumbent Atmosphere, and the Density of Air is proportional to the 8368Force compressing it, it follows by Computation, that at the height of 8369about seven and a half _English_ Miles from the Earth, the Air is four 8370times rarer than at the Surface of the Earth; and at the height of 15 8371Miles it is sixteen times rarer than that at the Surface of the Earth; 8372and at the height of 22-1/2, 30, or 38 Miles, it is respectively 64, 8373256, or 1024 times rarer, or thereabouts; and at the height of 76, 152, 8374228 Miles, it is about 1000000, 1000000000000, or 1000000000000000000 8375times rarer; and so on. 8376 8377Heat promotes Fluidity very much by diminishing the Tenacity of Bodies. 8378It makes many Bodies fluid which are not fluid in cold, and increases 8379the Fluidity of tenacious Liquids, as of Oil, Balsam, and Honey, and 8380thereby decreases their Resistance. But it decreases not the Resistance 8381of Water considerably, as it would do if any considerable part of the 8382Resistance of Water arose from the Attrition or Tenacity of its Parts. 8383And therefore the Resistance of Water arises principally and almost 8384entirely from the _Vis inertiæ_ of its Matter; and by consequence, if 8385the Heavens were as dense as Water, they would not have much less 8386Resistance than Water; if as dense as Quick-silver, they would not have 8387much less Resistance than Quick-silver; if absolutely dense, or full of 8388Matter without any _Vacuum_, let the Matter be never so subtil and 8389fluid, they would have a greater Resistance than Quick-silver. A solid 8390Globe in such a Medium would lose above half its Motion in moving three 8391times the length of its Diameter, and a Globe not solid (such as are the 8392Planets,) would be retarded sooner. And therefore to make way for the 8393regular and lasting Motions of the Planets and Comets, it's necessary to 8394empty the Heavens of all Matter, except perhaps some very thin Vapours, 8395Steams, or Effluvia, arising from the Atmospheres of the Earth, Planets, 8396and Comets, and from such an exceedingly rare Æthereal Medium as we 8397described above. A dense Fluid can be of no use for explaining the 8398Phænomena of Nature, the Motions of the Planets and Comets being better 8399explain'd without it. It serves only to disturb and retard the Motions 8400of those great Bodies, and make the Frame of Nature languish: And in the 8401Pores of Bodies, it serves only to stop the vibrating Motions of their 8402Parts, wherein their Heat and Activity consists. And as it is of no use, 8403and hinders the Operations of Nature, and makes her languish, so there 8404is no evidence for its Existence, and therefore it ought to be rejected. 8405And if it be rejected, the Hypotheses that Light consists in Pression 8406or Motion, propagated through such a Medium, are rejected with it. 8407 8408And for rejecting such a Medium, we have the Authority of those the 8409oldest and most celebrated Philosophers of _Greece_ and _Phoenicia_, 8410who made a _Vacuum_, and Atoms, and the Gravity of Atoms, the first 8411Principles of their Philosophy; tacitly attributing Gravity to some 8412other Cause than dense Matter. Later Philosophers banish the 8413Consideration of such a Cause out of natural Philosophy, feigning 8414Hypotheses for explaining all things mechanically, and referring other 8415Causes to Metaphysicks: Whereas the main Business of natural Philosophy 8416is to argue from Phænomena without feigning Hypotheses, and to deduce 8417Causes from Effects, till we come to the very first Cause, which 8418certainly is not mechanical; and not only to unfold the Mechanism of the 8419World, but chiefly to resolve these and such like Questions. What is 8420there in places almost empty of Matter, and whence is it that the Sun 8421and Planets gravitate towards one another, without dense Matter between 8422them? Whence is it that Nature doth nothing in vain; and whence arises 8423all that Order and Beauty which we see in the World? To what end are 8424Comets, and whence is it that Planets move all one and the same way in 8425Orbs concentrick, while Comets move all manner of ways in Orbs very 8426excentrick; and what hinders the fix'd Stars from falling upon one 8427another? How came the Bodies of Animals to be contrived with so much 8428Art, and for what ends were their several Parts? Was the Eye contrived 8429without Skill in Opticks, and the Ear without Knowledge of Sounds? How 8430do the Motions of the Body follow from the Will, and whence is the 8431Instinct in Animals? Is not the Sensory of Animals that place to which 8432the sensitive Substance is present, and into which the sensible Species 8433of Things are carried through the Nerves and Brain, that there they may 8434be perceived by their immediate presence to that Substance? And these 8435things being rightly dispatch'd, does it not appear from Phænomena that 8436there is a Being incorporeal, living, intelligent, omnipresent, who in 8437infinite Space, as it were in his Sensory, sees the things themselves 8438intimately, and throughly perceives them, and comprehends them wholly by 8439their immediate presence to himself: Of which things the Images only 8440carried through the Organs of Sense into our little Sensoriums, are 8441there seen and beheld by that which in us perceives and thinks. And 8442though every true Step made in this Philosophy brings us not immediately 8443to the Knowledge of the first Cause, yet it brings us nearer to it, and 8444on that account is to be highly valued. 8445 8446_Qu._ 29. Are not the Rays of Light very small Bodies emitted from 8447shining Substances? For such Bodies will pass through uniform Mediums in 8448right Lines without bending into the Shadow, which is the Nature of the 8449Rays of Light. They will also be capable of several Properties, and be 8450able to conserve their Properties unchanged in passing through several 8451Mediums, which is another Condition of the Rays of Light. Pellucid 8452Substances act upon the Rays of Light at a distance in refracting, 8453reflecting, and inflecting them, and the Rays mutually agitate the Parts 8454of those Substances at a distance for heating them; and this Action and 8455Re-action at a distance very much resembles an attractive Force between 8456Bodies. If Refraction be perform'd by Attraction of the Rays, the Sines 8457of Incidence must be to the Sines of Refraction in a given Proportion, 8458as we shew'd in our Principles of Philosophy: And this Rule is true by 8459Experience. The Rays of Light in going out of Glass into a _Vacuum_, are 8460bent towards the Glass; and if they fall too obliquely on the _Vacuum_, 8461they are bent backwards into the Glass, and totally reflected; and this 8462Reflexion cannot be ascribed to the Resistance of an absolute _Vacuum_, 8463but must be caused by the Power of the Glass attracting the Rays at 8464their going out of it into the _Vacuum_, and bringing them back. For if 8465the farther Surface of the Glass be moisten'd with Water or clear Oil, 8466or liquid and clear Honey, the Rays which would otherwise be reflected 8467will go into the Water, Oil, or Honey; and therefore are not reflected 8468before they arrive at the farther Surface of the Glass, and begin to go 8469out of it. If they go out of it into the Water, Oil, or Honey, they go 8470on, because the Attraction of the Glass is almost balanced and rendered 8471ineffectual by the contrary Attraction of the Liquor. But if they go out 8472of it into a _Vacuum_ which has no Attraction to balance that of the 8473Glass, the Attraction of the Glass either bends and refracts them, or 8474brings them back and reflects them. And this is still more evident by 8475laying together two Prisms of Glass, or two Object-glasses of very long 8476Telescopes, the one plane, the other a little convex, and so compressing 8477them that they do not fully touch, nor are too far asunder. For the 8478Light which falls upon the farther Surface of the first Glass where the 8479Interval between the Glasses is not above the ten hundred thousandth 8480Part of an Inch, will go through that Surface, and through the Air or 8481_Vacuum_ between the Glasses, and enter into the second Glass, as was 8482explain'd in the first, fourth, and eighth Observations of the first 8483Part of the second Book. But, if the second Glass be taken away, the 8484Light which goes out of the second Surface of the first Glass into the 8485Air or _Vacuum_, will not go on forwards, but turns back into the first 8486Glass, and is reflected; and therefore it is drawn back by the Power of 8487the first Glass, there being nothing else to turn it back. Nothing more 8488is requisite for producing all the variety of Colours, and degrees of 8489Refrangibility, than that the Rays of Light be Bodies of different 8490Sizes, the least of which may take violet the weakest and darkest of the 8491Colours, and be more easily diverted by refracting Surfaces from the 8492right Course; and the rest as they are bigger and bigger, may make the 8493stronger and more lucid Colours, blue, green, yellow, and red, and be 8494more and more difficultly diverted. Nothing more is requisite for 8495putting the Rays of Light into Fits of easy Reflexion and easy 8496Transmission, than that they be small Bodies which by their attractive 8497Powers, or some other Force, stir up Vibrations in what they act upon, 8498which Vibrations being swifter than the Rays, overtake them 8499successively, and agitate them so as by turns to increase and decrease 8500their Velocities, and thereby put them into those Fits. And lastly, the 8501unusual Refraction of Island-Crystal looks very much as if it were 8502perform'd by some kind of attractive virtue lodged in certain Sides both 8503of the Rays, and of the Particles of the Crystal. For were it not for 8504some kind of Disposition or Virtue lodged in some Sides of the Particles 8505of the Crystal, and not in their other Sides, and which inclines and 8506bends the Rays towards the Coast of unusual Refraction, the Rays which 8507fall perpendicularly on the Crystal, would not be refracted towards that 8508Coast rather than towards any other Coast, both at their Incidence and 8509at their Emergence, so as to emerge perpendicularly by a contrary 8510Situation of the Coast of unusual Refraction at the second Surface; the 8511Crystal acting upon the Rays after they have pass'd through it, and are 8512emerging into the Air; or, if you please, into a _Vacuum_. And since the 8513Crystal by this Disposition or Virtue does not act upon the Rays, unless 8514when one of their Sides of unusual Refraction looks towards that Coast, 8515this argues a Virtue or Disposition in those Sides of the Rays, which 8516answers to, and sympathizes with that Virtue or Disposition of the 8517Crystal, as the Poles of two Magnets answer to one another. And as 8518Magnetism may be intended and remitted, and is found only in the Magnet 8519and in Iron: So this Virtue of refracting the perpendicular Rays is 8520greater in Island-Crystal, less in Crystal of the Rock, and is not yet 8521found in other Bodies. I do not say that this Virtue is magnetical: It 8522seems to be of another kind. I only say, that whatever it be, it's 8523difficult to conceive how the Rays of Light, unless they be Bodies, can 8524have a permanent Virtue in two of their Sides which is not in their 8525other Sides, and this without any regard to their Position to the Space 8526or Medium through which they pass. 8527 8528What I mean in this Question by a _Vacuum_, and by the Attractions of 8529the Rays of Light towards Glass or Crystal, may be understood by what 8530was said in the 18th, 19th, and 20th Questions. 8531 8532_Quest._ 30. Are not gross Bodies and Light convertible into one 8533another, and may not Bodies receive much of their Activity from the 8534Particles of Light which enter their Composition? For all fix'd Bodies 8535being heated emit Light so long as they continue sufficiently hot, and 8536Light mutually stops in Bodies as often as its Rays strike upon their 8537Parts, as we shew'd above. I know no Body less apt to shine than Water; 8538and yet Water by frequent Distillations changes into fix'd Earth, as Mr. 8539_Boyle_ has try'd; and then this Earth being enabled to endure a 8540sufficient Heat, shines by Heat like other Bodies. 8541 8542The changing of Bodies into Light, and Light into Bodies, is very 8543conformable to the Course of Nature, which seems delighted with 8544Transmutations. Water, which is a very fluid tasteless Salt, she changes 8545by Heat into Vapour, which is a sort of Air, and by Cold into Ice, which 8546is a hard, pellucid, brittle, fusible Stone; and this Stone returns into 8547Water by Heat, and Vapour returns into Water by Cold. Earth by Heat 8548becomes Fire, and by Cold returns into Earth. Dense Bodies by 8549Fermentation rarify into several sorts of Air, and this Air by 8550Fermentation, and sometimes without it, returns into dense Bodies. 8551Mercury appears sometimes in the form of a fluid Metal, sometimes in the 8552form of a hard brittle Metal, sometimes in the form of a corrosive 8553pellucid Salt call'd Sublimate, sometimes in the form of a tasteless, 8554pellucid, volatile white Earth, call'd _Mercurius Dulcis_; or in that of 8555a red opake volatile Earth, call'd Cinnaber; or in that of a red or 8556white Precipitate, or in that of a fluid Salt; and in Distillation it 8557turns into Vapour, and being agitated _in Vacuo_, it shines like Fire. 8558And after all these Changes it returns again into its first form of 8559Mercury. Eggs grow from insensible Magnitudes, and change into Animals; 8560Tadpoles into Frogs; and Worms into Flies. All Birds, Beasts and Fishes, 8561Insects, Trees, and other Vegetables, with their several Parts, grow out 8562of Water and watry Tinctures and Salts, and by Putrefaction return again 8563into watry Substances. And Water standing a few Days in the open Air, 8564yields a Tincture, which (like that of Malt) by standing longer yields a 8565Sediment and a Spirit, but before Putrefaction is fit Nourishment for 8566Animals and Vegetables. And among such various and strange 8567Transmutations, why may not Nature change Bodies into Light, and Light 8568into Bodies? 8569 8570_Quest._ 31. Have not the small Particles of Bodies certain Powers, 8571Virtues, or Forces, by which they act at a distance, not only upon the 8572Rays of Light for reflecting, refracting, and inflecting them, but also 8573upon one another for producing a great Part of the Phænomena of Nature? 8574For it's well known, that Bodies act one upon another by the Attractions 8575of Gravity, Magnetism, and Electricity; and these Instances shew the 8576Tenor and Course of Nature, and make it not improbable but that there 8577may be more attractive Powers than these. For Nature is very consonant 8578and conformable to her self. How these Attractions may be perform'd, I 8579do not here consider. What I call Attraction may be perform'd by 8580impulse, or by some other means unknown to me. I use that Word here to 8581signify only in general any Force by which Bodies tend towards one 8582another, whatsoever be the Cause. For we must learn from the Phænomena 8583of Nature what Bodies attract one another, and what are the Laws and 8584Properties of the Attraction, before we enquire the Cause by which the 8585Attraction is perform'd. The Attractions of Gravity, Magnetism, and 8586Electricity, reach to very sensible distances, and so have been observed 8587by vulgar Eyes, and there may be others which reach to so small 8588distances as hitherto escape Observation; and perhaps electrical 8589Attraction may reach to such small distances, even without being excited 8590by Friction. 8591 8592For when Salt of Tartar runs _per Deliquium_, is not this done by an 8593Attraction between the Particles of the Salt of Tartar, and the 8594Particles of the Water which float in the Air in the form of Vapours? 8595And why does not common Salt, or Salt-petre, or Vitriol, run _per 8596Deliquium_, but for want of such an Attraction? Or why does not Salt of 8597Tartar draw more Water out of the Air than in a certain Proportion to 8598its quantity, but for want of an attractive Force after it is satiated 8599with Water? And whence is it but from this attractive Power that Water 8600which alone distils with a gentle luke-warm Heat, will not distil from 8601Salt of Tartar without a great Heat? And is it not from the like 8602attractive Power between the Particles of Oil of Vitriol and the 8603Particles of Water, that Oil of Vitriol draws to it a good quantity of 8604Water out of the Air, and after it is satiated draws no more, and in 8605Distillation lets go the Water very difficultly? And when Water and Oil 8606of Vitriol poured successively into the same Vessel grow very hot in the 8607mixing, does not this Heat argue a great Motion in the Parts of the 8608Liquors? And does not this Motion argue, that the Parts of the two 8609Liquors in mixing coalesce with Violence, and by consequence rush 8610towards one another with an accelerated Motion? And when _Aqua fortis_, 8611or Spirit of Vitriol poured upon Filings of Iron dissolves the Filings 8612with a great Heat and Ebullition, is not this Heat and Ebullition 8613effected by a violent Motion of the Parts, and does not that Motion 8614argue that the acid Parts of the Liquor rush towards the Parts of the 8615Metal with violence, and run forcibly into its Pores till they get 8616between its outmost Particles, and the main Mass of the Metal, and 8617surrounding those Particles loosen them from the main Mass, and set them 8618at liberty to float off into the Water? And when the acid Particles, 8619which alone would distil with an easy Heat, will not separate from the 8620Particles of the Metal without a very violent Heat, does not this 8621confirm the Attraction between them? 8622 8623When Spirit of Vitriol poured upon common Salt or Salt-petre makes an 8624Ebullition with the Salt, and unites with it, and in Distillation the 8625Spirit of the common Salt or Salt-petre comes over much easier than it 8626would do before, and the acid part of the Spirit of Vitriol stays 8627behind; does not this argue that the fix'd Alcaly of the Salt attracts 8628the acid Spirit of the Vitriol more strongly than its own Spirit, and 8629not being able to hold them both, lets go its own? And when Oil of 8630Vitriol is drawn off from its weight of Nitre, and from both the 8631Ingredients a compound Spirit of Nitre is distilled, and two parts of 8632this Spirit are poured on one part of Oil of Cloves or Carraway Seeds, 8633or of any ponderous Oil of vegetable or animal Substances, or Oil of 8634Turpentine thicken'd with a little Balsam of Sulphur, and the Liquors 8635grow so very hot in mixing, as presently to send up a burning Flame; 8636does not this very great and sudden Heat argue that the two Liquors mix 8637with violence, and that their Parts in mixing run towards one another 8638with an accelerated Motion, and clash with the greatest Force? And is it 8639not for the same reason that well rectified Spirit of Wine poured on the 8640same compound Spirit flashes; and that the _Pulvis fulminans_, composed 8641of Sulphur, Nitre, and Salt of Tartar, goes off with a more sudden and 8642violent Explosion than Gun-powder, the acid Spirits of the Sulphur and 8643Nitre rushing towards one another, and towards the Salt of Tartar, with 8644so great a violence, as by the shock to turn the whole at once into 8645Vapour and Flame? Where the Dissolution is slow, it makes a slow 8646Ebullition and a gentle Heat; and where it is quicker, it makes a 8647greater Ebullition with more heat; and where it is done at once, the 8648Ebullition is contracted into a sudden Blast or violent Explosion, with 8649a heat equal to that of Fire and Flame. So when a Drachm of the 8650above-mention'd compound Spirit of Nitre was poured upon half a Drachm 8651of Oil of Carraway Seeds _in vacuo_, the Mixture immediately made a 8652flash like Gun-powder, and burst the exhausted Receiver, which was a 8653Glass six Inches wide, and eight Inches deep. And even the gross Body of 8654Sulphur powder'd, and with an equal weight of Iron Filings and a little 8655Water made into Paste, acts upon the Iron, and in five or six hours 8656grows too hot to be touch'd, and emits a Flame. And by these Experiments 8657compared with the great quantity of Sulphur with which the Earth 8658abounds, and the warmth of the interior Parts of the Earth, and hot 8659Springs, and burning Mountains, and with Damps, mineral Coruscations, 8660Earthquakes, hot suffocating Exhalations, Hurricanes, and Spouts; we may 8661learn that sulphureous Steams abound in the Bowels of the Earth and 8662ferment with Minerals, and sometimes take fire with a sudden Coruscation 8663and Explosion; and if pent up in subterraneous Caverns, burst the 8664Caverns with a great shaking of the Earth, as in springing of a Mine. 8665And then the Vapour generated by the Explosion, expiring through the 8666Pores of the Earth, feels hot and suffocates, and makes Tempests and 8667Hurricanes, and sometimes causes the Land to slide, or the Sea to boil, 8668and carries up the Water thereof in Drops, which by their weight fall 8669down again in Spouts. Also some sulphureous Steams, at all times when 8670the Earth is dry, ascending into the Air, ferment there with nitrous 8671Acids, and sometimes taking fire cause Lightning and Thunder, and fiery 8672Meteors. For the Air abounds with acid Vapours fit to promote 8673Fermentations, as appears by the rusting of Iron and Copper in it, the 8674kindling of Fire by blowing, and the beating of the Heart by means of 8675Respiration. Now the above-mention'd Motions are so great and violent as 8676to shew that in Fermentations the Particles of Bodies which almost rest, 8677are put into new Motions by a very potent Principle, which acts upon 8678them only when they approach one another, and causes them to meet and 8679clash with great violence, and grow hot with the motion, and dash one 8680another into pieces, and vanish into Air, and Vapour, and Flame. 8681 8682When Salt of Tartar _per deliquium_, being poured into the Solution of 8683any Metal, precipitates the Metal and makes it fall down to the bottom 8684of the Liquor in the form of Mud: Does not this argue that the acid 8685Particles are attracted more strongly by the Salt of Tartar than by the 8686Metal, and by the stronger Attraction go from the Metal to the Salt of 8687Tartar? And so when a Solution of Iron in _Aqua fortis_ dissolves the 8688_Lapis Calaminaris_, and lets go the Iron, or a Solution of Copper 8689dissolves Iron immersed in it and lets go the Copper, or a Solution of 8690Silver dissolves Copper and lets go the Silver, or a Solution of Mercury 8691in _Aqua fortis_ being poured upon Iron, Copper, Tin, or Lead, dissolves 8692the Metal and lets go the Mercury; does not this argue that the acid 8693Particles of the _Aqua fortis_ are attracted more strongly by the _Lapis 8694Calaminaris_ than by Iron, and more strongly by Iron than by Copper, and 8695more strongly by Copper than by Silver, and more strongly by Iron, 8696Copper, Tin, and Lead, than by Mercury? And is it not for the same 8697reason that Iron requires more _Aqua fortis_ to dissolve it than Copper, 8698and Copper more than the other Metals; and that of all Metals, Iron is 8699dissolved most easily, and is most apt to rust; and next after Iron, 8700Copper? 8701 8702When Oil of Vitriol is mix'd with a little Water, or is run _per 8703deliquium_, and in Distillation the Water ascends difficultly, and 8704brings over with it some part of the Oil of Vitriol in the form of 8705Spirit of Vitriol, and this Spirit being poured upon Iron, Copper, or 8706Salt of Tartar, unites with the Body and lets go the Water; doth not 8707this shew that the acid Spirit is attracted by the Water, and more 8708attracted by the fix'd Body than by the Water, and therefore lets go the 8709Water to close with the fix'd Body? And is it not for the same reason 8710that the Water and acid Spirits which are mix'd together in Vinegar, 8711_Aqua fortis_, and Spirit of Salt, cohere and rise together in 8712Distillation; but if the _Menstruum_ be poured on Salt of Tartar, or on 8713Lead, or Iron, or any fix'd Body which it can dissolve, the Acid by a 8714stronger Attraction adheres to the Body, and lets go the Water? And is 8715it not also from a mutual Attraction that the Spirits of Soot and 8716Sea-Salt unite and compose the Particles of Sal-armoniac, which are less 8717volatile than before, because grosser and freer from Water; and that the 8718Particles of Sal-armoniac in Sublimation carry up the Particles of 8719Antimony, which will not sublime alone; and that the Particles of 8720Mercury uniting with the acid Particles of Spirit of Salt compose 8721Mercury sublimate, and with the Particles of Sulphur, compose Cinnaber; 8722and that the Particles of Spirit of Wine and Spirit of Urine well 8723rectified unite, and letting go the Water which dissolved them, compose 8724a consistent Body; and that in subliming Cinnaber from Salt of Tartar, 8725or from quick Lime, the Sulphur by a stronger Attraction of the Salt or 8726Lime lets go the Mercury, and stays with the fix'd Body; and that when 8727Mercury sublimate is sublimed from Antimony, or from Regulus of 8728Antimony, the Spirit of Salt lets go the Mercury, and unites with the 8729antimonial metal which attracts it more strongly, and stays with it till 8730the Heat be great enough to make them both ascend together, and then 8731carries up the Metal with it in the form of a very fusible Salt, called 8732Butter of Antimony, although the Spirit of Salt alone be almost as 8733volatile as Water, and the Antimony alone as fix'd as Lead? 8734 8735When _Aqua fortis_ dissolves Silver and not Gold, and _Aqua regia_ 8736dissolves Gold and not Silver, may it not be said that _Aqua fortis_ is 8737subtil enough to penetrate Gold as well as Silver, but wants the 8738attractive Force to give it Entrance; and that _Aqua regia_ is subtil 8739enough to penetrate Silver as well as Gold, but wants the attractive 8740Force to give it Entrance? For _Aqua regia_ is nothing else than _Aqua 8741fortis_ mix'd with some Spirit of Salt, or with Sal-armoniac; and even 8742common Salt dissolved in _Aqua fortis_, enables the _Menstruum_ to 8743dissolve Gold, though the Salt be a gross Body. When therefore Spirit of 8744Salt precipitates Silver out of _Aqua fortis_, is it not done by 8745attracting and mixing with the _Aqua fortis_, and not attracting, or 8746perhaps repelling Silver? And when Water precipitates Antimony out of 8747the Sublimate of Antimony and Sal-armoniac, or out of Butter of 8748Antimony, is it not done by its dissolving, mixing with, and weakening 8749the Sal-armoniac or Spirit of Salt, and its not attracting, or perhaps 8750repelling the Antimony? And is it not for want of an attractive virtue 8751between the Parts of Water and Oil, of Quick-silver and Antimony, of 8752Lead and Iron, that these Substances do not mix; and by a weak 8753Attraction, that Quick-silver and Copper mix difficultly; and from a 8754strong one, that Quick-silver and Tin, Antimony and Iron, Water and 8755Salts, mix readily? And in general, is it not from the same Principle 8756that Heat congregates homogeneal Bodies, and separates heterogeneal 8757ones? 8758 8759When Arsenick with Soap gives a Regulus, and with Mercury sublimate a 8760volatile fusible Salt, like Butter of Antimony, doth not this shew that 8761Arsenick, which is a Substance totally volatile, is compounded of fix'd 8762and volatile Parts, strongly cohering by a mutual Attraction, so that 8763the volatile will not ascend without carrying up the fixed? And so, when 8764an equal weight of Spirit of Wine and Oil of Vitriol are digested 8765together, and in Distillation yield two fragrant and volatile Spirits 8766which will not mix with one another, and a fix'd black Earth remains 8767behind; doth not this shew that Oil of Vitriol is composed of volatile 8768and fix'd Parts strongly united by Attraction, so as to ascend together 8769in form of a volatile, acid, fluid Salt, until the Spirit of Wine 8770attracts and separates the volatile Parts from the fixed? And therefore, 8771since Oil of Sulphur _per Campanam_ is of the same Nature with Oil of 8772Vitriol, may it not be inferred, that Sulphur is also a mixture of 8773volatile and fix'd Parts so strongly cohering by Attraction, as to 8774ascend together in Sublimation. By dissolving Flowers of Sulphur in Oil 8775of Turpentine, and distilling the Solution, it is found that Sulphur is 8776composed of an inflamable thick Oil or fat Bitumen, an acid Salt, a very 8777fix'd Earth, and a little Metal. The three first were found not much 8778unequal to one another, the fourth in so small a quantity as scarce to 8779be worth considering. The acid Salt dissolved in Water, is the same with 8780Oil of Sulphur _per Campanam_, and abounding much in the Bowels of the 8781Earth, and particularly in Markasites, unites it self to the other 8782Ingredients of the Markasite, which are, Bitumen, Iron, Copper, and 8783Earth, and with them compounds Allum, Vitriol, and Sulphur. With the 8784Earth alone it compounds Allum; with the Metal alone, or Metal and 8785Earth together, it compounds Vitriol; and with the Bitumen and Earth it 8786compounds Sulphur. Whence it comes to pass that Markasites abound with 8787those three Minerals. And is it not from the mutual Attraction of the 8788Ingredients that they stick together for compounding these Minerals, and 8789that the Bitumen carries up the other Ingredients of the Sulphur, which 8790without it would not sublime? And the same Question may be put 8791concerning all, or almost all the gross Bodies in Nature. For all the 8792Parts of Animals and Vegetables are composed of Substances volatile and 8793fix'd, fluid and solid, as appears by their Analysis; and so are Salts 8794and Minerals, so far as Chymists have been hitherto able to examine 8795their Composition. 8796 8797When Mercury sublimate is re-sublimed with fresh Mercury, and becomes 8798_Mercurius Dulcis_, which is a white tasteless Earth scarce dissolvable 8799in Water, and _Mercurius Dulcis_ re-sublimed with Spirit of Salt returns 8800into Mercury sublimate; and when Metals corroded with a little acid turn 8801into rust, which is an Earth tasteless and indissolvable in Water, and 8802this Earth imbibed with more acid becomes a metallick Salt; and when 8803some Stones, as Spar of Lead, dissolved in proper _Menstruums_ become 8804Salts; do not these things shew that Salts are dry Earth and watry Acid 8805united by Attraction, and that the Earth will not become a Salt without 8806so much acid as makes it dissolvable in Water? Do not the sharp and 8807pungent Tastes of Acids arise from the strong Attraction whereby the 8808acid Particles rush upon and agitate the Particles of the Tongue? And 8809when Metals are dissolved in acid _Menstruums_, and the Acids in 8810conjunction with the Metal act after a different manner, so that the 8811Compound has a different Taste much milder than before, and sometimes a 8812sweet one; is it not because the Acids adhere to the metallick 8813Particles, and thereby lose much of their Activity? And if the Acid be 8814in too small a Proportion to make the Compound dissolvable in Water, 8815will it not by adhering strongly to the Metal become unactive and lose 8816its Taste, and the Compound be a tasteless Earth? For such things as are 8817not dissolvable by the Moisture of the Tongue, act not upon the Taste. 8818 8819As Gravity makes the Sea flow round the denser and weightier Parts of 8820the Globe of the Earth, so the Attraction may make the watry Acid flow 8821round the denser and compacter Particles of Earth for composing the 8822Particles of Salt. For otherwise the Acid would not do the Office of a 8823Medium between the Earth and common Water, for making Salts dissolvable 8824in the Water; nor would Salt of Tartar readily draw off the Acid from 8825dissolved Metals, nor Metals the Acid from Mercury. Now, as in the great 8826Globe of the Earth and Sea, the densest Bodies by their Gravity sink 8827down in Water, and always endeavour to go towards the Center of the 8828Globe; so in Particles of Salt, the densest Matter may always endeavour 8829to approach the Center of the Particle: So that a Particle of Salt may 8830be compared to a Chaos; being dense, hard, dry, and earthy in the 8831Center; and rare, soft, moist, and watry in the Circumference. And 8832hence it seems to be that Salts are of a lasting Nature, being scarce 8833destroy'd, unless by drawing away their watry Parts by violence, or by 8834letting them soak into the Pores of the central Earth by a gentle Heat 8835in Putrefaction, until the Earth be dissolved by the Water, and 8836separated into smaller Particles, which by reason of their Smallness 8837make the rotten Compound appear of a black Colour. Hence also it may be, 8838that the Parts of Animals and Vegetables preserve their several Forms, 8839and assimilate their Nourishment; the soft and moist Nourishment easily 8840changing its Texture by a gentle Heat and Motion, till it becomes like 8841the dense, hard, dry, and durable Earth in the Center of each Particle. 8842But when the Nourishment grows unfit to be assimilated, or the central 8843Earth grows too feeble to assimilate it, the Motion ends in Confusion, 8844Putrefaction, and Death. 8845 8846If a very small quantity of any Salt or Vitriol be dissolved in a great 8847quantity of Water, the Particles of the Salt or Vitriol will not sink to 8848the bottom, though they be heavier in Specie than the Water, but will 8849evenly diffuse themselves into all the Water, so as to make it as saline 8850at the top as at the bottom. And does not this imply that the Parts of 8851the Salt or Vitriol recede from one another, and endeavour to expand 8852themselves, and get as far asunder as the quantity of Water in which 8853they float, will allow? And does not this Endeavour imply that they have 8854a repulsive Force by which they fly from one another, or at least, that 8855they attract the Water more strongly than they do one another? For as 8856all things ascend in Water which are less attracted than Water, by the 8857gravitating Power of the Earth; so all the Particles of Salt which float 8858in Water, and are less attracted than Water by any one Particle of Salt, 8859must recede from that Particle, and give way to the more attracted 8860Water. 8861 8862When any saline Liquor is evaporated to a Cuticle and let cool, the Salt 8863concretes in regular Figures; which argues, that the Particles of the 8864Salt before they concreted, floated in the Liquor at equal distances in 8865rank and file, and by consequence that they acted upon one another by 8866some Power which at equal distances is equal, at unequal distances 8867unequal. For by such a Power they will range themselves uniformly, and 8868without it they will float irregularly, and come together as 8869irregularly. And since the Particles of Island-Crystal act all the same 8870way upon the Rays of Light for causing the unusual Refraction, may it 8871not be supposed that in the Formation of this Crystal, the Particles not 8872only ranged themselves in rank and file for concreting in regular 8873Figures, but also by some kind of polar Virtue turned their homogeneal 8874Sides the same way. 8875 8876The Parts of all homogeneal hard Bodies which fully touch one another, 8877stick together very strongly. And for explaining how this may be, some 8878have invented hooked Atoms, which is begging the Question; and others 8879tell us that Bodies are glued together by rest, that is, by an occult 8880Quality, or rather by nothing; and others, that they stick together by 8881conspiring Motions, that is, by relative rest amongst themselves. I had 8882rather infer from their Cohesion, that their Particles attract one 8883another by some Force, which in immediate Contact is exceeding strong, 8884at small distances performs the chymical Operations above-mention'd, and 8885reaches not far from the Particles with any sensible Effect. 8886 8887All Bodies seem to be composed of hard Particles: For otherwise Fluids 8888would not congeal; as Water, Oils, Vinegar, and Spirit or Oil of Vitriol 8889do by freezing; Mercury by Fumes of Lead; Spirit of Nitre and Mercury, 8890by dissolving the Mercury and evaporating the Flegm; Spirit of Wine and 8891Spirit of Urine, by deflegming and mixing them; and Spirit of Urine and 8892Spirit of Salt, by subliming them together to make Sal-armoniac. Even 8893the Rays of Light seem to be hard Bodies; for otherwise they would not 8894retain different Properties in their different Sides. And therefore 8895Hardness may be reckon'd the Property of all uncompounded Matter. At 8896least, this seems to be as evident as the universal Impenetrability of 8897Matter. For all Bodies, so far as Experience reaches, are either hard, 8898or may be harden'd; and we have no other Evidence of universal 8899Impenetrability, besides a large Experience without an experimental 8900Exception. Now if compound Bodies are so very hard as we find some of 8901them to be, and yet are very porous, and consist of Parts which are only 8902laid together; the simple Particles which are void of Pores, and were 8903never yet divided, must be much harder. For such hard Particles being 8904heaped up together, can scarce touch one another in more than a few 8905Points, and therefore must be separable by much less Force than is 8906requisite to break a solid Particle, whose Parts touch in all the Space 8907between them, without any Pores or Interstices to weaken their Cohesion. 8908And how such very hard Particles which are only laid together and touch 8909only in a few Points, can stick together, and that so firmly as they do, 8910without the assistance of something which causes them to be attracted or 8911press'd towards one another, is very difficult to conceive. 8912 8913The same thing I infer also from the cohering of two polish'd Marbles 8914_in vacuo_, and from the standing of Quick-silver in the Barometer at 8915the height of 50, 60 or 70 Inches, or above, when ever it is well-purged 8916of Air and carefully poured in, so that its Parts be every where 8917contiguous both to one another and to the Glass. The Atmosphere by its 8918weight presses the Quick-silver into the Glass, to the height of 29 or 891930 Inches. And some other Agent raises it higher, not by pressing it 8920into the Glass, but by making its Parts stick to the Glass, and to one 8921another. For upon any discontinuation of Parts, made either by Bubbles 8922or by shaking the Glass, the whole Mercury falls down to the height of 892329 or 30 Inches. 8924 8925And of the same kind with these Experiments are those that follow. If 8926two plane polish'd Plates of Glass (suppose two pieces of a polish'd 8927Looking-glass) be laid together, so that their sides be parallel and at 8928a very small distance from one another, and then their lower edges be 8929dipped into Water, the Water will rise up between them. And the less 8930the distance of the Glasses is, the greater will be the height to which 8931the Water will rise. If the distance be about the hundredth part of an 8932Inch, the Water will rise to the height of about an Inch; and if the 8933distance be greater or less in any Proportion, the height will be 8934reciprocally proportional to the distance very nearly. For the 8935attractive Force of the Glasses is the same, whether the distance 8936between them be greater or less; and the weight of the Water drawn up is 8937the same, if the height of it be reciprocally proportional to the 8938distance of the Glasses. And in like manner, Water ascends between two 8939Marbles polish'd plane, when their polish'd sides are parallel, and at a 8940very little distance from one another, And if slender Pipes of Glass be 8941dipped at one end into stagnating Water, the Water will rise up within 8942the Pipe, and the height to which it rises will be reciprocally 8943proportional to the Diameter of the Cavity of the Pipe, and will equal 8944the height to which it rises between two Planes of Glass, if the 8945Semi-diameter of the Cavity of the Pipe be equal to the distance between 8946the Planes, or thereabouts. And these Experiments succeed after the same 8947manner _in vacuo_ as in the open Air, (as hath been tried before the 8948Royal Society,) and therefore are not influenced by the Weight or 8949Pressure of the Atmosphere. 8950 8951And if a large Pipe of Glass be filled with sifted Ashes well pressed 8952together in the Glass, and one end of the Pipe be dipped into stagnating 8953Water, the Water will rise up slowly in the Ashes, so as in the space 8954of a Week or Fortnight to reach up within the Glass, to the height of 30 8955or 40 Inches above the stagnating Water. And the Water rises up to this 8956height by the Action only of those Particles of the Ashes which are upon 8957the Surface of the elevated Water; the Particles which are within the 8958Water, attracting or repelling it as much downwards as upwards. And 8959therefore the Action of the Particles is very strong. But the Particles 8960of the Ashes being not so dense and close together as those of Glass, 8961their Action is not so strong as that of Glass, which keeps Quick-silver 8962suspended to the height of 60 or 70 Inches, and therefore acts with a 8963Force which would keep Water suspended to the height of above 60 Feet. 8964 8965By the same Principle, a Sponge sucks in Water, and the Glands in the 8966Bodies of Animals, according to their several Natures and Dispositions, 8967suck in various Juices from the Blood. 8968 8969If two plane polish'd Plates of Glass three or four Inches broad, and 8970twenty or twenty five long, be laid one of them parallel to the Horizon, 8971the other upon the first, so as at one of their ends to touch one 8972another, and contain an Angle of about 10 or 15 Minutes, and the same be 8973first moisten'd on their inward sides with a clean Cloth dipp'd into Oil 8974of Oranges or Spirit of Turpentine, and a Drop or two of the Oil or 8975Spirit be let fall upon the lower Glass at the other; so soon as the 8976upper Glass is laid down upon the lower, so as to touch it at one end as 8977above, and to touch the Drop at the other end, making with the lower 8978Glass an Angle of about 10 or 15 Minutes; the Drop will begin to move 8979towards the Concourse of the Glasses, and will continue to move with an 8980accelerated Motion, till it arrives at that Concourse of the Glasses. 8981For the two Glasses attract the Drop, and make it run that way towards 8982which the Attractions incline. And if when the Drop is in motion you 8983lift up that end of the Glasses where they meet, and towards which the 8984Drop moves, the Drop will ascend between the Glasses, and therefore is 8985attracted. And as you lift up the Glasses more and more, the Drop will 8986ascend slower and slower, and at length rest, being then carried 8987downward by its Weight, as much as upwards by the Attraction. And by 8988this means you may know the Force by which the Drop is attracted at all 8989distances from the Concourse of the Glasses. 8990 8991Now by some Experiments of this kind, (made by Mr. _Hauksbee_) it has 8992been found that the Attraction is almost reciprocally in a duplicate 8993Proportion of the distance of the middle of the Drop from the Concourse 8994of the Glasses, _viz._ reciprocally in a simple Proportion, by reason of 8995the spreading of the Drop, and its touching each Glass in a larger 8996Surface; and again reciprocally in a simple Proportion, by reason of the 8997Attractions growing stronger within the same quantity of attracting 8998Surface. The Attraction therefore within the same quantity of attracting 8999Surface, is reciprocally as the distance between the Glasses. And 9000therefore where the distance is exceeding small, the Attraction must be 9001exceeding great. By the Table in the second Part of the second Book, 9002wherein the thicknesses of colour'd Plates of Water between two Glasses 9003are set down, the thickness of the Plate where it appears very black, is 9004three eighths of the ten hundred thousandth part of an Inch. And where 9005the Oil of Oranges between the Glasses is of this thickness, the 9006Attraction collected by the foregoing Rule, seems to be so strong, as 9007within a Circle of an Inch in diameter, to suffice to hold up a Weight 9008equal to that of a Cylinder of Water of an Inch in diameter, and two or 9009three Furlongs in length. And where it is of a less thickness the 9010Attraction may be proportionally greater, and continue to increase, 9011until the thickness do not exceed that of a single Particle of the Oil. 9012There are therefore Agents in Nature able to make the Particles of 9013Bodies stick together by very strong Attractions. And it is the Business 9014of experimental Philosophy to find them out. 9015 9016Now the smallest Particles of Matter may cohere by the strongest 9017Attractions, and compose bigger Particles of weaker Virtue; and many of 9018these may cohere and compose bigger Particles whose Virtue is still 9019weaker, and so on for divers Successions, until the Progression end in 9020the biggest Particles on which the Operations in Chymistry, and the 9021Colours of natural Bodies depend, and which by cohering compose Bodies 9022of a sensible Magnitude. If the Body is compact, and bends or yields 9023inward to Pression without any sliding of its Parts, it is hard and 9024elastick, returning to its Figure with a Force rising from the mutual 9025Attraction of its Parts. If the Parts slide upon one another, the Body 9026is malleable or soft. If they slip easily, and are of a fit Size to be 9027agitated by Heat, and the Heat is big enough to keep them in Agitation, 9028the Body is fluid; and if it be apt to stick to things, it is humid; and 9029the Drops of every fluid affect a round Figure by the mutual Attraction 9030of their Parts, as the Globe of the Earth and Sea affects a round Figure 9031by the mutual Attraction of its Parts by Gravity. 9032 9033Since Metals dissolved in Acids attract but a small quantity of the 9034Acid, their attractive Force can reach but to a small distance from 9035them. And as in Algebra, where affirmative Quantities vanish and cease, 9036there negative ones begin; so in Mechanicks, where Attraction ceases, 9037there a repulsive Virtue ought to succeed. And that there is such a 9038Virtue, seems to follow from the Reflexions and Inflexions of the Rays 9039of Light. For the Rays are repelled by Bodies in both these Cases, 9040without the immediate Contact of the reflecting or inflecting Body. It 9041seems also to follow from the Emission of Light; the Ray so soon as it 9042is shaken off from a shining Body by the vibrating Motion of the Parts 9043of the Body, and gets beyond the reach of Attraction, being driven away 9044with exceeding great Velocity. For that Force which is sufficient to 9045turn it back in Reflexion, may be sufficient to emit it. It seems also 9046to follow from the Production of Air and Vapour. The Particles when they 9047are shaken off from Bodies by Heat or Fermentation, so soon as they are 9048beyond the reach of the Attraction of the Body, receding from it, and 9049also from one another with great Strength, and keeping at a distance, 9050so as sometimes to take up above a Million of Times more space than they 9051did before in the form of a dense Body. Which vast Contraction and 9052Expansion seems unintelligible, by feigning the Particles of Air to be 9053springy and ramous, or rolled up like Hoops, or by any other means than 9054a repulsive Power. The Particles of Fluids which do not cohere too 9055strongly, and are of such a Smallness as renders them most susceptible 9056of those Agitations which keep Liquors in a Fluor, are most easily 9057separated and rarified into Vapour, and in the Language of the Chymists, 9058they are volatile, rarifying with an easy Heat, and condensing with 9059Cold. But those which are grosser, and so less susceptible of Agitation, 9060or cohere by a stronger Attraction, are not separated without a stronger 9061Heat, or perhaps not without Fermentation. And these last are the Bodies 9062which Chymists call fix'd, and being rarified by Fermentation, become 9063true permanent Air; those Particles receding from one another with the 9064greatest Force, and being most difficultly brought together, which upon 9065Contact cohere most strongly. And because the Particles of permanent Air 9066are grosser, and arise from denser Substances than those of Vapours, 9067thence it is that true Air is more ponderous than Vapour, and that a 9068moist Atmosphere is lighter than a dry one, quantity for quantity. From 9069the same repelling Power it seems to be that Flies walk upon the Water 9070without wetting their Feet; and that the Object-glasses of long 9071Telescopes lie upon one another without touching; and that dry Powders 9072are difficultly made to touch one another so as to stick together, 9073unless by melting them, or wetting them with Water, which by exhaling 9074may bring them together; and that two polish'd Marbles, which by 9075immediate Contact stick together, are difficultly brought so close 9076together as to stick. 9077 9078And thus Nature will be very conformable to her self and very simple, 9079performing all the great Motions of the heavenly Bodies by the 9080Attraction of Gravity which intercedes those Bodies, and almost all the 9081small ones of their Particles by some other attractive and repelling 9082Powers which intercede the Particles. The _Vis inertiæ_ is a passive 9083Principle by which Bodies persist in their Motion or Rest, receive 9084Motion in proportion to the Force impressing it, and resist as much as 9085they are resisted. By this Principle alone there never could have been 9086any Motion in the World. Some other Principle was necessary for putting 9087Bodies into Motion; and now they are in Motion, some other Principle is 9088necessary for conserving the Motion. For from the various Composition of 9089two Motions, 'tis very certain that there is not always the same 9090quantity of Motion in the World. For if two Globes joined by a slender 9091Rod, revolve about their common Center of Gravity with an uniform 9092Motion, while that Center moves on uniformly in a right Line drawn in 9093the Plane of their circular Motion; the Sum of the Motions of the two 9094Globes, as often as the Globes are in the right Line described by their 9095common Center of Gravity, will be bigger than the Sum of their Motions, 9096when they are in a Line perpendicular to that right Line. By this 9097Instance it appears that Motion may be got or lost. But by reason of the 9098Tenacity of Fluids, and Attrition of their Parts, and the Weakness of 9099Elasticity in Solids, Motion is much more apt to be lost than got, and 9100is always upon the Decay. For Bodies which are either absolutely hard, 9101or so soft as to be void of Elasticity, will not rebound from one 9102another. Impenetrability makes them only stop. If two equal Bodies meet 9103directly _in vacuo_, they will by the Laws of Motion stop where they 9104meet, and lose all their Motion, and remain in rest, unless they be 9105elastick, and receive new Motion from their Spring. If they have so much 9106Elasticity as suffices to make them re-bound with a quarter, or half, or 9107three quarters of the Force with which they come together, they will 9108lose three quarters, or half, or a quarter of their Motion. And this may 9109be try'd, by letting two equal Pendulums fall against one another from 9110equal heights. If the Pendulums be of Lead or soft Clay, they will lose 9111all or almost all their Motions: If of elastick Bodies they will lose 9112all but what they recover from their Elasticity. If it be said, that 9113they can lose no Motion but what they communicate to other Bodies, the 9114consequence is, that _in vacuo_ they can lose no Motion, but when they 9115meet they must go on and penetrate one another's Dimensions. If three 9116equal round Vessels be filled, the one with Water, the other with Oil, 9117the third with molten Pitch, and the Liquors be stirred about alike to 9118give them a vortical Motion; the Pitch by its Tenacity will lose its 9119Motion quickly, the Oil being less tenacious will keep it longer, and 9120the Water being less tenacious will keep it longest, but yet will lose 9121it in a short time. Whence it is easy to understand, that if many 9122contiguous Vortices of molten Pitch were each of them as large as those 9123which some suppose to revolve about the Sun and fix'd Stars, yet these 9124and all their Parts would, by their Tenacity and Stiffness, communicate 9125their Motion to one another till they all rested among themselves. 9126Vortices of Oil or Water, or some fluider Matter, might continue longer 9127in Motion; but unless the Matter were void of all Tenacity and Attrition 9128of Parts, and Communication of Motion, (which is not to be supposed,) 9129the Motion would constantly decay. Seeing therefore the variety of 9130Motion which we find in the World is always decreasing, there is a 9131necessity of conserving and recruiting it by active Principles, such as 9132are the cause of Gravity, by which Planets and Comets keep their Motions 9133in their Orbs, and Bodies acquire great Motion in falling; and the cause 9134of Fermentation, by which the Heart and Blood of Animals are kept in 9135perpetual Motion and Heat; the inward Parts of the Earth are constantly 9136warm'd, and in some places grow very hot; Bodies burn and shine, 9137Mountains take fire, the Caverns of the Earth are blown up, and the Sun 9138continues violently hot and lucid, and warms all things by his Light. 9139For we meet with very little Motion in the World, besides what is owing 9140to these active Principles. And if it were not for these Principles, the 9141Bodies of the Earth, Planets, Comets, Sun, and all things in them, 9142would grow cold and freeze, and become inactive Masses; and all 9143Putrefaction, Generation, Vegetation and Life would cease, and the 9144Planets and Comets would not remain in their Orbs. 9145 9146All these things being consider'd, it seems probable to me, that God in 9147the Beginning form'd Matter in solid, massy, hard, impenetrable, 9148moveable Particles, of such Sizes and Figures, and with such other 9149Properties, and in such Proportion to Space, as most conduced to the End 9150for which he form'd them; and that these primitive Particles being 9151Solids, are incomparably harder than any porous Bodies compounded of 9152them; even so very hard, as never to wear or break in pieces; no 9153ordinary Power being able to divide what God himself made one in the 9154first Creation. While the Particles continue entire, they may compose 9155Bodies of one and the same Nature and Texture in all Ages: But should 9156they wear away, or break in pieces, the Nature of Things depending on 9157them, would be changed. Water and Earth, composed of old worn Particles 9158and Fragments of Particles, would not be of the same Nature and Texture 9159now, with Water and Earth composed of entire Particles in the Beginning. 9160And therefore, that Nature may be lasting, the Changes of corporeal 9161Things are to be placed only in the various Separations and new 9162Associations and Motions of these permanent Particles; compound Bodies 9163being apt to break, not in the midst of solid Particles, but where those 9164Particles are laid together, and only touch in a few Points. 9165 9166It seems to me farther, that these Particles have not only a _Vis 9167inertiæ_, accompanied with such passive Laws of Motion as naturally 9168result from that Force, but also that they are moved by certain active 9169Principles, such as is that of Gravity, and that which causes 9170Fermentation, and the Cohesion of Bodies. These Principles I consider, 9171not as occult Qualities, supposed to result from the specifick Forms of 9172Things, but as general Laws of Nature, by which the Things themselves 9173are form'd; their Truth appearing to us by Phænomena, though their 9174Causes be not yet discover'd. For these are manifest Qualities, and 9175their Causes only are occult. And the _Aristotelians_ gave the Name of 9176occult Qualities, not to manifest Qualities, but to such Qualities only 9177as they supposed to lie hid in Bodies, and to be the unknown Causes of 9178manifest Effects: Such as would be the Causes of Gravity, and of 9179magnetick and electrick Attractions, and of Fermentations, if we should 9180suppose that these Forces or Actions arose from Qualities unknown to us, 9181and uncapable of being discovered and made manifest. Such occult 9182Qualities put a stop to the Improvement of natural Philosophy, and 9183therefore of late Years have been rejected. To tell us that every 9184Species of Things is endow'd with an occult specifick Quality by which 9185it acts and produces manifest Effects, is to tell us nothing: But to 9186derive two or three general Principles of Motion from Phænomena, and 9187afterwards to tell us how the Properties and Actions of all corporeal 9188Things follow from those manifest Principles, would be a very great step 9189in Philosophy, though the Causes of those Principles were not yet 9190discover'd: And therefore I scruple not to propose the Principles of 9191Motion above-mention'd, they being of very general Extent, and leave 9192their Causes to be found out. 9193 9194Now by the help of these Principles, all material Things seem to have 9195been composed of the hard and solid Particles above-mention'd, variously 9196associated in the first Creation by the Counsel of an intelligent Agent. 9197For it became him who created them to set them in order. And if he did 9198so, it's unphilosophical to seek for any other Origin of the World, or 9199to pretend that it might arise out of a Chaos by the mere Laws of 9200Nature; though being once form'd, it may continue by those Laws for many 9201Ages. For while Comets move in very excentrick Orbs in all manner of 9202Positions, blind Fate could never make all the Planets move one and the 9203same way in Orbs concentrick, some inconsiderable Irregularities 9204excepted, which may have risen from the mutual Actions of Comets and 9205Planets upon one another, and which will be apt to increase, till this 9206System wants a Reformation. Such a wonderful Uniformity in the Planetary 9207System must be allowed the Effect of Choice. And so must the Uniformity 9208in the Bodies of Animals, they having generally a right and a left side 9209shaped alike, and on either side of their Bodies two Legs behind, and 9210either two Arms, or two Legs, or two Wings before upon their Shoulders, 9211and between their Shoulders a Neck running down into a Back-bone, and a 9212Head upon it; and in the Head two Ears, two Eyes, a Nose, a Mouth, and 9213a Tongue, alike situated. Also the first Contrivance of those very 9214artificial Parts of Animals, the Eyes, Ears, Brain, Muscles, Heart, 9215Lungs, Midriff, Glands, Larynx, Hands, Wings, swimming Bladders, natural 9216Spectacles, and other Organs of Sense and Motion; and the Instinct of 9217Brutes and Insects, can be the effect of nothing else than the Wisdom 9218and Skill of a powerful ever-living Agent, who being in all Places, is 9219more able by his Will to move the Bodies within his boundless uniform 9220Sensorium, and thereby to form and reform the Parts of the Universe, 9221than we are by our Will to move the Parts of our own Bodies. And yet we 9222are not to consider the World as the Body of God, or the several Parts 9223thereof, as the Parts of God. He is an uniform Being, void of Organs, 9224Members or Parts, and they are his Creatures subordinate to him, and 9225subservient to his Will; and he is no more the Soul of them, than the 9226Soul of Man is the Soul of the Species of Things carried through the 9227Organs of Sense into the place of its Sensation, where it perceives them 9228by means of its immediate Presence, without the Intervention of any 9229third thing. The Organs of Sense are not for enabling the Soul to 9230perceive the Species of Things in its Sensorium, but only for conveying 9231them thither; and God has no need of such Organs, he being every where 9232present to the Things themselves. And since Space is divisible _in 9233infinitum_, and Matter is not necessarily in all places, it may be also 9234allow'd that God is able to create Particles of Matter of several Sizes 9235and Figures, and in several Proportions to Space, and perhaps of 9236different Densities and Forces, and thereby to vary the Laws of Nature, 9237and make Worlds of several sorts in several Parts of the Universe. At 9238least, I see nothing of Contradiction in all this. 9239 9240As in Mathematicks, so in Natural Philosophy, the Investigation of 9241difficult Things by the Method of Analysis, ought ever to precede the 9242Method of Composition. This Analysis consists in making Experiments and 9243Observations, and in drawing general Conclusions from them by Induction, 9244and admitting of no Objections against the Conclusions, but such as are 9245taken from Experiments, or other certain Truths. For Hypotheses are not 9246to be regarded in experimental Philosophy. And although the arguing from 9247Experiments and Observations by Induction be no Demonstration of general 9248Conclusions; yet it is the best way of arguing which the Nature of 9249Things admits of, and may be looked upon as so much the stronger, by how 9250much the Induction is more general. And if no Exception occur from 9251Phænomena, the Conclusion may be pronounced generally. But if at any 9252time afterwards any Exception shall occur from Experiments, it may then 9253begin to be pronounced with such Exceptions as occur. By this way of 9254Analysis we may proceed from Compounds to Ingredients, and from Motions 9255to the Forces producing them; and in general, from Effects to their 9256Causes, and from particular Causes to more general ones, till the 9257Argument end in the most general. This is the Method of Analysis: And 9258the Synthesis consists in assuming the Causes discover'd, and 9259establish'd as Principles, and by them explaining the Phænomena 9260proceeding from them, and proving the Explanations. 9261 9262In the two first Books of these Opticks, I proceeded by this Analysis to 9263discover and prove the original Differences of the Rays of Light in 9264respect of Refrangibility, Reflexibility, and Colour, and their 9265alternate Fits of easy Reflexion and easy Transmission, and the 9266Properties of Bodies, both opake and pellucid, on which their Reflexions 9267and Colours depend. And these Discoveries being proved, may be assumed 9268in the Method of Composition for explaining the Phænomena arising from 9269them: An Instance of which Method I gave in the End of the first Book. 9270In this third Book I have only begun the Analysis of what remains to be 9271discover'd about Light and its Effects upon the Frame of Nature, hinting 9272several things about it, and leaving the Hints to be examin'd and 9273improv'd by the farther Experiments and Observations of such as are 9274inquisitive. And if natural Philosophy in all its Parts, by pursuing 9275this Method, shall at length be perfected, the Bounds of Moral 9276Philosophy will be also enlarged. For so far as we can know by natural 9277Philosophy what is the first Cause, what Power he has over us, and what 9278Benefits we receive from him, so far our Duty towards him, as well as 9279that towards one another, will appear to us by the Light of Nature. And 9280no doubt, if the Worship of false Gods had not blinded the Heathen, 9281their moral Philosophy would have gone farther than to the four 9282Cardinal Virtues; and instead of teaching the Transmigration of Souls, 9283and to worship the Sun and Moon, and dead Heroes, they would have taught 9284us to worship our true Author and Benefactor, as their Ancestors did 9285under the Government of _Noah_ and his Sons before they corrupted 9286themselves.